2010-01-13 Phil Muldoon <pmuldoon@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
178 how you can copy and share GDB
179 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
180 * Index:: Index
181 @end menu
182
183 @end ifnottex
184
185 @contents
186
187 @node Summary
188 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
189
190 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
191 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
192 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
193
194 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
195 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
196
197 @itemize @bullet
198 @item
199 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
200
201 @item
202 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
203
204 @item
205 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
206
207 @item
208 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
209 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
210 @end itemize
211
212 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
213 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
214 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
215
216 @cindex Modula-2
217 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
218 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
219
220 @cindex Pascal
221 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
222 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
223 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
224 syntax.
225
226 @cindex Fortran
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
228 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
229 underscore.
230
231 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
232 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
233
234 @menu
235 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
236 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
237 @end menu
238
239 @node Free Software
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software
241
242 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
243 General Public License
244 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
245 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
246 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
247 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
248 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
249 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
250
251 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
252 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
253 from anyone else.
254
255 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256
257 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
258 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
259 include with the free software. Many of our most important
260 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
261 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
262 when an important free software package does not come with a free
263 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
264 gaps today.
265
266 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
267 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
268 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
269 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
270 them from the free software world.
271
272 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
273 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
274 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
275 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
276 contract to make it non-free.
277
278 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
279 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
280 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
281 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
282 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
283 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
284 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
285
286 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
287 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
288 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
289 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
290
291 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
292 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
293 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
294 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
295 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
296 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
297 community.
298
299 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
300 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
301 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
302 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
303 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
304 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
305 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
306 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
307 of the manual.
308
309 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
310 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
311 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
312 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
313 manual to replace it.
314
315 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
316 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
317 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
318 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
319 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
320 the free software community.
321
322 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
323 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
324 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
325 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
326 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
327 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
328 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
329 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
330 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
331
332 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
333 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
334 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
335 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
336 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
337 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
338 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
339 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
340
341 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
342 published by other publishers, at
343 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
344
345 @node Contributors
346 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
347
348 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
349 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
350 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
351 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
352 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
353 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
354 blow-by-blow account.
355
356 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
357
358 @quotation
359 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
360 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
361 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
362 @end quotation
363
364 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
365 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
366 releases:
367 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
368 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
369 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
370 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
371 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
372 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
373 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
374 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
375 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
376
377 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
378 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
379
380 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
381 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
382 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
383 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
384 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
385
386 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
387 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
388 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
389
390 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
391 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
392
393 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
394
395 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
396 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
397 support.
398 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
399 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
400 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
401 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
402 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
403 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
404 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
405 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
406 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
407 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
408 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
409 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
410 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
411 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
412 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
413 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
414
415 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
416
417 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
418 libraries.
419
420 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
421 about several machine instruction sets.
422
423 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
424 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
425 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
426 and RDI targets, respectively.
427
428 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
429 command-line editing and command history.
430
431 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
432 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
433
434 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
435 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
436 symbols.
437
438 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
439 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
440
441 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
442
443 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
444 processors.
445
446 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
447
448 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
449
450 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
451
452 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
453 watchpoints.
454
455 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
456
457 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
458
459 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
460 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
461
462 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
463 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
464 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
465 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
466 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
467 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
468 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
469
470 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
471 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
472
473 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
474 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
475 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
476 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
477 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
478 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
479 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
480 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
481 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
482 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
483 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
484 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
485 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
486 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
487 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
488
489 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
490 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
491
492 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
493 Hat.
494
495 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
496 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
497 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
498 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
499 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
500 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
501
502 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
503 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
504 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
505 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
506 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
507 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
508 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
509 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
510 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
511 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
512 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
513 Weigand.
514
515 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
516 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
517 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
518 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
519
520 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
521 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
522
523 @node Sample Session
524 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530 @iftex
531 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533 @end iftex
534
535 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548 @smallexample
549 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550 $ @b{./m4}
551 @b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553 @b{foo}
554 0000
555 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557 @b{bar}
558 0000
559 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562 @b{baz}
563 @b{Ctrl-d}
564 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565 @end smallexample
566
567 @noindent
568 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570 @smallexample
571 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
574 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581 (@value{GDBP})
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588 that examples fit in this manual.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598 @code{break} command.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610 @smallexample
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613 @b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615 @b{foo}
616 0000
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622 context where it stops.
623
624 @smallexample
625 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634 the next line of the current function.
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661 stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
683 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
685 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698 (@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714 533 xfree(rquote);
715 534
716 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720 537
721 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723 540 @}
724 541
725 542 void
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736 540 @}
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738 $3 = 9
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740 $4 = 7
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @noindent
744 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749 assignments.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753 $5 = 7
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755 $6 = 9
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762 example that caused trouble initially:
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766 Continuing.
767
768 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770 baz
771 0000
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @b{Ctrl-d}
781 Program exited normally.
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789 @smallexample
790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @node Invocation
794 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797 The essentials are:
798 @itemize @bullet
799 @item
800 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801 @item
802 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803 @end itemize
804
805 @menu
806 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810 @end menu
811
812 @node Invoking GDB
813 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821 The command-line options described here are designed
822 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823 options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826 specifying an executable program:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834 specified:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838 @end smallexample
839
840 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841 to debug a running process:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845 @end smallexample
846
847 @noindent
848 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859 option processing.
860 @smallexample
861 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862 @end smallexample
863 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} -silent
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877 @noindent
878 Type
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -help
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890 @samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893 @menu
894 * File Options:: Choosing files
895 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897 @end menu
898
899 @node File Options
900 @subsection Choosing Files
901
902 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918 argument and ignore it.
919
920 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928 @c it.
929
930 @table @code
931 @item -symbols @var{file}
932 @itemx -s @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--symbols}
934 @cindex @code{-s}
935 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937 @item -exec @var{file}
938 @itemx -e @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--exec}
940 @cindex @code{-e}
941 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944 @item -se @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--se}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947 file.
948
949 @item -core @var{file}
950 @itemx -c @var{file}
951 @cindex @code{--core}
952 @cindex @code{-c}
953 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955 @item -pid @var{number}
956 @itemx -p @var{number}
957 @cindex @code{--pid}
958 @cindex @code{-p}
959 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961 @item -command @var{file}
962 @itemx -x @var{file}
963 @cindex @code{--command}
964 @cindex @code{-x}
965 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966 Files,, Command files}.
967
968 @item -eval-command @var{command}
969 @itemx -ex @var{command}
970 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
971 @cindex @code{-ex}
972 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977 @smallexample
978 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980 @end smallexample
981
982 @item -directory @var{directory}
983 @itemx -d @var{directory}
984 @cindex @code{--directory}
985 @cindex @code{-d}
986 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988 @item -r
989 @itemx -readnow
990 @cindex @code{--readnow}
991 @cindex @code{-r}
992 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996 @end table
997
998 @node Mode Options
999 @subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002 batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004 @table @code
1005 @item -nx
1006 @itemx -n
1007 @cindex @code{--nx}
1008 @cindex @code{-n}
1009 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012 Files}.
1013
1014 @item -quiet
1015 @itemx -silent
1016 @itemx -q
1017 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1018 @cindex @code{--silent}
1019 @cindex @code{-q}
1020 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023 @item -batch
1024 @cindex @code{--batch}
1025 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029 in the command files.
1030
1031 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033 make this more useful, the message
1034
1035 @smallexample
1036 Program exited normally.
1037 @end smallexample
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042 mode.
1043
1044 @item -batch-silent
1045 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049 for an interactive session.
1050
1051 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052 messages, for example.
1053
1054 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057 @item -return-child-result
1058 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062 @itemize @bullet
1063 @item
1064 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067 @item
1068 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069 @item
1070 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071 the exit code will be -1.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076 interface.
1077
1078 @item -nowindows
1079 @itemx -nw
1080 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081 @cindex @code{-nw}
1082 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086 @item -windows
1087 @itemx -w
1088 @cindex @code{--windows}
1089 @cindex @code{-w}
1090 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091 used if possible.
1092
1093 @item -cd @var{directory}
1094 @cindex @code{--cd}
1095 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096 instead of the current directory.
1097
1098 @item -fullname
1099 @itemx -f
1100 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1101 @cindex @code{-f}
1102 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110 frame.
1111
1112 @item -epoch
1113 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1114 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117 separate window.
1118
1119 @item -annotate @var{level}
1120 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1121 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133 @item --args
1134 @cindex @code{--args}
1135 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137 This option stops option processing.
1138
1139 @item -baud @var{bps}
1140 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1141 @cindex @code{--baud}
1142 @cindex @code{-b}
1143 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -l @var{timeout}
1147 @cindex @code{-l}
1148 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149 for remote debugging.
1150
1151 @item -tty @var{device}
1152 @itemx -t @var{device}
1153 @cindex @code{--tty}
1154 @cindex @code{-t}
1155 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159 @item -tui
1160 @cindex @code{--tui}
1161 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169 @c @item -xdb
1170 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174 @c systems.
1175
1176 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190 @item -write
1191 @cindex @code{--write}
1192 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194 (@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196 @item -statistics
1197 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201 @item -version
1202 @cindex @code{--version}
1203 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @node Startup
1209 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214 @enumerate
1215 @item
1216 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219 @item
1220 @cindex init file
1221 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1222 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1223 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1228 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1229 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1230 that file.
1231
1232 @item
1233 Processes command line options and operands.
1234
1235 @item
1236 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1237 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1238 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1239 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1240 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1241 @value{GDBN}.
1242
1243 @item
1244 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1245 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1246
1247 @item
1248 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1249 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1250 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1251 @end enumerate
1252
1253 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1254 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1255 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1256 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1257 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1258 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1259
1260 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1261 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1262
1263 @cindex init file name
1264 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1265 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1266 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1267 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1268 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1269 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1270 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1271 the file to the standard name.
1272
1273
1274 @node Quitting GDB
1275 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1276 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1277 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1278
1279 @table @code
1280 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1281 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1282 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @itemx q
1284 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1285 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1286 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1287 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1288 error code.
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @cindex interrupt
1292 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1293 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1294 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1295 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1296 until a time when it is safe.
1297
1298 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1299 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1300 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1301
1302 @node Shell Commands
1303 @section Shell Commands
1304
1305 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1306 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1307 just use the @code{shell} command.
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex shell
1311 @cindex shell escape
1312 @item shell @var{command string}
1313 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1314 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1315 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1316 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1317 @end table
1318
1319 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1320 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1321 @value{GDBN}:
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex make
1325 @cindex calling make
1326 @item make @var{make-args}
1327 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1328 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1329 @end table
1330
1331 @node Logging Output
1332 @section Logging Output
1333 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1334 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1335
1336 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1337 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex set logging
1341 @item set logging on
1342 Enable logging.
1343 @item set logging off
1344 Disable logging.
1345 @cindex logging file name
1346 @item set logging file @var{file}
1347 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1348 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1350 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1351 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1352 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1353 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1354 @kindex show logging
1355 @item show logging
1356 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1357 @end table
1358
1359 @node Commands
1360 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1361
1362 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1363 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1364 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1365 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1366 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1367
1368 @menu
1369 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1370 * Completion:: Command completion
1371 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1372 @end menu
1373
1374 @node Command Syntax
1375 @section Command Syntax
1376
1377 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1378 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1379 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1380 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1381 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1382 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1383
1384 @cindex abbreviation
1385 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1386 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1387 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1388 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1389 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1390 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1391 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1392
1393 @cindex repeating commands
1394 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1395 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1396 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1397 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1398 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1399 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1400 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1401
1402 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1403 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1404 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1405
1406 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1407 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1408 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1409 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1410 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1411
1412 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1413 @cindex comment
1414 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1415 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1416 Files,,Command Files}).
1417
1418 @cindex repeating command sequences
1419 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1420 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1421 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1422 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1423 for editing.
1424
1425 @node Completion
1426 @section Command Completion
1427
1428 @cindex completion
1429 @cindex word completion
1430 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1431 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1432 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1433 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1434
1435 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1436 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1437 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1438 enter it). For example, if you type
1439
1440 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1441 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1442 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1443 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1444 @smallexample
1445 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1446 @end smallexample
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1450 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1454 @end smallexample
1455
1456 @noindent
1457 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1458 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1459 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1460 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1461 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1462 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1463
1464 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1465 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1466 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1467 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1468 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1469 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1470 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1471 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1472 example:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1476 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1477 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1478 make_abs_section make_function_type
1479 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1480 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1481 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1483 @end smallexample
1484
1485 @noindent
1486 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1487 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1488 command.
1489
1490 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1491 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1492 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1493 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1494 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1495
1496 @cindex quotes in commands
1497 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1498 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1499 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1500 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1501 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1502 @value{GDBN} commands.
1503
1504 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1505 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1506 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1507 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1508 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1509 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1510 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1511 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1512 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1513 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1514 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1518 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1520 @end smallexample
1521
1522 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1523 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1524 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1525 place:
1526
1527 @smallexample
1528 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1529 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1531 @end smallexample
1532
1533 @noindent
1534 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1535 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1536 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1537
1538 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1539 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1540 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1541 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1542
1543 @cindex completion of structure field names
1544 @cindex structure field name completion
1545 @cindex completion of union field names
1546 @cindex union field name completion
1547 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1548 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1549 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1550 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1551 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1552 left-hand-side:
1553
1554 @smallexample
1555 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1556 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1557 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1558 @end smallexample
1559
1560 @noindent
1561 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1562 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1563 follows:
1564
1565 @smallexample
1566 struct ui_file
1567 @{
1568 int *magic;
1569 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1570 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1571 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1572 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1573 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1574 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1575 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1576 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1577 void *to_data;
1578 @}
1579 @end smallexample
1580
1581
1582 @node Help
1583 @section Getting Help
1584 @cindex online documentation
1585 @kindex help
1586
1587 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1588 using the command @code{help}.
1589
1590 @table @code
1591 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1592 @item help
1593 @itemx h
1594 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1595 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1596
1597 @smallexample
1598 (@value{GDBP}) help
1599 List of classes of commands:
1600
1601 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1602 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1603 data -- Examining data
1604 files -- Specifying and examining files
1605 internals -- Maintenance commands
1606 obscure -- Obscure features
1607 running -- Running the program
1608 stack -- Examining the stack
1609 status -- Status inquiries
1610 support -- Support facilities
1611 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1612 stopping the program
1613 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1614
1615 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1616 commands in that class.
1617 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1618 documentation.
1619 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1620 (@value{GDBP})
1621 @end smallexample
1622 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1623
1624 @item help @var{class}
1625 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1626 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1627 help display for the class @code{status}:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1631 Status inquiries.
1632
1633 List of commands:
1634
1635 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1636 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1637 info -- Generic command for showing things
1638 about the program being debugged
1639 show -- Generic command for showing things
1640 about the debugger
1641
1642 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1643 documentation.
1644 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1645 (@value{GDBP})
1646 @end smallexample
1647
1648 @item help @var{command}
1649 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1650 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1651
1652 @kindex apropos
1653 @item apropos @var{args}
1654 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1655 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1656 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 apropos reload
1660 @end smallexample
1661
1662 @noindent
1663 results in:
1664
1665 @smallexample
1666 @c @group
1667 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1668 multiple times in one run
1669 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1670 multiple times in one run
1671 @c @end group
1672 @end smallexample
1673
1674 @kindex complete
1675 @item complete @var{args}
1676 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1677 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1678 command you want completed. For example:
1679
1680 @smallexample
1681 complete i
1682 @end smallexample
1683
1684 @noindent results in:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 @group
1688 if
1689 ignore
1690 info
1691 inspect
1692 @end group
1693 @end smallexample
1694
1695 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1696 @end table
1697
1698 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1699 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1700 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1701 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1702 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1703 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1704
1705 @c @group
1706 @table @code
1707 @kindex info
1708 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1709 @item info
1710 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1711 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1712 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1713 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1714 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1715 @w{@code{help info}}.
1716
1717 @kindex set
1718 @item set
1719 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1720 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1721 @code{set prompt $}.
1722
1723 @kindex show
1724 @item show
1725 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1726 @value{GDBN} itself.
1727 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1728 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1729 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1730 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1731
1732 @kindex info set
1733 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1734 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1735 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1736 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1737 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1738 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1739 @end table
1740 @c @end group
1741
1742 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1743 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1744
1745 @table @code
1746 @kindex show version
1747 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1748 @item show version
1749 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1750 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1751 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1752 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1753 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1754 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1755 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1756 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1757 @value{GDBN}.
1758
1759 @kindex show copying
1760 @kindex info copying
1761 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1762 @item show copying
1763 @itemx info copying
1764 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1765
1766 @kindex show warranty
1767 @kindex info warranty
1768 @item show warranty
1769 @itemx info warranty
1770 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1771 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1772
1773 @end table
1774
1775 @node Running
1776 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1777
1778 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1779 debugging information when you compile it.
1780
1781 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1782 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1783 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1784 kill a child process.
1785
1786 @menu
1787 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1788 * Starting:: Starting your program
1789 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1790 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1791
1792 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1793 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1794 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1795 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1796
1797 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1798 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1799 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1800 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1801 @end menu
1802
1803 @node Compilation
1804 @section Compiling for Debugging
1805
1806 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1807 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1808 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1809 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1810 and addresses in the executable code.
1811
1812 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1813 the compiler.
1814
1815 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1816 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1817 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1818 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1819 executables containing debugging information.
1820
1821 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1822 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1823 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1824 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1825 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1826
1827 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1828 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1829 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1830
1831 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1832 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1833 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1834 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1835 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1836 provides macro information if you specify the options
1837 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1838 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1839 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1840 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1841 @option{-g} alone.
1842
1843 @need 2000
1844 @node Starting
1845 @section Starting your Program
1846 @cindex starting
1847 @cindex running
1848
1849 @table @code
1850 @kindex run
1851 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1852 @item run
1853 @itemx r
1854 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1855 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1856 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1857 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1858 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1859
1860 @end table
1861
1862 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1863 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1864 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1865 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1866 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1867 message like this one:
1868
1869 @smallexample
1870 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1871 Try "help target" or "continue".
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent
1875 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1876 first (@pxref{load}).
1877
1878 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1879 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1880 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1881 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1882 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1883 divided into four categories:
1884
1885 @table @asis
1886 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1887 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1888 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1889 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1890 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1891 the arguments.
1892 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1893 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1894 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1895
1896 @item The @emph{environment.}
1897 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1898 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1899 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1900 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1901
1902 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1903 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1904 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1905 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1906
1907 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1908 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1909 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1910 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1911 set a different device for your program.
1912 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1913
1914 @cindex pipes
1915 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1916 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1917 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1918 wrong program.
1919 @end table
1920
1921 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1922 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1923 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1924 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1925 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1926
1927 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1928 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1929 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1930 your current breakpoints.
1931
1932 @table @code
1933 @kindex start
1934 @item start
1935 @cindex run to main procedure
1936 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1937 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1938 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1939 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1940 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1941 procedure, depending on the language used.
1942
1943 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1944 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1945 the @samp{run} command.
1946
1947 @cindex elaboration phase
1948 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1949 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1950 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1951 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1952 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1953 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1954 will remain to halt execution.
1955
1956 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1957 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1958 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1959 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1960 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1961
1962 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1963 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1964 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1965 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1966 elaboration code before running your program.
1967
1968 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1969 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1970 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1971 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1972 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1973 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1974 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1975 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1976 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1977 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1978 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1979
1980 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1981 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1982 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1983 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1984
1985 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1986 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1987 environment:
1988
1989 @smallexample
1990 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1991 (@value{GDBP}) run
1992 @end smallexample
1993
1994 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1995 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1996
1997 @kindex set disable-randomization
1998 @item set disable-randomization
1999 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2000 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2001 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2002 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2003 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2004
2005 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2006 behavior using
2007
2008 @smallexample
2009 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2010 @end smallexample
2011
2012 @item set disable-randomization off
2013 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2014 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2015 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2016 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2017 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2018 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2019
2020 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2021 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2022 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2023 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2024 a code at its expected addresses.
2025
2026 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2027 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2028 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2029 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2030 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2031 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2032 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2033 a randomly chosen address.
2034
2035 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2036 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2037 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2038 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2039 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2040
2041 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2042 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2043
2044 @item show disable-randomization
2045 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2046 the virtual address space of the started program.
2047
2048 @end table
2049
2050 @node Arguments
2051 @section Your Program's Arguments
2052
2053 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2054 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2055 @code{run} command.
2056 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2057 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2058 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2059 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2060 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2061
2062 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2063 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2064 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2065 the program, not by the shell.
2066
2067 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2068 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2069
2070 @table @code
2071 @kindex set args
2072 @item set args
2073 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2074 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2075 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2076 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2077 it again without arguments.
2078
2079 @kindex show args
2080 @item show args
2081 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 @node Environment
2085 @section Your Program's Environment
2086
2087 @cindex environment (of your program)
2088 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2089 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2090 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2091 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2092 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2093 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2094 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2095
2096 @table @code
2097 @kindex path
2098 @item path @var{directory}
2099 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2100 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2101 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2102 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2103 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2104 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2105 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2106
2107 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2108 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2109 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2110 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2111 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2112 @var{directory} to the search path.
2113 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2114 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2115
2116 @kindex show paths
2117 @item show paths
2118 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2119 environment variable).
2120
2121 @kindex show environment
2122 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2123 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2124 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2125 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2126 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2127
2128 @kindex set environment
2129 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2130 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2131 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2132 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2133 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2134 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2135 null value.
2136 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2137 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2138
2139 For example, this command:
2140
2141 @smallexample
2142 set env USER = foo
2143 @end smallexample
2144
2145 @noindent
2146 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2147 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2148 are not actually required.)
2149
2150 @kindex unset environment
2151 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2152 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2153 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2154 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2155 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2156 @end table
2157
2158 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2159 the shell indicated
2160 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2161 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2162 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2163 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2164 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2165 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2166 @file{.profile}.
2167
2168 @node Working Directory
2169 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2170
2171 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2172 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2173 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2174 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2175 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2176 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2177
2178 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2179 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2180 Specify Files}.
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @kindex cd
2184 @cindex change working directory
2185 @item cd @var{directory}
2186 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2187
2188 @kindex pwd
2189 @item pwd
2190 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2191 @end table
2192
2193 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2194 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2195 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2196 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2197 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2198 current working directory of the debuggee.
2199
2200 @node Input/Output
2201 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2202
2203 @cindex redirection
2204 @cindex i/o
2205 @cindex terminal
2206 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2207 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2208 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2209 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2210 running your program.
2211
2212 @table @code
2213 @kindex info terminal
2214 @item info terminal
2215 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2216 program is using.
2217 @end table
2218
2219 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2220 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2221
2222 @smallexample
2223 run > outfile
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2228
2229 @kindex tty
2230 @cindex controlling terminal
2231 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2232 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2233 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2234 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2235 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2236
2237 @smallexample
2238 tty /dev/ttyb
2239 @end smallexample
2240
2241 @noindent
2242 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2243 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2244 that as their controlling terminal.
2245
2246 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2247 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2248 terminal.
2249
2250 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2251 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2252 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2253 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2254
2255 @cindex inferior tty
2256 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2257 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2258 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2259 program.
2260
2261 @table @code
2262 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2263 @kindex set inferior-tty
2264 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2265
2266 @item show inferior-tty
2267 @kindex show inferior-tty
2268 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2269 @end table
2270
2271 @node Attach
2272 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2273 @kindex attach
2274 @cindex attach
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @item attach @var{process-id}
2278 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2279 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2280 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2281 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2282 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2283
2284 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2285 executing the command.
2286 @end table
2287
2288 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2289 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2290 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2291 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2292
2293 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2294 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2295 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2296 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2297 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2298 Specify Files}.
2299
2300 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2301 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2302 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2303 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2304 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2305 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2306 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @kindex detach
2310 @item detach
2311 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2312 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2313 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2314 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2315 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2316 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2317 executing the command.
2318 @end table
2319
2320 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2321 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2322 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2323 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2324 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2325 Messages}).
2326
2327 @node Kill Process
2328 @section Killing the Child Process
2329
2330 @table @code
2331 @kindex kill
2332 @item kill
2333 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2334 @end table
2335
2336 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2337 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2338 is running.
2339
2340 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2341 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2342 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2343 outside the debugger.
2344
2345 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2346 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2347 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2348 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2349 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2350 breakpoint settings).
2351
2352 @node Inferiors and Programs
2353 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2354
2355 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2356 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2357 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2358 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2359 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2360 from multiple executables.
2361
2362 @cindex inferior
2363 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2364 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2365 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2366 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2367 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2368 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2369 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2370 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2371 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2372 threads running in it.
2373
2374 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2375 inferiors}}:
2376
2377 @table @code
2378 @kindex info inferiors
2379 @item info inferiors
2380 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2381
2382 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2383
2384 @enumerate
2385 @item
2386 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2387
2388 @item
2389 the target system's inferior identifier
2390
2391 @item
2392 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2393
2394 @end enumerate
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2398 indicates the current inferior.
2399
2400 For example,
2401 @end table
2402 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2406 Num Description Executable
2407 2 process 2307 hello
2408 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2409 @end smallexample
2410
2411 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2412
2413 @table @code
2414 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2415 @item inferior @var{infno}
2416 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2417 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2418 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2419 @end table
2420
2421
2422 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2423 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2424 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2425 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2426 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2427 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2428
2429 @table @code
2430 @kindex add-inferior
2431 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2432 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2433 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2434 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2435 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2436 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2437
2438 @kindex clone-inferior
2439 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2440 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2441 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2442 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2443 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2444
2445 @smallexample
2446 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2447 Num Description Executable
2448 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2449 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2450 Added inferior 2.
2451 1 inferiors added.
2452 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2453 Num Description Executable
2454 2 <null> helloworld
2455 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2456 @end smallexample
2457
2458 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2459
2460 @kindex remove-inferior
2461 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2462 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2463 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2464 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2465
2466 @end table
2467
2468 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2469 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2470 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2471 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2472
2473 @table @code
2474 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2475 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2476 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2477 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2478
2479 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2480 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2481 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2482 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2483 @end table
2484
2485 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2486 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2487 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2488 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2489
2490
2491 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2492 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2493
2494 @table @code
2495 @kindex set print inferior-events
2496 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2497 @item set print inferior-events
2498 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2499 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2500 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2501 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2502 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2503 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2504
2505 @kindex show print inferior-events
2506 @item show print inferior-events
2507 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2508 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2512 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2513 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2514
2515
2516 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2517 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2518 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2519 info program-spaces}} command.
2520
2521 @table @code
2522 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2523 @item maint info program-spaces
2524 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2525 @value{GDBN}.
2526
2527 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2528
2529 @enumerate
2530 @item
2531 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2532
2533 @item
2534 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2535 the @code{file} command.
2536
2537 @end enumerate
2538
2539 @noindent
2540 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2541 indicates the current program space.
2542
2543 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2544 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2545 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2546
2547 @smallexample
2548 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2549 Id Executable
2550 2 goodbye
2551 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2552 * 1 hello
2553 @end smallexample
2554
2555 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2556 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2557 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2558 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2559 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2560
2561 @smallexample
2562 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2563 Id Executable
2564 * 1 vfork-test
2565 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2566 @end smallexample
2567
2568 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2569 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2570 @end table
2571
2572 @node Threads
2573 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2574
2575 @cindex threads of execution
2576 @cindex multiple threads
2577 @cindex switching threads
2578 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2579 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2580 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2581 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2582 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2583 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2584 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2585
2586 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2587 programs:
2588
2589 @itemize @bullet
2590 @item automatic notification of new threads
2591 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2592 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2593 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2594 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2595 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2596 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2597 messages on thread start and exit.
2598 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2599 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2600 isn't compatible with the program.
2601 @end itemize
2602
2603 @quotation
2604 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2605 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2606 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2607 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2608 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2609 like this:
2610
2611 @smallexample
2612 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2613 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2614 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2615 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2616 @end smallexample
2617 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2618 @c doesn't support threads"?
2619 @end quotation
2620
2621 @cindex focus of debugging
2622 @cindex current thread
2623 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2624 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2625 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2626 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2627 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2628
2629 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2630 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2631 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2632 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2633 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2634 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2635 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2636 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2637 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2638 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2639
2640 @smallexample
2641 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2642 @end smallexample
2643
2644 @noindent
2645 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2646 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2647 further qualifier.
2648
2649 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2650 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2651 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2652 @c program?
2653 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2654 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2655 @c threads ab initio?
2656
2657 @cindex thread number
2658 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2659 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2660 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2661
2662 @table @code
2663 @kindex info threads
2664 @item info threads
2665 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2666 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2667
2668 @enumerate
2669 @item
2670 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2671
2672 @item
2673 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2674
2675 @item
2676 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2677 @end enumerate
2678
2679 @noindent
2680 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2681 indicates the current thread.
2682
2683 For example,
2684 @end table
2685 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2686
2687 @smallexample
2688 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2689 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2690 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2691 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2692 at threadtest.c:68
2693 @end smallexample
2694
2695 On HP-UX systems:
2696
2697 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2698 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2699 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2700 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2701 thread in your program.
2702
2703 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2704 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2705 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2706 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2707 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2708 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2709 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2710 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2711 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2712 HP-UX, you see
2713
2714 @smallexample
2715 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2716 @end smallexample
2717
2718 @noindent
2719 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2720
2721 @table @code
2722 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2723 @item info threads
2724 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2725 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2726
2727 @enumerate
2728 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2731
2732 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2733 @end enumerate
2734
2735 @noindent
2736 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2737 indicates the current thread.
2738
2739 For example,
2740 @end table
2741 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2742
2743 @smallexample
2744 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2745 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2746 at quicksort.c:137
2747 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2748 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2749 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2750 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2754 Solaris-specific command:
2755
2756 @table @code
2757 @item maint info sol-threads
2758 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2759 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2760 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @table @code
2764 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2765 @item thread @var{threadno}
2766 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2767 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2768 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2769 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2770 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2771
2772 @smallexample
2773 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2774 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2775 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2776 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2777 @end smallexample
2778
2779 @noindent
2780 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2781 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2782 threads.
2783
2784 @kindex thread apply
2785 @cindex apply command to several threads
2786 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2787 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2788 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2789 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2790 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2791 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2792 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2793 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2794
2795 @kindex set print thread-events
2796 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2797 @item set print thread-events
2798 @itemx set print thread-events on
2799 @itemx set print thread-events off
2800 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2801 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2802 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2803 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2804 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2805
2806 @kindex show print thread-events
2807 @item show print thread-events
2808 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2809 have started and exited.
2810 @end table
2811
2812 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2813 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2814 programs with multiple threads.
2815
2816 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2817 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2818
2819 @table @code
2820 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2821 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2822 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2823 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2824 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2825 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2826 an empty list.
2827
2828 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2829 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2830 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2831 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2832 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2833 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2834
2835 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2836 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2837 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2838 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2839 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2840 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2841 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2842
2843 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2844 only on some platforms.
2845
2846 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2847 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2848 Display current libthread_db search path.
2849 @end table
2850
2851 @node Forks
2852 @section Debugging Forks
2853
2854 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2855 @cindex multiple processes
2856 @cindex processes, multiple
2857 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2858 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2859 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2860 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2861 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2862 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2863 will cause it to terminate.
2864
2865 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2866 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2867 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2868 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2869 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2870 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2871 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2872 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2873 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2874 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2875
2876 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2877 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2878 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2879 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2880
2881 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2882 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2883
2884 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2885 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2886
2887 @table @code
2888 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2889 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2890 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2891 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2892 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2893
2894 @table @code
2895 @item parent
2896 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2897 unimpeded. This is the default.
2898
2899 @item child
2900 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2901 unimpeded.
2902
2903 @end table
2904
2905 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2906 @item show follow-fork-mode
2907 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2908 @end table
2909
2910 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2911 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2912 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2913
2914 @table @code
2915 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2916 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2917 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2918 retain debugger control over them both.
2919
2920 @table @code
2921 @item on
2922 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2923 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2924 independently. This is the default.
2925
2926 @item off
2927 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2928 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2929 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2930 is held suspended.
2931
2932 @end table
2933
2934 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2935 @item show detach-on-fork
2936 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2937 @end table
2938
2939 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2940 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2941 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2942 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2943 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2944 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2945
2946 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2947 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2948 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2949 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2950 and Programs}.
2951
2952 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2953 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2954 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2955 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2956 the child process's @code{main}.
2957
2958 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2959 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2960
2961 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2962 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2963 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2964 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2965 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2966 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2967 command.
2968
2969 @table @code
2970 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
2971 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
2972
2973 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
2974 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
2975
2976 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
2977
2978 @table @code
2979 @item new
2980 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
2981 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
2982 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
2983 original inferior.
2984
2985 For example:
2986
2987 @smallexample
2988 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2989 (gdb) info inferior
2990 Id Description Executable
2991 * 1 <null> prog1
2992 (@value{GDBP}) run
2993 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
2994 Program exited normally.
2995 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2996 Id Description Executable
2997 * 2 <null> prog2
2998 1 <null> prog1
2999 @end smallexample
3000
3001 @item same
3002 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3003 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3004 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3005 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3006 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3007
3008 For example:
3009
3010 @smallexample
3011 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3012 Id Description Executable
3013 * 1 <null> prog1
3014 (@value{GDBP}) run
3015 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3016 Program exited normally.
3017 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3018 Id Description Executable
3019 * 1 <null> prog2
3020 @end smallexample
3021
3022 @end table
3023 @end table
3024
3025 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3026 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3027 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3028
3029 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3030 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3031
3032 @cindex checkpoint
3033 @cindex restart
3034 @cindex bookmark
3035 @cindex snapshot of a process
3036 @cindex rewind program state
3037
3038 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3039 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3040 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3041 later.
3042
3043 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3044 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3045 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3046 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3047 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3048
3049 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3050 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3051 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3052 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3053 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3054 start again from there.
3055
3056 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3057 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3058
3059 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3060
3061 @table @code
3062 @kindex checkpoint
3063 @item checkpoint
3064 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3065 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3066 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3067
3068 @kindex info checkpoints
3069 @item info checkpoints
3070 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3071 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3072 listed:
3073
3074 @table @code
3075 @item Checkpoint ID
3076 @item Process ID
3077 @item Code Address
3078 @item Source line, or label
3079 @end table
3080
3081 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3082 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3083 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3084 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3085 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3086 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3087 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3088
3089 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3090 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3091 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3092 the debugger.
3093
3094 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3095 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3096 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3097
3098 @end table
3099
3100 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3101 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3102 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3103 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3104 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3105 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3106 previously read data can be read again.
3107
3108 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3109 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3110 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3111 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3112 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3113 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3114
3115 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3116 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3117 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3118 different execution path this time.
3119
3120 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3121 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3122 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3123 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3124 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3125 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3126 potentially pose a problem.
3127
3128 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3129
3130 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3131 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3132 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3133 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3134 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3135 next.
3136
3137 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3138 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3139 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3140 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3141 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3142
3143 @node Stopping
3144 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3145
3146 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3147 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3148 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3149
3150 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3151 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3152 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3153 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3154 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3155 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3156 explicitly request this information at any time.
3157
3158 @table @code
3159 @kindex info program
3160 @item info program
3161 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3162 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @menu
3166 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3167 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3168 * Signals:: Signals
3169 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3170 @end menu
3171
3172 @node Breakpoints
3173 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3174
3175 @cindex breakpoints
3176 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3177 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3178 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3179 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3180 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3181 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3182 program.
3183
3184 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3185 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3186 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3187 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3188 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3189 call).
3190
3191 @cindex watchpoints
3192 @cindex data breakpoints
3193 @cindex memory tracing
3194 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3195 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3196 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3197 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3198 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3199 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3200 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3201 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3202 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3203 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3204 same commands.
3205
3206 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3207 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3208 Automatic Display}.
3209
3210 @cindex catchpoints
3211 @cindex breakpoint on events
3212 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3213 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3214 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3215 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3216 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3217 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3218 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3219
3220 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3221 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3222 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3223 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3224 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3225 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3226 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3227 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3228 enable it again.
3229
3230 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3231 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3232 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3233 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3234 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3235 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3236 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3237
3238 @menu
3239 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3240 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3241 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3242 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3243 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3244 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3245 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3246 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3247 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3248 @end menu
3249
3250 @node Set Breaks
3251 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3252
3253 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3254 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3255 @c
3256 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3257
3258 @kindex break
3259 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3260 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3261 @cindex latest breakpoint
3262 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3263 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3264 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3265 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3266 convenience variables.
3267
3268 @table @code
3269 @item break @var{location}
3270 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3271 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3272 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3273 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3274 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3275
3276 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3277 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3278 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3279 that situation.
3280
3281 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3282 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3283 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3284
3285 @item break
3286 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3287 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3288 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3289 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3290 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3291 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3292 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3293 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3294 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3295 inside loops.
3296
3297 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3298 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3299 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3300 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3301 existed when your program stopped.
3302
3303 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3304 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3305 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3306 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3307 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3308 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3309 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3310
3311 @kindex tbreak
3312 @item tbreak @var{args}
3313 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3314 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3315 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3316 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3317
3318 @kindex hbreak
3319 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3320 @item hbreak @var{args}
3321 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3322 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3323 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3324 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3325 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3326 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3327 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3328 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3329 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3330 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3331 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3332 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3333 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3334 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3335 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3336 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3337 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3338 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3339
3340 @kindex thbreak
3341 @item thbreak @var{args}
3342 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3343 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3344 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3345 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3346 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3347 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3348 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3349 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3350
3351 @kindex rbreak
3352 @cindex regular expression
3353 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3354 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3355 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3356 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3357 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3358 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3359 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3360 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3361 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3362
3363 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3364 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3365 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3366 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3367 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3368 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3369
3370 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3371 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3372 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3373 classes.
3374
3375 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3376 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3377 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3378
3379 @smallexample
3380 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3381 @end smallexample
3382
3383 @kindex info breakpoints
3384 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3385 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3386 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3387 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3388 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3389 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3390 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3391 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3392
3393 @table @emph
3394 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3395 @item Type
3396 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3397 @item Disposition
3398 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3399 @item Enabled or Disabled
3400 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3401 that are not enabled.
3402 @item Address
3403 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3404 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3405 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3406 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3407 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3408 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3409 @item What
3410 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3411 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3412 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3413 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3414 @end table
3415
3416 @noindent
3417 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3418 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3419 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3420 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3421 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3422 valid location.
3423
3424 @noindent
3425 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3426 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3427 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3428 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3429 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3433 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3434 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3435 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3436 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3437 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3441 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3442 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3443 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3444
3445 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3446 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3447 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3448 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3449
3450 @itemize @bullet
3451 @item
3452 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3453 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3454
3455 @item
3456 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3457 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3458
3459 @item
3460 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3461 several places where that function is inlined.
3462 @end itemize
3463
3464 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3465 the relevant locations@footnote{
3466 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3467 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3468 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3469 info with line numbers for them.}.
3470
3471 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3472 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3473 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3474 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3475 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3476 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3477 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3478
3479 For example:
3480
3481 @smallexample
3482 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3483 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3484 stop only if i==1
3485 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3486 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3487 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3488 @end smallexample
3489
3490 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3491 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3492 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3493 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3494 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3495 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3496 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3497 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3498 that belong to that breakpoint.
3499
3500 @cindex pending breakpoints
3501 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3502 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3503 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3504 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3505 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3506 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3507 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3508 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3509 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3510 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3511 is not yet resolved.
3512
3513 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3514 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3515 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3516 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3517 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3518 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3519
3520 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3521 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3522 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3523 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3524
3525 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3526 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3527 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3528
3529 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3530 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3531 address specification to an address:
3532
3533 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3534 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3535 @table @code
3536 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3537 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3538 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3539
3540 @item set breakpoint pending on
3541 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3542 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3543
3544 @item set breakpoint pending off
3545 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3546 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3547 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3548
3549 @item show breakpoint pending
3550 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3551 @end table
3552
3553 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3554 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3555 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3556
3557 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3558 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3559 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3560 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3561 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3562 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3563 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3564 breakpoints.
3565
3566 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3567
3568 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3569 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3570 @table @code
3571 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3572 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3573 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3574 breakpoint must be used.
3575
3576 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3577 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3578 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3579 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3580 @end table
3581
3582 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3583 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3584 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3585 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3586 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3587 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3588 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3589 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3590 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3591
3592 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3593 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3594 @table @code
3595 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3596 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3597 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3598 removed from the target when it stops.
3599
3600 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3601 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3602 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3603 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3604 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3605
3606 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3607 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3608 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3609 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3610 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3611 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3612 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3616 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3617 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3618 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3619 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3620 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3621 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3622 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3623
3624
3625 @node Set Watchpoints
3626 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3627
3628 @cindex setting watchpoints
3629 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3630 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3631 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3632 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3633 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3634
3635 @itemize @bullet
3636 @item
3637 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3638
3639 @item
3640 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3641 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3642 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3643
3644 @item
3645 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3646 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3647 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3648 @end itemize
3649
3650 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3651 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3652 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3653 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3654 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3655 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3656 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3657 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3658 the expression changes.
3659
3660 @cindex software watchpoints
3661 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3662 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3663 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3664 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3665 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3666 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3667 culprit.)
3668
3669 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3670 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3671 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3672
3673 @table @code
3674 @kindex watch
3675 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3676 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3677 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3678 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3679 to watch the value of a single variable:
3680
3681 @smallexample
3682 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3683 @end smallexample
3684
3685 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3686 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3687 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3688 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3689 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3690 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3691
3692 @kindex rwatch
3693 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3694 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3695 by the program.
3696
3697 @kindex awatch
3698 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3699 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3700 or written into by the program.
3701
3702 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3703 @item info watchpoints
3704 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3705 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3706 @end table
3707
3708 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3709 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3710 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3711 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3712 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3713 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3714
3715 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3716 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3717 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3718 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3719 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3720 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3721 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3722 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3723
3724 @table @code
3725 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3726 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3727 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3728
3729 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3730 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3731 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3732 @end table
3733
3734 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3735 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3736 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3737
3738 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3739
3740 @smallexample
3741 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3742 @end smallexample
3743
3744 @noindent
3745 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3746
3747 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3748 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3749 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3750 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3751 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3752 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3753 will print a message like this:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3757 @end smallexample
3758
3759 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3760 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3761 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3762 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3763 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3764 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3765 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3766 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3767
3768 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3769 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3770 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3771 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3772 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3773 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3774
3775 @smallexample
3776 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3777 @end smallexample
3778
3779 @noindent
3780 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3781
3782 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3783 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3784 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3785 expression with separately allocated resources.
3786
3787 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3788 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3789 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3790
3791 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3792 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3793 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3794 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3795 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3796 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3797 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3798 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3799 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3800
3801 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3802 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3803 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3804 watched expression from every thread.
3805
3806 @quotation
3807 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3808 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3809 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3810 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3811 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3812 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3813 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3814 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3815 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3816 @end quotation
3817
3818 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3819
3820 @node Set Catchpoints
3821 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3822 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3823 @cindex exception handlers
3824 @cindex event handling
3825
3826 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3827 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3828 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3829
3830 @table @code
3831 @kindex catch
3832 @item catch @var{event}
3833 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3834 @table @code
3835 @item throw
3836 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3837 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3838
3839 @item catch
3840 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3841
3842 @item exception
3843 @cindex Ada exception catching
3844 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3845 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3846 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3847 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3848 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3849
3850 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3851 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3852 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3853 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3854 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3855 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3856 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3857 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3858
3859 @item exception unhandled
3860 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3861
3862 @item assert
3863 A failed Ada assertion.
3864
3865 @item exec
3866 @cindex break on fork/exec
3867 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3868 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3869
3870 @item syscall
3871 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @r{...}
3872 @cindex break on a system call.
3873 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3874 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3875 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3876 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3877 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3878 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3879 will be caught.
3880
3881 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3882 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3883 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3884 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3885
3886 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3887 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3888 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3889 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3890
3891 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3892 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3893 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3894 available choices.
3895
3896 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3897 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3898 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3899 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3900 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3901 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3902 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3903 behind the OS upgrades).
3904
3905 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3906 arguments to it:
3907
3908 @smallexample
3909 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3910 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3911 (@value{GDBP}) r
3912 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3913
3914 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3915 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3916 (@value{GDBP}) c
3917 Continuing.
3918
3919 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3920 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3921 (@value{GDBP})
3922 @end smallexample
3923
3924 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3925
3926 @smallexample
3927 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3928 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3929 (@value{GDBP}) r
3930 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3931
3932 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3933 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3934 (@value{GDBP}) c
3935 Continuing.
3936
3937 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
3938 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3939 (@value{GDBP})
3940 @end smallexample
3941
3942 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
3943 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
3944 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
3945
3946 @smallexample
3947 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3948 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
3949 (@value{GDBP}) r
3950 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3951
3952 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
3953 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3954 (@value{GDBP}) c
3955 Continuing.
3956
3957 Program exited normally.
3958 (@value{GDBP})
3959 @end smallexample
3960
3961 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
3962 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
3963 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
3964 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
3965
3966 @smallexample
3967 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
3968 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
3969 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
3970 (@value{GDBP})
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
3974 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
3975 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
3976 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
3977 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
3978 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
3979
3980 @smallexample
3981 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3982 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
3983 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
3984 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
3985 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3986 (@value{GDBP})
3987 @end smallexample
3988
3989 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
3990
3991 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
3992 number. In this case, you would see something like:
3993
3994 @smallexample
3995 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3996 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
3997 @end smallexample
3998
3999 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4000
4001 @item fork
4002 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4003 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4004
4005 @item vfork
4006 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4007 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4008
4009 @end table
4010
4011 @item tcatch @var{event}
4012 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4013 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4014
4015 @end table
4016
4017 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4018
4019 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4020 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4021
4022 @itemize @bullet
4023 @item
4024 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4025 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4026 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4027 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4028 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4029 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4030 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4031 disabled within interactive calls.
4032
4033 @item
4034 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4035
4036 @item
4037 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4038 @end itemize
4039
4040 @cindex raise exceptions
4041 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4042 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4043 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4044 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4045 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4046 out where the exception was raised.
4047
4048 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4049 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4050 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4051 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4052
4053 @smallexample
4054 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4055 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4056 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4057 @end smallexample
4058
4059 @noindent
4060 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4061 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4062 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4063
4064 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4065 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4066 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4067 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4068 raised.
4069
4070
4071 @node Delete Breaks
4072 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4073
4074 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4075 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4076 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4077 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4078 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4079 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4080
4081 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4082 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4083 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4084 their breakpoint numbers.
4085
4086 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4087 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4088 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4089
4090 @table @code
4091 @kindex clear
4092 @item clear
4093 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4094 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4095 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4096 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4097
4098 @item clear @var{location}
4099 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4100 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4101 most useful ones are listed below:
4102
4103 @table @code
4104 @item clear @var{function}
4105 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4106 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4107
4108 @item clear @var{linenum}
4109 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4110 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4111 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4112 @end table
4113
4114 @cindex delete breakpoints
4115 @kindex delete
4116 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4117 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4118 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4119 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4120 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4121 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4122 @end table
4123
4124 @node Disabling
4125 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4126
4127 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4128 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4129 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4130 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4131 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4132
4133 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4134 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
4135 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
4136 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
4137 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
4138
4139 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4140 affects all of its locations.
4141
4142 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4143 states of enablement:
4144
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146 @item
4147 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4148 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4149 @item
4150 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4151 @item
4152 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4153 disabled.
4154 @item
4155 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4156 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4157 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4158 @end itemize
4159
4160 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4161 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex disable
4165 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4166 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4167 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4168 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4169 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4170 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4171 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4172
4173 @kindex enable
4174 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4175 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4176 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4177
4178 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4179 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4180 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4181
4182 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4183 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4184 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4185 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4186 @end table
4187
4188 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4189 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4190 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4191 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4192 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4193 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4194 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4195 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4196 Stepping}.)
4197
4198 @node Conditions
4199 @subsection Break Conditions
4200 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4201 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4202
4203 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4204 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4205 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4206 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4207 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4208 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4209 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4210 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4211
4212 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4213 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4214 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4215 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4216 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4217
4218 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4219 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4220 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4221 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4222 one.
4223
4224 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4225 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4226 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4227 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4228 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4229 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4230 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4231 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4232 conditions for the
4233 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4234 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4235
4236 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4237 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4238 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4239 with the @code{condition} command.
4240
4241 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4242 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4243 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4244 catchpoint.
4245
4246 @table @code
4247 @kindex condition
4248 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4249 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4250 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4251 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4252 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4253 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4254 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4255 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4256 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4257 prints an error message:
4258
4259 @smallexample
4260 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4261 @end smallexample
4262
4263 @noindent
4264 @value{GDBN} does
4265 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4266 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4267 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4268
4269 @item condition @var{bnum}
4270 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4271 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4275 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4276 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4277 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4278 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4279 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4280 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4281 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4282 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4283 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4284 your program reaches it.
4285
4286 @table @code
4287 @kindex ignore
4288 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4289 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4290 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4291 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4292 takes no action.
4293
4294 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4295 a count of zero.
4296
4297 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4298 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4299 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4300 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4301
4302 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4303 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4304 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4305
4306 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4307 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4308 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4309 Variables}.
4310 @end table
4311
4312 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4313
4314
4315 @node Break Commands
4316 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4317
4318 @cindex breakpoint commands
4319 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4320 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4321 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4322 enable other breakpoints.
4323
4324 @table @code
4325 @kindex commands
4326 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4327 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
4328 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4329 @itemx end
4330 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
4331 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4332 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4333
4334 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4335 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4336
4337 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
4338 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
4339 recently encountered).
4340 @end table
4341
4342 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4343 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4344
4345 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4346 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4347 that resumes execution.
4348
4349 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4350 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4351 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4352 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4353 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4354
4355 @kindex silent
4356 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4357 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4358 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4359 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4360 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4361 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4362
4363 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4364 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4365 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4366
4367 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4368 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4369
4370 @smallexample
4371 break foo if x>0
4372 commands
4373 silent
4374 printf "x is %d\n",x
4375 cont
4376 end
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4380 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4381 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4382 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4383 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4384 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4385 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4386
4387 @smallexample
4388 break 403
4389 commands
4390 silent
4391 set x = y + 4
4392 cont
4393 end
4394 @end smallexample
4395
4396 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4397 @node Error in Breakpoints
4398 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4399
4400 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4401 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4402
4403 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4404 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4405 @smallexample
4406 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4407 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4412 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4413 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4414
4415 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4416 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4417
4418 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4419 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4420 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4421
4422 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4423 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4424 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4425 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4426
4427 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4428 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4429 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4430 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4431 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4432 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4433 first in the bundle.
4434
4435 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4436 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4437 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4438 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4439 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4440 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4441 is hit.
4442
4443 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4444 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4445
4446 @smallexample
4447 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4451 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4452 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4453 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4454 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4455 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4456 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4457 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4458
4459 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4460 adjusted breakpoints:
4461
4462 @smallexample
4463 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4464 to 0x00010410.
4465 @end smallexample
4466
4467 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4468 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4469 frequently than expected.
4470
4471 @node Continuing and Stepping
4472 @section Continuing and Stepping
4473
4474 @cindex stepping
4475 @cindex continuing
4476 @cindex resuming execution
4477 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4478 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4479 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4480 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4481 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4482 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4483 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4484 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4485
4486 @table @code
4487 @kindex continue
4488 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4489 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4490 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4491 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4492 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4493 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4494 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4495 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4496 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4497 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4498
4499 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4500 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4501 @code{continue} is ignored.
4502
4503 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4504 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4505 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4506 @code{continue}.
4507 @end table
4508
4509 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4510 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4511 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4512 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4513
4514 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4515 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4516 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4517 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4518 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4519 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4520
4521 @table @code
4522 @kindex step
4523 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4524 @item step
4525 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4526 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4527 abbreviated @code{s}.
4528
4529 @quotation
4530 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4531 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4532 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4533 @c distinction here.
4534 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4535 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4536 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4537 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4538 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4539 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4540 below.
4541 @end quotation
4542
4543 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4544 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4545 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4546 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4547 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4548 called within the line.
4549
4550 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4551 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4552 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4553 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4554 was any debugging information about the routine.
4555
4556 @item step @var{count}
4557 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4558 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4559 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4560
4561 @kindex next
4562 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4563 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4564 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4565 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4566 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4567 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4568 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4569 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4570
4571 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4572
4573
4574 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4575 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4576 @c
4577 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4578 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4579 @c function are executed without stopping.
4580
4581 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4582 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4583 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4584
4585 @kindex set step-mode
4586 @item set step-mode
4587 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4588 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4589 @itemx set step-mode on
4590 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4591 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4592 information rather than stepping over it.
4593
4594 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4595 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4596 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4597
4598 @item set step-mode off
4599 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4600 debug information. This is the default.
4601
4602 @item show step-mode
4603 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4604 source line debug information.
4605
4606 @kindex finish
4607 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4608 @item finish
4609 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4610 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4611 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4612
4613 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4614 ,Returning from a Function}).
4615
4616 @kindex until
4617 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4618 @cindex run until specified location
4619 @item until
4620 @itemx u
4621 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4622 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4623 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4624 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4625 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4626 than the address of the jump.
4627
4628 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4629 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4630 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4631 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4632 through the next iteration.
4633
4634 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4635 stack frame.
4636
4637 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4638 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4639 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4640 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4641 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4642
4643 @smallexample
4644 (@value{GDBP}) f
4645 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4646 206 expand_input();
4647 (@value{GDBP}) until
4648 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4652 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4653 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4654 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4655 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4656 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4657 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4658
4659 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4660 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4661 argument.
4662
4663 @item until @var{location}
4664 @itemx u @var{location}
4665 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4666 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4667 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4668 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4669 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4670 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4671 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4672 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4673 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4674 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4675 invocations have returned.
4676
4677 @smallexample
4678 94 int factorial (int value)
4679 95 @{
4680 96 if (value > 1) @{
4681 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4682 98 @}
4683 99 return (value);
4684 100 @}
4685 @end smallexample
4686
4687
4688 @kindex advance @var{location}
4689 @itemx advance @var{location}
4690 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4691 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4692 @ref{Specify Location}.
4693 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4694 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4695 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4696 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4697
4698
4699 @kindex stepi
4700 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4701 @item stepi
4702 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4703 @itemx si
4704 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4705
4706 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4707 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4708 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4709 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4710
4711 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4712
4713 @need 750
4714 @kindex nexti
4715 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4716 @item nexti
4717 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4718 @itemx ni
4719 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4720 proceed until the function returns.
4721
4722 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4723 @end table
4724
4725 @node Signals
4726 @section Signals
4727 @cindex signals
4728
4729 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4730 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4731 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4732 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4733 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4734 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4735 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4736 requested an alarm).
4737
4738 @cindex fatal signals
4739 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4740 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4741 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4742 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4743 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4744 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4745
4746 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4747 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4748 signal.
4749
4750 @cindex handling signals
4751 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4752 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4753 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4754 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4755 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4756
4757 @table @code
4758 @kindex info signals
4759 @kindex info handle
4760 @item info signals
4761 @itemx info handle
4762 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4763 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4764 the defined types of signals.
4765
4766 @item info signals @var{sig}
4767 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4768
4769 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4770
4771 @kindex handle
4772 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4773 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4774 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4775 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4776 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4777 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4778 say what change to make.
4779 @end table
4780
4781 @c @group
4782 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4783 Their full names are:
4784
4785 @table @code
4786 @item nostop
4787 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4788 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4789
4790 @item stop
4791 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4792 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4793
4794 @item print
4795 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4796
4797 @item noprint
4798 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4799 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4800
4801 @item pass
4802 @itemx noignore
4803 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4804 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4805 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4806
4807 @item nopass
4808 @itemx ignore
4809 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4810 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4811 @end table
4812 @c @end group
4813
4814 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4815 program until you
4816 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4817 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4818 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4819 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4820 program sees that signal when you continue.
4821
4822 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4823 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4824 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4825 erroneous signals.
4826
4827 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4828 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4829 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4830 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4831 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4832 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4833 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4834 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4835 Program a Signal}.
4836
4837 @cindex extra signal information
4838 @anchor{extra signal information}
4839
4840 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4841 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4842 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4843 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4844 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4845 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4846 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4847 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4848 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4849 system header.
4850
4851 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4852 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4853
4854 @smallexample
4855 @group
4856 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4857 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4858 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4859 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4860 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4861 type = struct @{
4862 int si_signo;
4863 int si_errno;
4864 int si_code;
4865 union @{
4866 int _pad[28];
4867 struct @{...@} _kill;
4868 struct @{...@} _timer;
4869 struct @{...@} _rt;
4870 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4871 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4872 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4873 @} _sifields;
4874 @}
4875 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4876 type = struct @{
4877 void *si_addr;
4878 @}
4879 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4880 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4881 @end group
4882 @end smallexample
4883
4884 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4885
4886 @node Thread Stops
4887 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4888
4889 @cindex stopped threads
4890 @cindex threads, stopped
4891
4892 @cindex continuing threads
4893 @cindex threads, continuing
4894
4895 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4896 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4897 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4898 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4899 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4900 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4901 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4902 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4903 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4904
4905 @menu
4906 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4907 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4908 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4909 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4910 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4911 @end menu
4912
4913 @node All-Stop Mode
4914 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4915
4916 @cindex all-stop mode
4917
4918 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4919 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4920 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4921 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4922 underfoot.
4923
4924 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4925 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4926 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4927
4928 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4929 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4930 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4931 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4932 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4933 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4934 stops.
4935
4936 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4937 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4938 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4939 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4940
4941 @cindex automatic thread selection
4942 @cindex switching threads automatically
4943 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4944 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4945 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4946 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4947 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4948 thread.
4949
4950 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4951 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4952
4953 @table @code
4954 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4955 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4956 @cindex lock scheduler
4957 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4958 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4959 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4960 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4961 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4962 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4963 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4964 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4965 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4966 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4967 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4968 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4969
4970 @item show scheduler-locking
4971 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4972 @end table
4973
4974 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
4975 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
4976 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
4977 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
4978 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
4979 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
4980 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
4981 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
4982 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
4983 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
4984 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
4985 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
4986 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
4987 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
4988
4989 @table @code
4990 @kindex set schedule-multiple
4991 @item set schedule-multiple
4992 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
4993 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
4994 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
4995 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
4996 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
4997 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
4998
4999 @item show schedule-multiple
5000 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5001 multiple processes.
5002 @end table
5003
5004 @node Non-Stop Mode
5005 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5006
5007 @cindex non-stop mode
5008
5009 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5010 @c with more details.
5011
5012 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5013 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5014 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5015 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5016 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5017 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5018
5019 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5020 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5021 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5022 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5023 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5024 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5025 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5026 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5027 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5028 independently and simultaneously.
5029
5030 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5031 or attach to your program:
5032
5033 @smallexample
5034 # Enable the async interface.
5035 set target-async 1
5036
5037 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5038 set pagination off
5039
5040 # Finally, turn it on!
5041 set non-stop on
5042 @end smallexample
5043
5044 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5045
5046 @table @code
5047 @kindex set non-stop
5048 @item set non-stop on
5049 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5050 @item set non-stop off
5051 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5052 @kindex show non-stop
5053 @item show non-stop
5054 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5055 @end table
5056
5057 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5058 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5059 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5060 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5061 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5062 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5063 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5064 default.
5065
5066 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5067 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5068 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5069
5070 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5071 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5072 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5073 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5074 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5075
5076 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5077 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5078 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5079 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5080 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5081
5082 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5083
5084 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5085 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5086 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5087 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5088 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5089 previously current thread.
5090
5091 @node Background Execution
5092 @subsection Background Execution
5093
5094 @cindex foreground execution
5095 @cindex background execution
5096 @cindex asynchronous execution
5097 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5098
5099 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5100 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5101 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5102 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5103 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5104 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5105
5106 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5107 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5108 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5109
5110 @table @code
5111 @kindex set target-async
5112 @item set target-async on
5113 Enable asynchronous mode.
5114 @item set target-async off
5115 Disable asynchronous mode.
5116 @kindex show target-async
5117 @item show target-async
5118 Show the current target-async setting.
5119 @end table
5120
5121 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5122 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5123
5124 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5125 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5126 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5127 are:
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @kindex run&
5131 @item run
5132 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5133
5134 @item attach
5135 @kindex attach&
5136 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5137
5138 @item step
5139 @kindex step&
5140 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5141
5142 @item stepi
5143 @kindex stepi&
5144 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5145
5146 @item next
5147 @kindex next&
5148 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5149
5150 @item nexti
5151 @kindex nexti&
5152 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5153
5154 @item continue
5155 @kindex continue&
5156 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5157
5158 @item finish
5159 @kindex finish&
5160 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5161
5162 @item until
5163 @kindex until&
5164 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5165
5166 @end table
5167
5168 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5169 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5170 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5171 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5172 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5173 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5174
5175 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5176 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5177
5178 @table @code
5179 @kindex interrupt
5180 @item interrupt
5181 @itemx interrupt -a
5182
5183 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5184 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5185 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5186 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5190 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5191
5192 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5193 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5194 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5195
5196 @table @code
5197 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5198 @cindex thread breakpoints
5199 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5200 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5201 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5202 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5203 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5204 specify some source line.
5205
5206 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5207 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5208 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5209 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5210 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5211
5212 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5213 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5214 program.
5215
5216 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5217 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5218 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5219
5220 @smallexample
5221 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5222 @end smallexample
5223
5224 @end table
5225
5226 @node Interrupted System Calls
5227 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5228
5229 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5230 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5231 @cindex premature return from system calls
5232 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5233 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5234 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5235 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5236 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5237 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5238 stop execution.
5239
5240 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5241 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5242 style anyways.
5243
5244 For example, do not write code like this:
5245
5246 @smallexample
5247 sleep (10);
5248 @end smallexample
5249
5250 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5251 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5252
5253 Instead, write this:
5254
5255 @smallexample
5256 int unslept = 10;
5257 while (unslept > 0)
5258 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5259 @end smallexample
5260
5261 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5262 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5263 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5264 @value{GDBN}.
5265
5266 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5267 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5268 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5269 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5270
5271
5272 @node Reverse Execution
5273 @chapter Running programs backward
5274 @cindex reverse execution
5275 @cindex running programs backward
5276
5277 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5278 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5279 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5280 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5281
5282 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5283 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5284 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5285 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5286 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5287 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5288
5289 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5290 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5291 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5292 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5293 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5294 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5295 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5296 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5297 prior values@footnote{
5298 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5299 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5300 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5301
5302 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5303 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5304 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5305 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5306 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5307 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5308 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5309 }.
5310
5311 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5312 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5313
5314 @table @code
5315 @kindex reverse-continue
5316 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5317 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5318 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5319 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5320 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5321 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5322 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5323
5324 @kindex reverse-step
5325 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5326 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5327 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5328 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5329
5330 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5331 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5332 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5333 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5334 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5335 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5336
5337 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5338 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5339
5340 @kindex reverse-stepi
5341 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5342 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5343 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5344 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5345 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5346 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5347 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5348
5349 @kindex reverse-next
5350 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5351 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5352 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5353 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5354 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5355 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5356 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5357 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5358 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5359 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5360
5361 @kindex reverse-nexti
5362 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5363 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5364 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5365 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5366 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5367 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5368 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5369 frame) is reached.
5370
5371 @kindex reverse-finish
5372 @item reverse-finish
5373 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5374 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5375 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5376 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5377
5378 @kindex set exec-direction
5379 @item set exec-direction
5380 Set the direction of target execution.
5381 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5382 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5383 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5384 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5385 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5386 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5387 @item set exec-direction forward
5388 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5389 This is the default.
5390 @end table
5391
5392
5393 @node Process Record and Replay
5394 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5395 @cindex process record and replay
5396 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5397
5398 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5399 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5400 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5401
5402 @cindex replay mode
5403 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5404 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5405 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5406 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5407 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5408 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5409 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5410 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5411 execution log.
5412
5413 @cindex record mode
5414 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5415 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5416 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5417 for future replay.
5418
5419 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5420 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5421 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5422 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5423 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5424 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5425
5426 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5427 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5428 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5429 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5430
5431 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5432 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5433
5434 @table @code
5435 @kindex target record
5436 @kindex record
5437 @kindex rec
5438 @item target record
5439 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5440 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5441 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5442 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5443 the @kbd{target record} command.
5444
5445 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5446
5447 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5448 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5449 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5450 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5451 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5452
5453 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5454 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5455 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5456 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5457 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5458 support these two modes.
5459
5460 @kindex record stop
5461 @kindex rec s
5462 @item record stop
5463 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5464 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5465 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5466
5467 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5468 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5469 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5470 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5471 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5472
5473 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5474 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5475 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5476 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5477 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5478
5479 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5480 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5481
5482 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5483 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5484 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5485
5486 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5487 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5488 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5489 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5490 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5491 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5492 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5493 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5494
5495 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5496 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5497 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5498
5499 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5500 @item show record insn-number-max
5501 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5502
5503 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5504 @item set record stop-at-limit
5505 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5506 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5507 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5508 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5509 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5510 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5511
5512 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5513 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5514
5515 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5516 @item show record stop-at-limit
5517 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5518
5519 @kindex info record
5520 @item info record
5521 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5522 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5523
5524 @itemize @bullet
5525 @item
5526 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5527 @item
5528 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5529 @item
5530 Highest recorded instruction number.
5531 @item
5532 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5533 @item
5534 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5535 @item
5536 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5537 @end itemize
5538
5539 @kindex record delete
5540 @kindex rec del
5541 @item record delete
5542 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5543 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5544 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5545 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5546 @end table
5547
5548
5549 @node Stack
5550 @chapter Examining the Stack
5551
5552 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5553 stopped and how it got there.
5554
5555 @cindex call stack
5556 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5557 is generated.
5558 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5559 the arguments of the call,
5560 and the local variables of the function being called.
5561 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5562 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5563 stack}.
5564
5565 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5566 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5567
5568 @cindex selected frame
5569 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5570 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5571 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5572 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5573 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5574 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5575
5576 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5577 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5578 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5579
5580 @menu
5581 * Frames:: Stack frames
5582 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5583 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5584 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5585
5586 @end menu
5587
5588 @node Frames
5589 @section Stack Frames
5590
5591 @cindex frame, definition
5592 @cindex stack frame
5593 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5594 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5595 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5596 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5597 which the function is executing.
5598
5599 @cindex initial frame
5600 @cindex outermost frame
5601 @cindex innermost frame
5602 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5603 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5604 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5605 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5606 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5607 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5608 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5609 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5610
5611 @cindex frame pointer
5612 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5613 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5614 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5615 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5616 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5617 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5618
5619 @cindex frame number
5620 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5621 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5622 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5623 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5624 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5625
5626 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5627 @c underflow problems.
5628 @cindex frameless execution
5629 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5630 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5631 @smallexample
5632 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5633 @end smallexample
5634 generates functions without a frame.)
5635 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5636 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5637 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5638 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5639 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5640 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5641 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5642
5643 @table @code
5644 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5645 @cindex current stack frame
5646 @item frame @var{args}
5647 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5648 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5649 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5650 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5651
5652 @kindex select-frame
5653 @cindex selecting frame silently
5654 @item select-frame
5655 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5656 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5657 @code{frame}.
5658 @end table
5659
5660 @node Backtrace
5661 @section Backtraces
5662
5663 @cindex traceback
5664 @cindex call stack traces
5665 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5666 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5667 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5668 stack.
5669
5670 @table @code
5671 @kindex backtrace
5672 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5673 @item backtrace
5674 @itemx bt
5675 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5676 frames in the stack.
5677
5678 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5679 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5680
5681 @item backtrace @var{n}
5682 @itemx bt @var{n}
5683 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5684
5685 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5686 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5687 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5688
5689 @item backtrace full
5690 @itemx bt full
5691 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5692 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5693 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5694 number of frames to print, as described above.
5695 @end table
5696
5697 @kindex where
5698 @kindex info stack
5699 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5700 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5701
5702 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5703 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5704 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5705 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5706 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5707 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5708 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5709 multi-threaded program.
5710
5711 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5712 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5713 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5714 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5715 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5716 line number.
5717
5718 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5719 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5724 at builtin.c:993
5725 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5726 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5727 at macro.c:71
5728 (More stack frames follow...)
5729 @end group
5730 @end smallexample
5731
5732 @noindent
5733 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5734 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5735 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5736
5737 @noindent
5738 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5739 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5740 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5741 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5742 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5743
5744 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5745 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5746 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5747 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5748 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5749 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5750 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5751 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5752 such a backtrace might look like:
5753
5754 @smallexample
5755 @group
5756 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5757 at builtin.c:993
5758 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5759 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5760 at macro.c:71
5761 (More stack frames follow...)
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 @noindent
5766 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5767 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5768
5769 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5770 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5771 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5772
5773 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5774 @cindex program entry point
5775 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5776 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5777 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5778 @code{main}@footnote{
5779 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5780 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5781 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5782 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5783 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5784 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5785
5786 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5787 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5788
5789 @table @code
5790 @item set backtrace past-main
5791 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5792 @kindex set backtrace
5793 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5794
5795 @item set backtrace past-main off
5796 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5797 default.
5798
5799 @item show backtrace past-main
5800 @kindex show backtrace
5801 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5802
5803 @item set backtrace past-entry
5804 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5805 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5806 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5807 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5808
5809 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5810 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5811 application. This is the default.
5812
5813 @item show backtrace past-entry
5814 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5815
5816 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5817 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5818 @cindex backtrace limit
5819 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5820 unlimited.
5821
5822 @item show backtrace limit
5823 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5824 @end table
5825
5826 @node Selection
5827 @section Selecting a Frame
5828
5829 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5830 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5831 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5832 of the stack frame just selected.
5833
5834 @table @code
5835 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5836 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5837 @item frame @var{n}
5838 @itemx f @var{n}
5839 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5840 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5841 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5842 @code{main}.
5843
5844 @item frame @var{addr}
5845 @itemx f @var{addr}
5846 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5847 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5848 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5849 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5850 switches between them.
5851
5852 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5853 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5854
5855 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5856 pointer and a program counter.
5857
5858 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5859 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5860
5861 @kindex up
5862 @item up @var{n}
5863 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5864 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5865 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5866
5867 @kindex down
5868 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5869 @item down @var{n}
5870 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5871 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5872 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5873 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5874 @end table
5875
5876 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5877 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5878 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5879 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5880
5881 @need 1000
5882 For example:
5883
5884 @smallexample
5885 @group
5886 (@value{GDBP}) up
5887 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5888 at env.c:10
5889 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5890 @end group
5891 @end smallexample
5892
5893 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5894 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5895 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5896 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5897 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5898 for details.
5899
5900 @table @code
5901 @kindex down-silently
5902 @kindex up-silently
5903 @item up-silently @var{n}
5904 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5905 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5906 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5907 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5908 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5909 distracting.
5910 @end table
5911
5912 @node Frame Info
5913 @section Information About a Frame
5914
5915 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5916 stack frame.
5917
5918 @table @code
5919 @item frame
5920 @itemx f
5921 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5922 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5923 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5924 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5925 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5926
5927 @kindex info frame
5928 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5929 @item info frame
5930 @itemx info f
5931 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5932 including:
5933
5934 @itemize @bullet
5935 @item
5936 the address of the frame
5937 @item
5938 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5939 @item
5940 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5941 @item
5942 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5943 @item
5944 the address of the frame's arguments
5945 @item
5946 the address of the frame's local variables
5947 @item
5948 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5949 @item
5950 which registers were saved in the frame
5951 @end itemize
5952
5953 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5954 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5955 the usual conventions.
5956
5957 @item info frame @var{addr}
5958 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5959 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5960 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5961 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5962 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5963 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5964
5965 @kindex info args
5966 @item info args
5967 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5968
5969 @item info locals
5970 @kindex info locals
5971 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5972 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5973 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5974
5975 @kindex info catch
5976 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5977 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5978 @item info catch
5979 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5980 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5981 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5982 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5983 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5984
5985 @end table
5986
5987
5988 @node Source
5989 @chapter Examining Source Files
5990
5991 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5992 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5993 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5994 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5995 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5996 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5997 source files by explicit command.
5998
5999 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6000 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6001 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6002
6003 @menu
6004 * List:: Printing source lines
6005 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6006 * Edit:: Editing source files
6007 * Search:: Searching source files
6008 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6009 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6010 @end menu
6011
6012 @node List
6013 @section Printing Source Lines
6014
6015 @kindex list
6016 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6017 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6018 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6019 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6020 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6021
6022 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6023
6024 @table @code
6025 @item list @var{linenum}
6026 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6027 current source file.
6028
6029 @item list @var{function}
6030 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6031 @var{function}.
6032
6033 @item list
6034 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6035 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6036 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6037 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6038 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6039
6040 @item list -
6041 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6045 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6046 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6047
6048 @table @code
6049 @kindex set listsize
6050 @item set listsize @var{count}
6051 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6052 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6053
6054 @kindex show listsize
6055 @item show listsize
6056 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6057 @end table
6058
6059 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6060 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6061 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6062 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6063 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6064
6065 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6066 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6067 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6068 to specify some source line.
6069
6070 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @item list @var{linespec}
6074 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6075
6076 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6077 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6078 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6079 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6080 the same source file as the first linespec.
6081
6082 @item list ,@var{last}
6083 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6084
6085 @item list @var{first},
6086 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6087
6088 @item list +
6089 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6090
6091 @item list -
6092 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6093
6094 @item list
6095 As described in the preceding table.
6096 @end table
6097
6098 @node Specify Location
6099 @section Specifying a Location
6100 @cindex specifying location
6101 @cindex linespec
6102
6103 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6104 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6105 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6106 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6107
6108 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6109 @value{GDBN} understands:
6110
6111 @table @code
6112 @item @var{linenum}
6113 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6114
6115 @item -@var{offset}
6116 @itemx +@var{offset}
6117 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6118 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6119 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6120 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6121 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6122 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6123 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6124 linespec.
6125
6126 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6127 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6128
6129 @item @var{function}
6130 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6131 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6132
6133 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6134 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6135 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6136 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6137 functions in different source files.
6138
6139 @item *@var{address}
6140 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6141 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6142 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6143 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6144 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6145 source files.
6146
6147 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6148 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6149 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6150 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6151 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6152 of @var{address}:
6153
6154 @table @code
6155 @item @var{expression}
6156 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6157
6158 @item @var{funcaddr}
6159 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6160 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6161 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6162 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6163 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6164 (although the Pascal form also works).
6165
6166 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6167 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6168
6169 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6170 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6171 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6172 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6173 functions with identical names in different source files.
6174 @end table
6175
6176 @end table
6177
6178
6179 @node Edit
6180 @section Editing Source Files
6181 @cindex editing source files
6182
6183 @kindex edit
6184 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6185 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6186 The editing program of your choice
6187 is invoked with the current line set to
6188 the active line in the program.
6189 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6190 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6191
6192 @table @code
6193 @item edit @var{location}
6194 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6195 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6196 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6197 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6198 command most commonly used:
6199
6200 @table @code
6201 @item edit @var{number}
6202 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6203
6204 @item edit @var{function}
6205 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6206 @end table
6207
6208 @end table
6209
6210 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6211 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6212 @footnote{
6213 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6214 following command-line syntax:
6215 @smallexample
6216 ex +@var{number} file
6217 @end smallexample
6218 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6219 the file where to start editing.}.
6220 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6221 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6222 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6223 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6224 @smallexample
6225 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6226 export EDITOR
6227 gdb @dots{}
6228 @end smallexample
6229 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6230 @smallexample
6231 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6232 gdb @dots{}
6233 @end smallexample
6234
6235 @node Search
6236 @section Searching Source Files
6237 @cindex searching source files
6238
6239 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6240 regular expression.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @kindex search
6244 @kindex forward-search
6245 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6246 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6247 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6248 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6249 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6250 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6251 @code{fo}.
6252
6253 @kindex reverse-search
6254 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6255 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6256 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6257 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6258 this command as @code{rev}.
6259 @end table
6260
6261 @node Source Path
6262 @section Specifying Source Directories
6263
6264 @cindex source path
6265 @cindex directories for source files
6266 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6267 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6268 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6269 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6270 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6271 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6272 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6273
6274 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6275 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6276 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6277 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6278 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6279 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6280 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6281 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6282 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6283 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6284 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6285
6286 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6287 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6288 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6289 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6290 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6291 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6292
6293 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6294 source files.
6295
6296 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6297 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6298 each line is in the file.
6299
6300 @kindex directory
6301 @kindex dir
6302 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6303 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6304 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6305
6306 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6307 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6308
6309 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6310 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6311 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6312 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6313 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6314 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6315 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6316 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6317 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6318 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6319 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6320 name to look up the sources.
6321
6322 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6323 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6324 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6325 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6326 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6327 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6328 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6329 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6330
6331 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6332 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6333 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6334 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6335 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6336 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6337 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6338
6339 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6340 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6341 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6342 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6343 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6344 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6345 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6346 command.
6347
6348 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6349 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6350 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6351 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6352 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6353 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6354 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6355
6356 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6357 @cindex default source path substitution
6358 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6359 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6360 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6361 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6362 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6363 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6364 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6365 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6366 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6367 together.
6368
6369 @table @code
6370 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6371 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6372 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6373 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6374 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6375 part of absolute file names) or
6376 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6377 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6378
6379 @kindex cdir
6380 @kindex cwd
6381 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6382 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6383 @cindex compilation directory
6384 @cindex current directory
6385 @cindex working directory
6386 @cindex directory, current
6387 @cindex directory, compilation
6388 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6389 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6390 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6391 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6392 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6393 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6394
6395 @item directory
6396 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6397
6398 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6399 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6400
6401 @item show directories
6402 @kindex show directories
6403 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6404
6405 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6406 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6407 @kindex set substitute-path
6408 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6409 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6410 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6411
6412 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6413 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6414
6415 @smallexample
6416 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6417 @end smallexample
6418
6419 @noindent
6420 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6421 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6422 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6423
6424 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6425 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6426 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6427 the substitution.
6428
6429 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6430
6431 @smallexample
6432 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6433 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6434 @end smallexample
6435
6436 @noindent
6437 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6438 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6439 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6440 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6441
6442
6443 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6444 @kindex unset substitute-path
6445 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6446 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6447 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6448
6449 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6450
6451 @item show substitute-path [path]
6452 @kindex show substitute-path
6453 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6454 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6455
6456 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6457 rules.
6458
6459 @end table
6460
6461 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6462 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6463 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6464
6465 @enumerate
6466 @item
6467 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6468
6469 @item
6470 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6471 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6472 directories in one command.
6473 @end enumerate
6474
6475 @node Machine Code
6476 @section Source and Machine Code
6477 @cindex source line and its code address
6478
6479 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6480 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6481 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6482 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6483 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6484 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6485 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6486 well as hex.
6487
6488 @table @code
6489 @kindex info line
6490 @item info line @var{linespec}
6491 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6492 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6493 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6494 @end table
6495
6496 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6497 the object code for the first line of function
6498 @code{m4_changequote}:
6499
6500 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6501 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6502 @smallexample
6503 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6504 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6505 @end smallexample
6506
6507 @noindent
6508 @cindex code address and its source line
6509 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6510 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6511 @smallexample
6512 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6513 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6514 @end smallexample
6515
6516 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6517 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6518 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6519 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6520 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6521 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6522 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6523 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6524 Variables}).
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @kindex disassemble
6528 @cindex assembly instructions
6529 @cindex instructions, assembly
6530 @cindex machine instructions
6531 @cindex listing machine instructions
6532 @item disassemble
6533 @itemx disassemble /m
6534 @itemx disassemble /r
6535 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6536 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6537 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6538 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6539 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6540 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6541 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6542 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6543 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6544 arguments specify a range of addresses (first inclusive, second exclusive)
6545 to dump. In that case, the name of the function is also printed (since
6546 there could be several functions in the given range).
6547
6548 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6549 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6550
6551 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6552 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6553 @end table
6554
6555 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6556 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6557
6558 @smallexample
6559 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6560 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6561 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6562 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6563 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6564 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6565 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6566 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6567 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6568 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6569 End of assembler dump.
6570 @end smallexample
6571
6572 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6573 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6574
6575 @smallexample
6576 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6577 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6578 5 @{
6579 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6580 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6581 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6582 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6583 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6584
6585 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6586 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6587 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6588
6589 7 return 0;
6590 8 @}
6591 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6592 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6593 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6594
6595 End of assembler dump.
6596 @end smallexample
6597
6598 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6599 mnemonics or other syntax.
6600
6601 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6602 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6603 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6604 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6605 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6606
6607 @table @code
6608 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6609 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6610 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6611 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6612 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6613 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6614
6615 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6616 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6617 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6618 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6619
6620 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6621 @item show disassembly-flavor
6622 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6623 @end table
6624
6625 @table @code
6626 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6627 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6628 @item set disassemble-next-line
6629 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6630 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6631 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6632 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6633 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6634 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6635 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6636 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6637 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6638 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6639 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6640 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6641 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6642 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6643 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6644 instruction.
6645 @end table
6646
6647
6648 @node Data
6649 @chapter Examining Data
6650
6651 @cindex printing data
6652 @cindex examining data
6653 @kindex print
6654 @kindex inspect
6655 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6656 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6657 @c different window or something like that.
6658 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6659 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6660 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6661 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6662 Different Languages}).
6663
6664 @table @code
6665 @item print @var{expr}
6666 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6667 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6668 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6669 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6670 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6671 Formats}.
6672
6673 @item print
6674 @itemx print /@var{f}
6675 @cindex reprint the last value
6676 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6677 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6678 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6679 @end table
6680
6681 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6682 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6683 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6684
6685 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6686 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6687 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6688 Table}.
6689
6690 @menu
6691 * Expressions:: Expressions
6692 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6693 * Variables:: Program variables
6694 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6695 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6696 * Memory:: Examining memory
6697 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6698 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6699 * Value History:: Value history
6700 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6701 * Registers:: Registers
6702 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6703 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6704 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6705 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6706 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6707 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6708 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6709 character set than GDB does
6710 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6711 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6712 @end menu
6713
6714 @node Expressions
6715 @section Expressions
6716
6717 @cindex expressions
6718 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6719 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6720 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6721 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6722 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6723 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6724 @ref{Compilation}.
6725
6726 @cindex arrays in expressions
6727 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6728 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6729 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6730 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6731 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6732 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6733
6734 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6735 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6736 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6737 languages.
6738
6739 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6740 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6741
6742 @cindex casts, in expressions
6743 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6744 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6745 at that address in memory.
6746 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6747
6748 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6749 to programming languages:
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @item @@
6753 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6754 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6755
6756 @item ::
6757 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6758 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6759
6760 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6761 @cindex type casting memory
6762 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6763 @cindex casts, to view memory
6764 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6765 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6766 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6767 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6768 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6769 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6770 @end table
6771
6772 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6773 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6774 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6775
6776 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6777 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6778 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6779 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6780 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6781 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6782 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6783
6784 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6785 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6786 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6787 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6788 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6789 as well.
6790
6791 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6792 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6793 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6794 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6795 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6796 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6797 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6798 choices.
6799
6800 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6801 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6802 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6803
6804 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6805 @smallexample
6806 @group
6807 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6808 [0] cancel
6809 [1] all
6810 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6811 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6812 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6813 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6814 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6815 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6816 > 2 4 6
6817 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6818 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6819 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6820 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6821 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6822 breakpoints.
6823 (@value{GDBP})
6824 @end group
6825 @end smallexample
6826
6827 @table @code
6828 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6829 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6830 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6831
6832 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6833 is ambiguous.
6834
6835 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6836 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6837 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6838 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6839 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6840 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6841 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6842 in the use of the menu.
6843
6844 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6845 when an ambiguity is detected.
6846
6847 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6848 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6849
6850 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6851 @item show multiple-symbols
6852 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6853 @end table
6854
6855 @node Variables
6856 @section Program Variables
6857
6858 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6859 in your program.
6860
6861 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6862 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6863
6864 @itemize @bullet
6865 @item
6866 global (or file-static)
6867 @end itemize
6868
6869 @noindent or
6870
6871 @itemize @bullet
6872 @item
6873 visible according to the scope rules of the
6874 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6875 @end itemize
6876
6877 @noindent This means that in the function
6878
6879 @smallexample
6880 foo (a)
6881 int a;
6882 @{
6883 bar (a);
6884 @{
6885 int b = test ();
6886 bar (b);
6887 @}
6888 @}
6889 @end smallexample
6890
6891 @noindent
6892 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6893 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6894 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6895 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6896
6897 @cindex variable name conflict
6898 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6899 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6900 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6901 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6902 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6903 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6904 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6905
6906 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6907 @ifnotinfo
6908 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6909 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6910 @end ifnotinfo
6911 @smallexample
6912 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6913 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6914 @end smallexample
6915
6916 @noindent
6917 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6918 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6919 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6920 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6921
6922 @smallexample
6923 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6924 @end smallexample
6925
6926 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6927 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6928 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6929 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6930 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6931 @c conflict?? --mew
6932
6933 @cindex wrong values
6934 @cindex variable values, wrong
6935 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6936 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6937 @quotation
6938 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6939 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6940 scope, and just before exit.
6941 @end quotation
6942 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6943 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6944 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6945 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6946 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6947 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6948 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6949 variable definitions may be gone.
6950
6951 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6952 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6953 when compiling.
6954
6955 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6956 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6957 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6958 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6959 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6960 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6961 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6962
6963 @smallexample
6964 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6965 @end smallexample
6966
6967 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6968 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6969 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6970 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6971 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6972 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6973 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6974 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6975 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6976 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6977 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6978
6979 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6980 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6981 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6982 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6983
6984 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6985 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6986 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6987 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6988 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6989 For program code
6990
6991 @smallexample
6992 char var0[] = "A";
6993 signed char var1[] = "A";
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 You get during debugging
6997 @smallexample
6998 (gdb) print var0
6999 $1 = "A"
7000 (gdb) print var1
7001 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7002 @end smallexample
7003
7004 @node Arrays
7005 @section Artificial Arrays
7006
7007 @cindex artificial array
7008 @cindex arrays
7009 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7010 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7011 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7012 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7013 program.
7014
7015 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7016 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7017 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7018 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7019 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7020 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7021 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7022 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7023 example. If a program says
7024
7025 @smallexample
7026 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7027 @end smallexample
7028
7029 @noindent
7030 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7031
7032 @smallexample
7033 p *array@@len
7034 @end smallexample
7035
7036 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7037 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7038 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7039 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7040 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7041
7042 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7043 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7044 The value need not be in memory:
7045 @smallexample
7046 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7047 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7048 @end smallexample
7049
7050 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7051 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7052 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7053 @smallexample
7054 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7055 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7056 @end smallexample
7057
7058 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7059 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7060 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7061 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7062 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7063 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7064 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7065 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7066 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7067 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7068
7069 @smallexample
7070 set $i = 0
7071 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7072 @key{RET}
7073 @key{RET}
7074 @dots{}
7075 @end smallexample
7076
7077 @node Output Formats
7078 @section Output Formats
7079
7080 @cindex formatted output
7081 @cindex output formats
7082 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7083 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7084 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7085 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7086 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7087
7088 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7089 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7090 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7091 letters supported are:
7092
7093 @table @code
7094 @item x
7095 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7096 hexadecimal.
7097
7098 @item d
7099 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7100
7101 @item u
7102 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7103
7104 @item o
7105 Print as integer in octal.
7106
7107 @item t
7108 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7109 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7110 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7111 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7112
7113 @item a
7114 @cindex unknown address, locating
7115 @cindex locate address
7116 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7117 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7118 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7119
7120 @smallexample
7121 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7122 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7123 @end smallexample
7124
7125 @noindent
7126 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7127 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7128
7129 @item c
7130 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7131 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7132 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7133 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7134
7135 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7136 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7137 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7138 data.
7139
7140 @item f
7141 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7142 using typical floating point syntax.
7143
7144 @item s
7145 @cindex printing strings
7146 @cindex printing byte arrays
7147 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7148 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7149 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7150 natural types.
7151
7152 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7153 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7154 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7155 array.
7156
7157 @item r
7158 @cindex raw printing
7159 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7160 use a type-specific pretty-printer. The @samp{r} format bypasses any
7161 pretty-printer which might exist for the value's type.
7162 @end table
7163
7164 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7165
7166 @smallexample
7167 p/x $pc
7168 @end smallexample
7169
7170 @noindent
7171 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7172 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7173
7174 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7175 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7176 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7177
7178 @node Memory
7179 @section Examining Memory
7180
7181 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7182 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7183
7184 @cindex examining memory
7185 @table @code
7186 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7187 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7188 @itemx x @var{addr}
7189 @itemx x
7190 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7194 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7195 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7196 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7197 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7198
7199 @table @r
7200 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7201 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7202 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7203 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7204 @c 4.1.2.
7205
7206 @item @var{f}, the display format
7207 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7208 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7209 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7210 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7211 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7212
7213 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7214 The unit size is any of
7215
7216 @table @code
7217 @item b
7218 Bytes.
7219 @item h
7220 Halfwords (two bytes).
7221 @item w
7222 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7223 @item g
7224 Giant words (eight bytes).
7225 @end table
7226
7227 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7228 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
7229 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
7230
7231 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7232 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7233 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7234 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7235 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7236 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7237 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7238 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7239 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7240 a value from memory).
7241 @end table
7242
7243 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7244 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7245 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7246 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7247 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7248
7249 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7250 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7251 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7252 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7253 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7254
7255 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7256 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7257 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7258 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7259 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7260 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7261 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7262 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7263 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7264
7265 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7266 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7267 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7268 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7269 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7270 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7271 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7272
7273 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7274 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7275
7276 @smallexample
7277 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7278 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7279 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7280 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7281 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7282 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7283 @end smallexample
7284
7285 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7286 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7287 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7288 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7289 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7290 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7291 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7292 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7293 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7294
7295 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7296 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7297 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7298
7299 @cindex remote memory comparison
7300 @cindex verify remote memory image
7301 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7302 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7303 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7304 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7305 situations.
7306
7307 @table @code
7308 @kindex compare-sections
7309 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7310 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7311 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7312 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7313 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7314 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7315 remote request.
7316 @end table
7317
7318 @node Auto Display
7319 @section Automatic Display
7320 @cindex automatic display
7321 @cindex display of expressions
7322
7323 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7324 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7325 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7326 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7327 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7328 The automatic display looks like this:
7329
7330 @smallexample
7331 2: foo = 38
7332 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 @noindent
7336 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7337 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7338 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7339 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7340 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7341 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7342
7343 @table @code
7344 @kindex display
7345 @item display @var{expr}
7346 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7347 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7348
7349 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7350
7351 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7352 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7353 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7354 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7355 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7356
7357 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7358 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7359 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7360 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7361 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7362 @end table
7363
7364 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7365 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7366 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7367
7368 @table @code
7369 @kindex delete display
7370 @kindex undisplay
7371 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7372 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7373 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7374
7375 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7376 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7377
7378 @kindex disable display
7379 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7380 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7381 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7382 enabled again later.
7383
7384 @kindex enable display
7385 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7386 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7387 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7388
7389 @item display
7390 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7391 done when your program stops.
7392
7393 @kindex info display
7394 @item info display
7395 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7396 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7397 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7398 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7399 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7400 @end table
7401
7402 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7403 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7404 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7405 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7406 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7407 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7408 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7409 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7410 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7411 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7412 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7413
7414 @node Print Settings
7415 @section Print Settings
7416
7417 @cindex format options
7418 @cindex print settings
7419 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7420 and symbols are printed.
7421
7422 @noindent
7423 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7424
7425 @table @code
7426 @kindex set print
7427 @item set print address
7428 @itemx set print address on
7429 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7430 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7431 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7432 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7433 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7434 @code{set print address on}:
7435
7436 @smallexample
7437 @group
7438 (@value{GDBP}) f
7439 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7440 at input.c:530
7441 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7442 @end group
7443 @end smallexample
7444
7445 @item set print address off
7446 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7447 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7448
7449 @smallexample
7450 @group
7451 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7452 (@value{GDBP}) f
7453 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7454 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7455 @end group
7456 @end smallexample
7457
7458 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7459 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7460 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7461 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7462
7463 @kindex show print
7464 @item show print address
7465 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7466 @end table
7467
7468 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7469 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7470 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7471 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7472 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7473 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7474 it prints a symbolic address:
7475
7476 @table @code
7477 @item set print symbol-filename on
7478 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7479 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7480 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7481 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7482
7483 @item set print symbol-filename off
7484 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7485 default.
7486
7487 @item show print symbol-filename
7488 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7489 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7490 @end table
7491
7492 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7493 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7494 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7495
7496 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7497 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7498
7499 @table @code
7500 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7501 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7502 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7503 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7504 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7505 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7506
7507 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7508 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7509 symbolic address.
7510 @end table
7511
7512 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7513 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7514 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7515 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7516 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7517 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7518 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7519 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7523 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7524 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7525 @end smallexample
7526
7527 @quotation
7528 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7529 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7530 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7531 @end quotation
7532
7533 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7534
7535 @table @code
7536 @item set print array
7537 @itemx set print array on
7538 @cindex pretty print arrays
7539 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7540 but uses more space. The default is off.
7541
7542 @item set print array off
7543 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7544
7545 @item show print array
7546 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7547 arrays.
7548
7549 @cindex print array indexes
7550 @item set print array-indexes
7551 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7552 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7553 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7554 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7555
7556 @item set print array-indexes off
7557 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7558
7559 @item show print array-indexes
7560 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7561 arrays.
7562
7563 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7564 @cindex number of array elements to print
7565 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7566 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7567 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7568 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7569 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7570 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7571 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7572
7573 @item show print elements
7574 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7575 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7576
7577 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7578 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7579 @cindex printing frame argument values
7580 @cindex print all frame argument values
7581 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7582 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7583 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7584 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7585 values are:
7586
7587 @table @code
7588 @item all
7589 The values of all arguments are printed.
7590
7591 @item scalars
7592 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7593 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7594 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7595 only scalar arguments are shown:
7596
7597 @smallexample
7598 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7599 at frame-args.c:23
7600 @end smallexample
7601
7602 @item none
7603 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7604 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7605
7606 @smallexample
7607 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7608 at frame-args.c:23
7609 @end smallexample
7610 @end table
7611
7612 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7613 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7614 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7615 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7616 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7617 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7618 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7619 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7620 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7621 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7622
7623 @item show print frame-arguments
7624 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7625
7626 @item set print repeats
7627 @cindex repeated array elements
7628 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7629 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7630 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7631 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7632 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7633 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7634 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7635
7636 @item show print repeats
7637 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7638 elements.
7639
7640 @item set print null-stop
7641 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7642 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7643 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7644 contain only short strings.
7645 The default is off.
7646
7647 @item show print null-stop
7648 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7649 @sc{null} character.
7650
7651 @item set print pretty on
7652 @cindex print structures in indented form
7653 @cindex indentation in structure display
7654 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7655 per line, like this:
7656
7657 @smallexample
7658 @group
7659 $1 = @{
7660 next = 0x0,
7661 flags = @{
7662 sweet = 1,
7663 sour = 1
7664 @},
7665 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7666 @}
7667 @end group
7668 @end smallexample
7669
7670 @item set print pretty off
7671 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7672
7673 @smallexample
7674 @group
7675 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7676 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7677 @end group
7678 @end smallexample
7679
7680 @noindent
7681 This is the default format.
7682
7683 @item show print pretty
7684 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7685
7686 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7687 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7688 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7689 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7690 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7691 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7692 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7693 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7694
7695 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7696 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7697 international character sets, and is the default.
7698
7699 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7700 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7701
7702 @item set print union on
7703 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7704 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7705 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7706
7707 @item set print union off
7708 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7709 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7710 instead.
7711
7712 @item show print union
7713 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7714 structures and other unions.
7715
7716 For example, given the declarations
7717
7718 @smallexample
7719 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7720 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7721 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7722 Bug_forms;
7723
7724 struct thing @{
7725 Species it;
7726 union @{
7727 Tree_forms tree;
7728 Bug_forms bug;
7729 @} form;
7730 @};
7731
7732 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7733 @end smallexample
7734
7735 @noindent
7736 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7737
7738 @smallexample
7739 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7740 @end smallexample
7741
7742 @noindent
7743 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7744
7745 @smallexample
7746 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7747 @end smallexample
7748
7749 @noindent
7750 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7751 and in Pascal.
7752 @end table
7753
7754 @need 1000
7755 @noindent
7756 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7760 @item set print demangle
7761 @itemx set print demangle on
7762 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7763 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7764 linkage. The default is on.
7765
7766 @item show print demangle
7767 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7768
7769 @item set print asm-demangle
7770 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7771 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7772 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7773 The default is off.
7774
7775 @item show print asm-demangle
7776 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7777 or demangled form.
7778
7779 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7780 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7781 @kindex set demangle-style
7782 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7783 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7784 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item auto
7788 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7789
7790 @item gnu
7791 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7792 This is the default.
7793
7794 @item hp
7795 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7796
7797 @item lucid
7798 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7799
7800 @item arm
7801 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7802 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7803 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7804 require further enhancement to permit that.
7805
7806 @end table
7807 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7808
7809 @item show demangle-style
7810 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7811
7812 @item set print object
7813 @itemx set print object on
7814 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7815 @cindex display derived types
7816 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7817 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7818 the virtual function table.
7819
7820 @item set print object off
7821 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7822 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7823
7824 @item show print object
7825 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7826
7827 @item set print static-members
7828 @itemx set print static-members on
7829 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7830 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7831
7832 @item set print static-members off
7833 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7834
7835 @item show print static-members
7836 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7837
7838 @item set print pascal_static-members
7839 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7840 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7841 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7842 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7843
7844 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7845 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7846
7847 @item show print pascal_static-members
7848 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7849
7850 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7851 @item set print vtbl
7852 @itemx set print vtbl on
7853 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7854 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7855 @cindex VTBL display
7856 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7857 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7858 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7859
7860 @item set print vtbl off
7861 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7862
7863 @item show print vtbl
7864 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7865 @end table
7866
7867 @node Value History
7868 @section Value History
7869
7870 @cindex value history
7871 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7872 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7873 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7874 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7875 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7876 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7877 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7878 symbol table.
7879
7880 @cindex @code{$}
7881 @cindex @code{$$}
7882 @cindex history number
7883 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7884 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7885 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7886 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7887 history number.
7888
7889 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7890 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7891 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7892 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7893 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7894 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7895 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7896
7897 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7898 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7899
7900 @smallexample
7901 p *$
7902 @end smallexample
7903
7904 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7905 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7906
7907 @smallexample
7908 p *$.next
7909 @end smallexample
7910
7911 @noindent
7912 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7913 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7914
7915 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7916 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7917
7918 @smallexample
7919 print x
7920 set x=5
7921 @end smallexample
7922
7923 @noindent
7924 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7925 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7926
7927 @table @code
7928 @kindex show values
7929 @item show values
7930 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7931 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7932 values} does not change the history.
7933
7934 @item show values @var{n}
7935 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7936
7937 @item show values +
7938 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7939 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7940 @end table
7941
7942 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7943 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7944
7945 @node Convenience Vars
7946 @section Convenience Variables
7947
7948 @cindex convenience variables
7949 @cindex user-defined variables
7950 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7951 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7952 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7953 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7954 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7955
7956 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7957 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7958 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7959 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7960 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7961
7962 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7963 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7964 For example:
7965
7966 @smallexample
7967 set $foo = *object_ptr
7968 @end smallexample
7969
7970 @noindent
7971 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7972 @code{object_ptr}.
7973
7974 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7975 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7976 value with another assignment at any time.
7977
7978 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7979 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7980 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7981 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7982
7983 @table @code
7984 @kindex show convenience
7985 @cindex show all user variables
7986 @item show convenience
7987 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7988 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7989
7990 @kindex init-if-undefined
7991 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7992 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7993 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7994 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7995 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7996 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7997 override default values used in a command script.
7998
7999 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8000 any side-effects do not occur.
8001 @end table
8002
8003 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8004 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8005 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8006
8007 @smallexample
8008 set $i = 0
8009 print bar[$i++]->contents
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 @noindent
8013 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8014
8015 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8016 values likely to be useful.
8017
8018 @table @code
8019 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8020 @item $_
8021 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8022 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8023 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8024 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8025 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8026 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8027 to the type of @code{$__}.
8028
8029 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8030 @item $__
8031 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8032 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8033 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8034
8035 @item $_exitcode
8036 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8037 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8038 the program being debugged terminates.
8039
8040 @item $_siginfo
8041 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8042 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8043 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8044 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8045 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8046 @end table
8047
8048 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8049 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8050 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8051
8052 @cindex convenience functions
8053 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8054 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8055 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8056 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8057 @value{GDBN}.
8058
8059 @table @code
8060 @item help function
8061 @kindex help function
8062 @cindex show all convenience functions
8063 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8064 @end table
8065
8066 @node Registers
8067 @section Registers
8068
8069 @cindex registers
8070 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8071 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8072 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8073 your machine.
8074
8075 @table @code
8076 @kindex info registers
8077 @item info registers
8078 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8079 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8080
8081 @kindex info all-registers
8082 @cindex floating point registers
8083 @item info all-registers
8084 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8085 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8086
8087 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8088 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8089 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8090 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8091 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8092 @end table
8093
8094 @cindex stack pointer register
8095 @cindex program counter register
8096 @cindex process status register
8097 @cindex frame pointer register
8098 @cindex standard registers
8099 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8100 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8101 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8102 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8103 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8104 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8105 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8106 you could print the program counter in hex with
8107
8108 @smallexample
8109 p/x $pc
8110 @end smallexample
8111
8112 @noindent
8113 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8114
8115 @smallexample
8116 x/i $pc
8117 @end smallexample
8118
8119 @noindent
8120 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8121 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8122 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8123 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8124 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8125 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8126 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8127
8128 @smallexample
8129 set $sp += 4
8130 @end smallexample
8131
8132 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8133 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8134 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8135 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8136 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8137 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8138 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8139
8140 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8141 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8142 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8143 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8144 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8145 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8146 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8147
8148 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8149 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8150 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8151 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8152 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8153 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8154 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8155 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8156 prints the data in both formats.
8157
8158 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8159 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8160 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8161 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8162 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8163 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8164 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8165
8166 @smallexample
8167 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8168 $1 = @{
8169 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8170 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8171 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8172 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8173 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8174 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8175 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8176 @}
8177 @end smallexample
8178
8179 @noindent
8180 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8181 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8182 value to a @code{struct} member:
8183
8184 @smallexample
8185 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8186 @end smallexample
8187
8188 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8189 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8190 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8191 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8192 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8193 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8194
8195 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8196 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8197 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8198 frame makes no difference.
8199
8200 @node Floating Point Hardware
8201 @section Floating Point Hardware
8202 @cindex floating point
8203
8204 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8205 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8206
8207 @table @code
8208 @kindex info float
8209 @item info float
8210 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8211 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8212 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8213 the ARM and x86 machines.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 @node Vector Unit
8217 @section Vector Unit
8218 @cindex vector unit
8219
8220 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8221 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8222
8223 @table @code
8224 @kindex info vector
8225 @item info vector
8226 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8227 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8228 @end table
8229
8230 @node OS Information
8231 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8232 @cindex OS information
8233
8234 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8235 you debug your program.
8236
8237 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8238 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8239 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8240 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8241 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8242 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8243 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8244 structure.
8245
8246 @table @code
8247 @item info udot
8248 @kindex info udot
8249 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8250 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8251 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8252 the @code{examine} command.
8253 @end table
8254
8255 @cindex auxiliary vector
8256 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8257 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8258 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8259 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8260 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8261 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8262 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8263 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8264 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8265 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8266 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8267 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8268
8269 @table @code
8270 @kindex info auxv
8271 @item info auxv
8272 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8273 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8274 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8275 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8276 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8277 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8278 an unrecognized tag.
8279 @end table
8280
8281 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8282 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8283 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8284 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8285
8286 @table @code
8287 @kindex info os processes
8288 @item info os processes
8289 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8290 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8291 the command corresponding to the process.
8292 @end table
8293
8294 @node Memory Region Attributes
8295 @section Memory Region Attributes
8296 @cindex memory region attributes
8297
8298 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8299 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8300 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8301 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8302 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8303 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8304 user can override the fetched regions.
8305
8306 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8307 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8308 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8309 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8310 all memory.
8311
8312 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8313 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8314
8315 @table @code
8316 @kindex mem
8317 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8318 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8319 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8320 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8321 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8322 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8323
8324 @item mem auto
8325 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8326 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8327
8328 @kindex delete mem
8329 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8330 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8331 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8332
8333 @kindex disable mem
8334 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8335 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8336 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8337 It may be enabled again later.
8338
8339 @kindex enable mem
8340 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8341 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8342
8343 @kindex info mem
8344 @item info mem
8345 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8346 for each region:
8347
8348 @table @emph
8349 @item Memory Region Number
8350 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8351 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8352 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8353
8354 @item Lo Address
8355 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8356
8357 @item Hi Address
8358 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8359
8360 @item Attributes
8361 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8362 @end table
8363 @end table
8364
8365
8366 @subsection Attributes
8367
8368 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8369 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8370 write accesses to a memory region.
8371
8372 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8373 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8374 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8375
8376 @table @code
8377 @item ro
8378 Memory is read only.
8379 @item wo
8380 Memory is write only.
8381 @item rw
8382 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8383 @end table
8384
8385 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8386 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8387 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8388 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8389 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8390
8391 @table @code
8392 @item 8
8393 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8394 @item 16
8395 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8396 @item 32
8397 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8398 @item 64
8399 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8400 @end table
8401
8402 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8403 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8404 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8405 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8406 @c
8407 @c @table @code
8408 @c @item hwbreak
8409 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8410 @c @item swbreak (default)
8411 @c @end table
8412
8413 @subsubsection Data Cache
8414 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8415 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8416 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8417 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8418 registers.
8419
8420 @table @code
8421 @item cache
8422 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8423 @item nocache
8424 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8425 @end table
8426
8427 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8428 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8429 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8430 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8431 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8432
8433 @table @code
8434 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8435 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8436 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8437 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8438 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8439 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8440 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8441 The default value is @code{on}.
8442 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8443 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8444 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8445 @end table
8446
8447
8448 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8449 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8450 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8451 @c
8452 @c @table @code
8453 @c @item verify
8454 @c @item noverify (default)
8455 @c @end table
8456
8457 @node Dump/Restore Files
8458 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8459 @cindex dump/restore files
8460 @cindex append data to a file
8461 @cindex dump data to a file
8462 @cindex restore data from a file
8463
8464 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8465 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8466 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8467 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8468 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8469 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8470 files.
8471
8472 @table @code
8473
8474 @kindex dump
8475 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8476 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8477 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8478 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8479
8480 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8481 @table @code
8482 @item binary
8483 Raw binary form.
8484 @item ihex
8485 Intel hex format.
8486 @item srec
8487 Motorola S-record format.
8488 @item tekhex
8489 Tektronix Hex format.
8490 @end table
8491
8492 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8493 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8494 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8495 form.
8496
8497 @kindex append
8498 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8499 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8500 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8501 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8502 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8503
8504 @kindex restore
8505 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8506 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8507 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8508 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8509 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8510
8511 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8512 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8513 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8514 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8515 from that location.
8516
8517 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8518 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8519 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8520 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8521
8522 @end table
8523
8524 @node Core File Generation
8525 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8526 @cindex dump core from inferior
8527
8528 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8529 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8530 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8531 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8532 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8533 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8534 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8535
8536 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8537 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8538 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8539
8540 @table @code
8541 @kindex gcore
8542 @kindex generate-core-file
8543 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8544 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8545 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8546 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8547 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8548 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8549
8550 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8551 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8552 @end table
8553
8554 @node Character Sets
8555 @section Character Sets
8556 @cindex character sets
8557 @cindex charset
8558 @cindex translating between character sets
8559 @cindex host character set
8560 @cindex target character set
8561
8562 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8563 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8564 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8565 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8566 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8567 @dfn{target character set}.
8568
8569 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8570 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8571 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8572 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8573 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8574 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8575 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8576 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8577 character and string literals in expressions.
8578
8579 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8580 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8581 target-charset} command, described below.
8582
8583 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8584 support:
8585
8586 @table @code
8587 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8588 @kindex set target-charset
8589 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8590 list of supported target character sets, type
8591 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8592
8593 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8594 @kindex set host-charset
8595 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8596
8597 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8598 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8599 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8600 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8601 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8602
8603 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8604 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8605 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8606
8607 @item set charset @var{charset}
8608 @kindex set charset
8609 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8610 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8611 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8612 for both host and target.
8613
8614 @item show charset
8615 @kindex show charset
8616 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8617
8618 @item show host-charset
8619 @kindex show host-charset
8620 Show the name of the current host character set.
8621
8622 @item show target-charset
8623 @kindex show target-charset
8624 Show the name of the current target character set.
8625
8626 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8627 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8628 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8629 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8630 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8631 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8632
8633 @item show target-wide-charset
8634 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8635 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8636 @end table
8637
8638 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8639 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8640 @file{charset-test.c}:
8641
8642 @smallexample
8643 #include <stdio.h>
8644
8645 char ascii_hello[]
8646 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8647 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8648 char ibm1047_hello[]
8649 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8650 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8651
8652 main ()
8653 @{
8654 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8655 @}
8656 @end smallexample
8657
8658 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8659 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8660 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8661
8662 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8663
8664 @smallexample
8665 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8666 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8667 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8668 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8669 @dots{}
8670 (@value{GDBP})
8671 @end smallexample
8672
8673 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8674 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8675 strings:
8676
8677 @smallexample
8678 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8679 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8680 (@value{GDBP})
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8684 initial character set:
8685 @smallexample
8686 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8687 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8688 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8689 (@value{GDBP})
8690 @end smallexample
8691
8692 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8693 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8694 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8695 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8696 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8697
8698 @smallexample
8699 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8700 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8701 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8702 $2 = 72 'H'
8703 (@value{GDBP})
8704 @end smallexample
8705
8706 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8707 literals you use in expressions:
8708
8709 @smallexample
8710 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8711 $3 = 43 '+'
8712 (@value{GDBP})
8713 @end smallexample
8714
8715 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8716 character.
8717
8718 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8719 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8720 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8721
8722 @smallexample
8723 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8724 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8725 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8726 $5 = 200 '\310'
8727 (@value{GDBP})
8728 @end smallexample
8729
8730 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8731 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8732
8733 @smallexample
8734 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8735 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8736 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8737 @end smallexample
8738
8739 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8740 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8741 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8742 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8743 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8744
8745 @smallexample
8746 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8747 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8748 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8749 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8750 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8751 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8752 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8753 $7 = 72 '\110'
8754 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8755 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8756 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8757 $9 = 200 'H'
8758 (@value{GDBP})
8759 @end smallexample
8760
8761 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8762 string literals you use in expressions:
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8766 $10 = 78 '+'
8767 (@value{GDBP})
8768 @end smallexample
8769
8770 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8771 character.
8772
8773 @node Caching Remote Data
8774 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8775 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8776
8777 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
8778 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8779 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8780 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
8781 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
8782 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
8783 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
8784 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
8785 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
8786 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
8787 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
8788 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
8789 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
8790 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
8791 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
8792
8793 @table @code
8794 @kindex set remotecache
8795 @item set remotecache on
8796 @itemx set remotecache off
8797 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
8798 with old scripts.
8799
8800 @kindex show remotecache
8801 @item show remotecache
8802 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
8803
8804 @kindex set stack-cache
8805 @item set stack-cache on
8806 @itemx set stack-cache off
8807 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
8808 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
8809
8810 @kindex show stack-cache
8811 @item show stack-cache
8812 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
8813
8814 @kindex info dcache
8815 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
8816 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8817 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
8818 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
8819 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
8820 operation.
8821
8822 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
8823 printed in hex.
8824 @end table
8825
8826 @node Searching Memory
8827 @section Search Memory
8828 @cindex searching memory
8829
8830 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8831 @code{find} command.
8832
8833 @table @code
8834 @kindex find
8835 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8836 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8837 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8838 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8839 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8840 @end table
8841
8842 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8843 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8844
8845 @table @r
8846 @item @var{s}, search query size
8847 The size of each search query value.
8848
8849 @table @code
8850 @item b
8851 bytes
8852 @item h
8853 halfwords (two bytes)
8854 @item w
8855 words (four bytes)
8856 @item g
8857 giant words (eight bytes)
8858 @end table
8859
8860 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8861 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8862 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8863
8864 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8865 value's type in the current language.
8866 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8867 pattern as a mixture of types.
8868 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8869 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8870 which is typically four bytes.
8871
8872 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8873 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8874 @end table
8875
8876 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8877 (@code{"}).
8878 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8879 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8880
8881 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8882 number of matches found.
8883
8884 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8885 @samp{$_}.
8886 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8887
8888 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8889
8890 @smallexample
8891 void
8892 hello ()
8893 @{
8894 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8895 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8896 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8897 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8898 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8899 @}
8900 @end smallexample
8901
8902 @noindent
8903 you get during debugging:
8904
8905 @smallexample
8906 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8907 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8908 1 pattern found
8909 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8910 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8911 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8912 2 patterns found
8913 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8914 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8915 1 pattern found
8916 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8917 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8918 1 pattern found
8919 (gdb) print $numfound
8920 $1 = 1
8921 (gdb) print $_
8922 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 @node Optimized Code
8926 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
8927 @cindex optimized code, debugging
8928 @cindex debugging optimized code
8929
8930 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
8931 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
8932 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
8933 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
8934 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
8935 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
8936 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
8937
8938 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
8939 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
8940 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
8941 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
8942
8943 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
8944 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
8945 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
8946 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
8947 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
8948 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
8949
8950 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
8951 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
8952 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
8953 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
8954 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
8955
8956 @menu
8957 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
8958 @end menu
8959
8960 @node Inline Functions
8961 @section Inline Functions
8962 @cindex inline functions, debugging
8963
8964 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
8965 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
8966 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
8967 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
8968 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
8969 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
8970 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
8971 @code{info frame} command.
8972
8973 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
8974 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
8975 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
8976 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
8977 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
8978 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
8979 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
8980 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
8981 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
8982 local variables in the caller.
8983
8984 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
8985 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
8986 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
8987 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
8988 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
8989 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
8990 instructions are executed.
8991
8992 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
8993 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
8994 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
8995 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
8996
8997 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
8998 function calls are the same as normal calls:
8999
9000 @itemize @bullet
9001 @item
9002 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9003 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9004 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9005 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9006 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9007 function instead.
9008
9009 @item
9010 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9011 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9012 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9013 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9014 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9015 or inside the inlined function instead.
9016
9017 @item
9018 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9019 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9020 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9021 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9022
9023 @end itemize
9024
9025
9026 @node Macros
9027 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9028
9029 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9030 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9031 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9032 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9033 where it was defined.
9034
9035 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9036 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9037 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9038 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9039
9040 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9041 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9042 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9043 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9044 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9045 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9046 see @ref{List}.
9047
9048 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9049 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9050 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9051
9052 @table @code
9053
9054 @kindex macro expand
9055 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9056 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9057 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9058 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9059 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9060 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9061 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9062 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9063 it can be any string of tokens.
9064
9065 @kindex macro exp1
9066 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9067 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9068 @cindex expand macro once
9069 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9070 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9071 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9072 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9073 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9074 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9075 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9076 can be any string of tokens.
9077
9078 @kindex info macro
9079 @cindex macro definition, showing
9080 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9081 @item info macro @var{macro}
9082 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9083 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9084
9085 @kindex macro define
9086 @cindex user-defined macros
9087 @cindex defining macros interactively
9088 @cindex macros, user-defined
9089 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9090 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9091 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9092 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9093 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9094 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9095 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9096 @var{arglist}.
9097
9098 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9099 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9100 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9101 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9102 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9103
9104 @kindex macro undef
9105 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9106 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9107 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9108 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9109 in the program being debugged.
9110
9111 @kindex macro list
9112 @item macro list
9113 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9114 @end table
9115
9116 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9117 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9118 show our source files:
9119
9120 @smallexample
9121 $ cat sample.c
9122 #include <stdio.h>
9123 #include "sample.h"
9124
9125 #define M 42
9126 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9127
9128 main ()
9129 @{
9130 #define N 28
9131 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9132 #undef N
9133 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9134 #define N 1729
9135 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9136 @}
9137 $ cat sample.h
9138 #define Q <
9139 $
9140 @end smallexample
9141
9142 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9143 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9144 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9145 information.
9146
9147 @smallexample
9148 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9149 $
9150 @end smallexample
9151
9152 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9153
9154 @smallexample
9155 $ gdb -nw sample
9156 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9157 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9158 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9159 (@value{GDBP})
9160 @end smallexample
9161
9162 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9163 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9164 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9165
9166 @smallexample
9167 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9168 3
9169 4 #define M 42
9170 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9171 6
9172 7 main ()
9173 8 @{
9174 9 #define N 28
9175 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9176 11 #undef N
9177 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9178 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9179 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9180 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9181 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9182 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9183 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9184 #define Q <
9185 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9186 expands to: (42 + 1)
9187 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9188 expands to: once (M + 1)
9189 (@value{GDBP})
9190 @end smallexample
9191
9192 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9193 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9194 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9195 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9196
9197 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9198 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9199
9200 @smallexample
9201 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9202 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9203 (@value{GDBP}) run
9204 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9205
9206 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9207 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9208 (@value{GDBP})
9209 @end smallexample
9210
9211 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9212
9213 @smallexample
9214 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9215 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9216 #define N 28
9217 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9218 expands to: 28 < 42
9219 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9220 $1 = 1
9221 (@value{GDBP})
9222 @end smallexample
9223
9224 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9225 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9226 thereof) in force at each point:
9227
9228 @smallexample
9229 (@value{GDBP}) next
9230 Hello, world!
9231 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9232 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9233 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9234 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9235 (@value{GDBP}) next
9236 We're so creative.
9237 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9238 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9239 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9240 #define N 1729
9241 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9242 expands to: 1729 < 42
9243 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9244 $2 = 0
9245 (@value{GDBP})
9246 @end smallexample
9247
9248 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9249 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9250 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9251 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9252
9253 @smallexample
9254 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9255 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9256 -D__STDC__=1
9257 (@value{GDBP})
9258 @end smallexample
9259
9260
9261 @node Tracepoints
9262 @chapter Tracepoints
9263 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9264 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9265
9266 @cindex tracepoints
9267 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9268 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9269 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9270 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9271 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9272 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9273 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9274
9275 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9276 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9277 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9278 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9279 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9280 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9281 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9282 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9283 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9284 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9285 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9286
9287 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9288 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9289 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9290 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9291 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9292 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9293 Packets}.
9294
9295 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9296
9297 @menu
9298 * Set Tracepoints::
9299 * Analyze Collected Data::
9300 * Tracepoint Variables::
9301 @end menu
9302
9303 @node Set Tracepoints
9304 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9305
9306 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9307 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9308 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9309 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9310 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9311 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9312 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9313
9314 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9315 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9316 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9317 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9318 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9319 tracepoint was hit.
9320
9321 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
9322 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
9323 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
9324 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
9325
9326 @cindex fast tracepoints
9327 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9328 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9329 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9330
9331 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9332 conditions and actions.
9333
9334 @menu
9335 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9336 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9337 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9338 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9339 * Trace State Variables::
9340 * Tracepoint Actions::
9341 * Listing Tracepoints::
9342 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9343 @end menu
9344
9345 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9346 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9347
9348 @table @code
9349 @cindex set tracepoint
9350 @kindex trace
9351 @item trace @var{location}
9352 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9353 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9354 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9355 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9356 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9357 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9358 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9359 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9360 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9361
9362 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9363
9364 @smallexample
9365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9366
9367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9368
9369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9370
9371 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9372
9373 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9374 @end smallexample
9375
9376 @noindent
9377 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9378
9379 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9380 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9381 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9382 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9383 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9384 information on tracepoint conditions.
9385
9386 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9387 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9388 @kindex ftrace
9389 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9390 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9391 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9392 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9393 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9394 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9395 message.
9396
9397 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9398 @code{trace}.
9399
9400 @vindex $tpnum
9401 @cindex last tracepoint number
9402 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9403 @cindex tracepoint number
9404 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9405 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9406
9407 @kindex delete tracepoint
9408 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9409 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9410 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9411 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9412 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9413
9414 Examples:
9415
9416 @smallexample
9417 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9418
9419 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9420 @end smallexample
9421
9422 @noindent
9423 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9424 @end table
9425
9426 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9427 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9428
9429 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9430
9431 @table @code
9432 @kindex disable tracepoint
9433 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9434 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9435 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9436 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9437 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9438
9439 @kindex enable tracepoint
9440 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9441 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9442 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9443 run.
9444 @end table
9445
9446 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9447 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9448
9449 @table @code
9450 @kindex passcount
9451 @cindex tracepoint pass count
9452 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9453 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9454 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9455 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9456 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9457 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
9458 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
9459 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
9460 user.
9461
9462 Examples:
9463
9464 @smallexample
9465 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
9466 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
9467
9468 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
9469 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
9470 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9471 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
9472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
9473 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
9474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
9475 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
9476 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
9477 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
9478 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
9479 @end smallexample
9480 @end table
9481
9482 @node Tracepoint Conditions
9483 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
9484 @cindex conditional tracepoints
9485 @cindex tracepoint conditions
9486
9487 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
9488 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
9489 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
9490 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
9491 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
9492 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
9493 is true.
9494
9495 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
9496 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
9497 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
9498 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
9499 just as with breakpoints.
9500
9501 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
9502 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
9503 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
9504 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
9505 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
9506 accesses, and so forth.
9507
9508 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
9509 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
9510 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
9511 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
9512 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
9513 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
9514 search through.
9515
9516 @smallexample
9517 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
9518 @end smallexample
9519
9520 @node Trace State Variables
9521 @subsection Trace State Variables
9522 @cindex trace state variables
9523
9524 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
9525 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
9526 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
9527 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
9528 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
9529 integers.
9530
9531 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
9532 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
9533 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
9534 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
9535
9536 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
9537 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
9538 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
9539 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
9540 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
9541 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
9542 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
9543 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
9544 variable with the same name.
9545
9546 @table @code
9547
9548 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
9549 @kindex tvariable
9550 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
9551 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
9552 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
9553 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
9554 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
9555 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
9556 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
9557 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
9558 value. The default initial value is 0.
9559
9560 @item info tvariables
9561 @kindex info tvariables
9562 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
9563 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
9564 currently running.
9565
9566 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
9567 @kindex delete tvariable
9568 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
9569 are specified.
9570
9571 @end table
9572
9573 @node Tracepoint Actions
9574 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
9575
9576 @table @code
9577 @kindex actions
9578 @cindex tracepoint actions
9579 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9580 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
9581 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
9582 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
9583 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
9584 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
9585 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
9586 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
9587 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
9588 @code{while-stepping}.
9589
9590 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
9591 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
9592 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
9593
9594 @smallexample
9595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
9596
9597 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
9598
9599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
9600 @end smallexample
9601
9602 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
9603 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
9604 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
9605 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
9606 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
9607 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
9608 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
9609 @code{end} command.
9610
9611 @smallexample
9612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9614 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
9615 > collect bar,baz
9616 > collect $regs
9617 > while-stepping 12
9618 > collect $fp, $sp
9619 > end
9620 end
9621 @end smallexample
9622
9623 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
9624 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9625 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
9626 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
9627 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
9628 special arguments are supported:
9629
9630 @table @code
9631 @item $regs
9632 collect all registers
9633
9634 @item $args
9635 collect all function arguments
9636
9637 @item $locals
9638 collect all local variables.
9639 @end table
9640
9641 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9642 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9643 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
9644
9645 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9646 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9647
9648 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
9649 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9650 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
9651 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
9652 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
9653 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
9654 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
9655 action were used.
9656
9657 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9658 @item while-stepping @var{n}
9659 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
9660 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9661 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
9662 its own @code{end} command):
9663
9664 @smallexample
9665 > while-stepping 12
9666 > collect $regs, myglobal
9667 > end
9668 >
9669 @end smallexample
9670
9671 @noindent
9672 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9673 @code{stepping}.
9674
9675 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9676 @kindex set default-collect
9677 @cindex default collection action
9678 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
9679 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
9680 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
9681 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
9682 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
9683 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
9684
9685 @item show default-collect
9686 @kindex show default-collect
9687 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
9688 tracepoint hit.
9689
9690 @end table
9691
9692 @node Listing Tracepoints
9693 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
9694
9695 @table @code
9696 @kindex info tracepoints
9697 @kindex info tp
9698 @cindex information about tracepoints
9699 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9700 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9701 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9702 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9703 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9704 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9705
9706 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9707 tracing:
9708
9709 @itemize @bullet
9710 @item
9711 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9712 @item
9713 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
9714 @item
9715 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
9716 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
9717 @end itemize
9718
9719 @smallexample
9720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9721 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
9722 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9723 pass count 1200
9724 step count 20
9725 A while-stepping 20
9726 A collect globfoo, $regs
9727 A end
9728 A collect globfoo2
9729 A end
9730 (@value{GDBP})
9731 @end smallexample
9732
9733 @noindent
9734 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9735 @end table
9736
9737 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9738 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9739
9740 @table @code
9741 @kindex tstart
9742 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9743 @cindex collected data discarded
9744 @item tstart
9745 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9746 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9747 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9748 experiment.
9749
9750 @kindex tstop
9751 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9752 @item tstop
9753 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9754 stops collecting data.
9755
9756 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9757 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9758 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9759
9760 @kindex tstatus
9761 @cindex status of trace data collection
9762 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9763 @item tstatus
9764 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9765 collection.
9766 @end table
9767
9768 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9769
9770 @smallexample
9771 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9773 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9774 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9775 > while-stepping 11
9776 > collect $regs
9777 > end
9778 > end
9779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9780 [time passes @dots{}]
9781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9782 @end smallexample
9783
9784 @cindex disconnected tracing
9785 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
9786 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
9787 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
9788 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
9789 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
9790 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
9791 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
9792 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
9793
9794 @table @code
9795 @item set disconnected-tracing on
9796 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
9797 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
9798 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
9799 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
9800 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
9801 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
9802 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
9803
9804 @item show disconnected-tracing
9805 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
9806 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
9807
9808 @end table
9809
9810 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
9811 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
9812 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
9813 it will continue after reconnection.
9814
9815 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
9816 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
9817 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
9818 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
9819 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
9820 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
9821 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
9822 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
9823 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
9824 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
9825
9826 @node Analyze Collected Data
9827 @section Using the Collected Data
9828
9829 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
9830 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
9831 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
9832 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
9833 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
9834 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
9835 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
9836 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
9837 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
9838 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
9839 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
9840 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
9841 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
9842 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
9843 the buffer will fail.
9844
9845 @menu
9846 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
9847 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
9848 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
9849 @end menu
9850
9851 @node tfind
9852 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
9853
9854 @kindex tfind
9855 @cindex select trace snapshot
9856 @cindex find trace snapshot
9857 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
9858 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
9859 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
9860 snapshot is selected.
9861
9862 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
9863
9864 @table @code
9865 @item tfind start
9866 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
9867 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
9868
9869 @item tfind none
9870 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
9871
9872 @item tfind end
9873 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
9874
9875 @item tfind
9876 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
9877
9878 @item tfind -
9879 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
9880 retracing earlier steps.
9881
9882 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
9883 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
9884 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
9885 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
9886 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
9887
9888 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
9889 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
9890 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
9891 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
9892 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
9893
9894 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9895 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
9896 addresses.
9897
9898 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9899 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
9900 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
9901
9902 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
9903 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9904 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9905 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9906 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9907 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9908 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9909 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9910 @end table
9911
9912 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9913 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9914 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9915 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9916 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9917 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9918 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9919 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9920 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9921 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9922 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9923 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9924 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9925 tracepoint as the current one.
9926
9927 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9928 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9929 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9930 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9931 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9932
9933 @smallexample
9934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9936 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9937 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9938 > tfind
9939 > end
9940
9941 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9942 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9943 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9944 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9945 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9946 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9947 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9948 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9949 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9950 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9951 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9952 @end smallexample
9953
9954 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9955 the buffer:
9956
9957 @smallexample
9958 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9960 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9961 > tfind line
9962 > end
9963
9964 Frame 0, X = 1
9965 Frame 7, X = 2
9966 Frame 13, X = 255
9967 @end smallexample
9968
9969 @node tdump
9970 @subsection @code{tdump}
9971 @kindex tdump
9972 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9973 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9974
9975 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9976 the current trace snapshot.
9977
9978 @smallexample
9979 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9980 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9981 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9982 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9983 > end
9984
9985 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9986
9987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9988 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9989 at gdb_test.c:444
9990 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9991
9992 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9993 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9994 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9995 d1 0x18 24
9996 d2 0x80 128
9997 d3 0x33 51
9998 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9999 d5 0x22 34
10000 d6 0xe0 224
10001 d7 0x380035 3670069
10002 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10003 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10004 a2 0x100 256
10005 a3 0x322000 3284992
10006 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10007 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10008 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10009 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10010 ps 0x0 0
10011 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10012 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10013 fpstatus 0x0 0
10014 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10015 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10016 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10017 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10018 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10019 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10020 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10021 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10022 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10023
10024 (@value{GDBP})
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @node save-tracepoints
10028 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
10029 @kindex save-tracepoints
10030 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10031
10032 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10033 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10034 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10035 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10036 Files}).
10037
10038 @node Tracepoint Variables
10039 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10040 @cindex tracepoint variables
10041 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @vindex $trace_frame
10045 @item (int) $trace_frame
10046 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10047 snapshot is selected.
10048
10049 @vindex $tracepoint
10050 @item (int) $tracepoint
10051 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10052
10053 @vindex $trace_line
10054 @item (int) $trace_line
10055 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10056
10057 @vindex $trace_file
10058 @item (char []) $trace_file
10059 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10060
10061 @vindex $trace_func
10062 @item (char []) $trace_func
10063 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10064 @end table
10065
10066 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10067 use @code{output} instead.
10068
10069 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10070 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10071 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10072 which are managed by the target.
10073
10074 @smallexample
10075 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10076
10077 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10078 > output $trace_file
10079 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10080 > tfind
10081 > end
10082 @end smallexample
10083
10084 @node Overlays
10085 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10086 @cindex overlays
10087
10088 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10089 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10090 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10091 use overlays.
10092
10093 @menu
10094 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10095 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10096 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10097 mapped by asking the inferior.
10098 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10099 @end menu
10100
10101 @node How Overlays Work
10102 @section How Overlays Work
10103 @cindex mapped overlays
10104 @cindex unmapped overlays
10105 @cindex load address, overlay's
10106 @cindex mapped address
10107 @cindex overlay area
10108
10109 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10110 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10111 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10112 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10113 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10114
10115 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10116 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10117 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10118 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10119 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10120 largest overlay as well.
10121
10122 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10123 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10124 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10125 there.
10126
10127 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10128 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10129 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10130
10131 @smallexample
10132 @group
10133 Data Instruction Larger
10134 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10135 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10136 | | | | | |
10137 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10138 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10139 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10140 | and heap | | | | | |
10141 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10142 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10143 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10144 | | | | | |
10145 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10146 address | | | | | |
10147 | overlay | <-' | | |
10148 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10149 | | <---. | | load address
10150 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10151 | | | |
10152 +-----------+ | |
10153 +-----------+
10154 | |
10155 +-----------+
10156
10157 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10158 @end group
10159 @end smallexample
10160
10161 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10162 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10163 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10164 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10165 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10166 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10167 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10168 program and the overlay area.
10169
10170 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10171 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10172 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10173 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10174 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10175 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10176 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10177
10178 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10179 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10180 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10181
10182 @itemize @bullet
10183
10184 @item
10185 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10186 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10187 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10188 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10189
10190 @item
10191 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10192 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10193 your program's performance.
10194
10195 @item
10196 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10197 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10198 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10199 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10200 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10201 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10202 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10203
10204 @item
10205 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10206 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10207 instruction and data spaces.
10208
10209 @end itemize
10210
10211 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10212 improved in many ways:
10213
10214 @itemize @bullet
10215
10216 @item
10217 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
10218 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
10219 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
10220 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
10221 area in the usual way.
10222
10223 @item
10224 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
10225 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
10226
10227 @item
10228 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
10229 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
10230 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
10231 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
10232 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
10233 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
10234 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
10235
10236 @end itemize
10237
10238
10239 @node Overlay Commands
10240 @section Overlay Commands
10241
10242 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
10243 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
10244 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
10245 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
10246 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
10247 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
10248
10249 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
10250 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
10251
10252 @table @code
10253 @item overlay off
10254 @kindex overlay
10255 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
10256 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
10257 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
10258 overlay support is disabled.
10259
10260 @item overlay manual
10261 @cindex manual overlay debugging
10262 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10263 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
10264 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
10265 commands described below.
10266
10267 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
10268 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
10269 @cindex map an overlay
10270 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
10271 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
10272 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
10273 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
10274 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
10275 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
10276
10277 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
10278 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
10279 @cindex unmap an overlay
10280 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
10281 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
10282 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
10283 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
10284
10285 @item overlay auto
10286 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10287 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
10288 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
10289 Overlay Debugging}.
10290
10291 @item overlay load-target
10292 @itemx overlay load
10293 @cindex reloading the overlay table
10294 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
10295 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
10296 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
10297 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
10298 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
10299
10300 @item overlay list-overlays
10301 @itemx overlay list
10302 @cindex listing mapped overlays
10303 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
10304 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
10305
10306 @end table
10307
10308 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
10309 of the function the address falls in:
10310
10311 @smallexample
10312 (@value{GDBP}) print main
10313 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
10314 @end smallexample
10315 @noindent
10316 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
10317 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
10318 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
10319 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
10320
10321 @smallexample
10322 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10323 No sections are mapped.
10324 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10325 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
10326 @end smallexample
10327 @noindent
10328 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
10329 name normally:
10330
10331 @smallexample
10332 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10333 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
10334 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
10335 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10336 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
10337 @end smallexample
10338
10339 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
10340 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
10341 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
10342 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
10343 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
10344
10345 @itemize @bullet
10346 @item
10347 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
10348 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
10349 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
10350 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
10351 @item
10352 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
10353 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
10354 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
10355 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
10356 breakpoints properly.
10357 @end itemize
10358
10359
10360 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
10361 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
10362 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
10363
10364 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
10365 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
10366 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
10367 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
10368 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
10369 current state of the overlays.
10370
10371 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
10372 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
10373
10374 @table @asis
10375
10376 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
10377 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380 struct
10381 @{
10382 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
10383 unsigned long vma;
10384
10385 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
10386 unsigned long size;
10387
10388 /* The overlay's load address. */
10389 unsigned long lma;
10390
10391 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
10392 zero otherwise. */
10393 unsigned long mapped;
10394 @}
10395 @end smallexample
10396
10397 @item @code{_novlys}:
10398 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
10399 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
10400
10401 @end table
10402
10403 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
10404 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
10405 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
10406 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
10407 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
10408 currently mapped.
10409
10410 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
10411 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
10412 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
10413 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
10414 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
10415 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
10416 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
10417 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
10418 are not being executed.
10419
10420 @node Overlay Sample Program
10421 @section Overlay Sample Program
10422 @cindex overlay example program
10423
10424 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
10425 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
10426 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
10427 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
10428 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
10429 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
10430 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
10431
10432 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
10433 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
10434 suite. The program consists of the following files from
10435 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
10436
10437 @table @file
10438 @item overlays.c
10439 The main program file.
10440 @item ovlymgr.c
10441 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
10442 @item foo.c
10443 @itemx bar.c
10444 @itemx baz.c
10445 @itemx grbx.c
10446 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
10447 @item d10v.ld
10448 @itemx m32r.ld
10449 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
10450 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
10451 @end table
10452
10453 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
10454 cross-compiler like this:
10455
10456 @smallexample
10457 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
10458 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
10459 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
10460 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
10461 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
10462 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
10463 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
10464 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
10465 @end smallexample
10466
10467 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
10468 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
10469 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
10470
10471
10472 @node Languages
10473 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
10474 @cindex languages
10475
10476 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
10477 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
10478 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
10479 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
10480 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
10481 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
10482
10483 @cindex working language
10484 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
10485 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
10486 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
10487 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
10488 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
10489 language}.
10490
10491 @menu
10492 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
10493 * Show:: Displaying the language
10494 * Checks:: Type and range checks
10495 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
10496 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
10497 @end menu
10498
10499 @node Setting
10500 @section Switching Between Source Languages
10501
10502 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
10503 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
10504 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
10505 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
10506 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
10507 are printed, etc.
10508
10509 In addition to the working language, every source file that
10510 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
10511 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
10512 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
10513 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
10514 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
10515 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
10516 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
10517 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
10518 Displaying the Language}.
10519
10520 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
10521 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
10522 another language. In that case, make the
10523 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
10524 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
10525 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
10526
10527 @menu
10528 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
10529 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
10530 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
10531 @end menu
10532
10533 @node Filenames
10534 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
10535
10536 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
10537 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
10538
10539 @table @file
10540 @item .ada
10541 @itemx .ads
10542 @itemx .adb
10543 @itemx .a
10544 Ada source file.
10545
10546 @item .c
10547 C source file
10548
10549 @item .C
10550 @itemx .cc
10551 @itemx .cp
10552 @itemx .cpp
10553 @itemx .cxx
10554 @itemx .c++
10555 C@t{++} source file
10556
10557 @item .m
10558 Objective-C source file
10559
10560 @item .f
10561 @itemx .F
10562 Fortran source file
10563
10564 @item .mod
10565 Modula-2 source file
10566
10567 @item .s
10568 @itemx .S
10569 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
10570 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
10571 @end table
10572
10573 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
10574 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
10575
10576 @node Manually
10577 @subsection Setting the Working Language
10578
10579 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
10580 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
10581 your program.
10582
10583 @kindex set language
10584 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
10585 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
10586 a language, such as
10587 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
10588 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
10589
10590 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
10591 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
10592 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
10593 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
10594 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
10595 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
10596 command such as:
10597
10598 @smallexample
10599 print a = b + c
10600 @end smallexample
10601
10602 @noindent
10603 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
10604 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
10605 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
10606 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
10607
10608 @node Automatically
10609 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
10610
10611 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
10612 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
10613 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
10614 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
10615 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
10616 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
10617 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
10618 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
10619 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
10620
10621 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
10622 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
10623 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
10624 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
10625 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
10626
10627 @node Show
10628 @section Displaying the Language
10629
10630 The following commands help you find out which language is the
10631 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
10632
10633 @table @code
10634 @item show language
10635 @kindex show language
10636 Display the current working language. This is the
10637 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
10638 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
10639
10640 @item info frame
10641 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
10642 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
10643 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
10644 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
10645 information listed here.
10646
10647 @item info source
10648 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
10649 Display the source language of this source file.
10650 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
10651 information listed here.
10652 @end table
10653
10654 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
10655 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
10656 with a language explicitly:
10657
10658 @table @code
10659 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
10660 @kindex set extension-language
10661 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
10662 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
10663
10664 @item info extensions
10665 @kindex info extensions
10666 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
10667 @end table
10668
10669 @node Checks
10670 @section Type and Range Checking
10671
10672 @quotation
10673 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
10674 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
10675 section documents the intended facilities.
10676 @end quotation
10677 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
10678
10679 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
10680 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
10681 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
10682 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
10683 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
10684 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
10685 errors when your program is running.
10686
10687 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
10688 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
10689 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
10690 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
10691 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
10692 automatically based on your program's source language.
10693 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
10694 settings of supported languages.
10695
10696 @menu
10697 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
10698 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
10699 @end menu
10700
10701 @cindex type checking
10702 @cindex checks, type
10703 @node Type Checking
10704 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
10705
10706 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10707 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10708 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10709 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10710
10711 @smallexample
10712 1 + 2 @result{} 3
10713 @exdent but
10714 @error{} 1 + 2.3
10715 @end smallexample
10716
10717 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10718 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10719
10720 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
10721 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
10722 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
10723 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
10724 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
10725 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
10726 also issues a warning.
10727
10728 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
10729 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
10730 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
10731 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
10732 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
10733 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
10734
10735 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
10736 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
10737 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
10738 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
10739 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
10740 details on specific languages.
10741
10742 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
10743
10744 @kindex set check type
10745 @kindex show check type
10746 @table @code
10747 @item set check type auto
10748 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
10749 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10750 each language.
10751
10752 @item set check type on
10753 @itemx set check type off
10754 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10755 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
10756 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
10757 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
10758 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
10759
10760 @item set check type warn
10761 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
10762 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
10763 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
10764 numbers and structures.
10765
10766 @item show type
10767 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
10768 is setting it automatically.
10769 @end table
10770
10771 @cindex range checking
10772 @cindex checks, range
10773 @node Range Checking
10774 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
10775
10776 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
10777 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
10778 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
10779 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
10780 not exceed the bounds of the array.
10781
10782 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
10783 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
10784 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
10785 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
10786
10787 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
10788 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
10789 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
10790 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
10791 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
10792 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
10796 @end smallexample
10797
10798 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
10799 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
10800 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
10801
10802 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
10803
10804 @kindex set check range
10805 @kindex show check range
10806 @table @code
10807 @item set check range auto
10808 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
10809 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10810 each language.
10811
10812 @item set check range on
10813 @itemx set check range off
10814 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10815 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
10816 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
10817 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
10818
10819 @item set check range warn
10820 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
10821 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
10822 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
10823 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
10824 systems).
10825
10826 @item show range
10827 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
10828 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
10829 @end table
10830
10831 @node Supported Languages
10832 @section Supported Languages
10833
10834 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
10835 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
10836 @c This is false ...
10837 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
10838 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
10839 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
10840 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
10841 language.
10842
10843 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
10844 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
10845 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
10846 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
10847 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
10848 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
10849 language reference or tutorial.
10850
10851 @menu
10852 * C:: C and C@t{++}
10853 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
10854 * Fortran:: Fortran
10855 * Pascal:: Pascal
10856 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
10857 * Ada:: Ada
10858 @end menu
10859
10860 @node C
10861 @subsection C and C@t{++}
10862
10863 @cindex C and C@t{++}
10864 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
10865
10866 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
10867 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
10868 together.
10869
10870 @cindex C@t{++}
10871 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
10872 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
10873 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
10874 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
10875 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
10876 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
10877 compiler (@code{aCC}).
10878
10879 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
10880 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
10881 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
10882 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
10883 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
10884 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10885
10886 @menu
10887 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
10888 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
10889 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
10890 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
10891 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
10892 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
10893 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
10894 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
10895 @end menu
10896
10897 @node C Operators
10898 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
10899
10900 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
10901
10902 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10903 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10904 often defined on groups of types.
10905
10906 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10907
10908 @itemize @bullet
10909
10910 @item
10911 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10912 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10913
10914 @item
10915 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10916 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10917
10918 @item
10919 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10920
10921 @item
10922 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10923
10924 @end itemize
10925
10926 @noindent
10927 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10928 in order of increasing precedence:
10929
10930 @table @code
10931 @item ,
10932 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10933 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10934 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10935
10936 @item =
10937 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10938 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10939
10940 @item @var{op}=
10941 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10942 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10943 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10944 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10945 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10946
10947 @item ?:
10948 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10949 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10950 integral type.
10951
10952 @item ||
10953 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10954
10955 @item &&
10956 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10957
10958 @item |
10959 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10960
10961 @item ^
10962 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10963
10964 @item &
10965 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10966
10967 @item ==@r{, }!=
10968 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10969 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10970
10971 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10972 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10973 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10974 and non-zero for true.
10975
10976 @item <<@r{, }>>
10977 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10978
10979 @item @@
10980 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10981
10982 @item +@r{, }-
10983 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10984 pointer types.
10985
10986 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10987 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10988 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10989 integral types.
10990
10991 @item ++@r{, }--
10992 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10993 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10994 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10995 operation takes place.
10996
10997 @item *
10998 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10999 @code{++}.
11000
11001 @item &
11002 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11003
11004 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11005 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11006 to examine the address
11007 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11008 stored.
11009
11010 @item -
11011 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11012 precedence as @code{++}.
11013
11014 @item !
11015 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11016 @code{++}.
11017
11018 @item ~
11019 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11020 @code{++}.
11021
11022
11023 @item .@r{, }->
11024 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11025 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11026 pointer based on the stored type information.
11027 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11028
11029 @item .*@r{, }->*
11030 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11031
11032 @item []
11033 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11034 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11035
11036 @item ()
11037 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11038
11039 @item ::
11040 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11041 and @code{class} types.
11042
11043 @item ::
11044 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11045 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11046 above.
11047 @end table
11048
11049 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11050 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11051 predefined meaning.
11052
11053 @node C Constants
11054 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11055
11056 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11057
11058 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11059 following ways:
11060
11061 @itemize @bullet
11062 @item
11063 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11064 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11065 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11066 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11067 @code{long} value.
11068
11069 @item
11070 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11071 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11072 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11073 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11074 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11075 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11076 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11077 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11078 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11079 constant.
11080
11081 @item
11082 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11083 integral equivalents.
11084
11085 @item
11086 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11087 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11088 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11089 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11090 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11091 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11092 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11093 @samp{\n} for newline.
11094
11095 @item
11096 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11097 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11098 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11099 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11100 characters.
11101
11102 @item
11103 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11104 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11105
11106 @item
11107 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11108 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11109 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11110 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11111 @end itemize
11112
11113 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11114 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11115
11116 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11117 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11118
11119 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11120 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11121 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11122 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11123 @quotation
11124 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11125 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11126 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11127 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11128 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11129 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11130 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11131 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11132 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11133 C@t{++} code.
11134 @end quotation
11135
11136 @enumerate
11137
11138 @cindex member functions
11139 @item
11140 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11141
11142 @smallexample
11143 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11144 @end smallexample
11145
11146 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11147 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11148 @item
11149 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11150 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11151 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11152 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11153
11154 @cindex call overloaded functions
11155 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11156 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11157 @item
11158 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11159 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11160 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11161 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11162 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11163 default arguments.
11164
11165 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11166 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11167 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11168 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11169 number of function arguments.
11170
11171 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11172 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11173 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11174
11175 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11176 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11177 @smallexample
11178 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11179 @end smallexample
11180
11181 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11182 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11183
11184 @cindex reference declarations
11185 @item
11186 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11187 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11188 dereferenced.
11189
11190 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11191 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11192 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11193 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11194 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11195
11196 @item
11197 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11198 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11199 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11200 necessary, for example in an expression like
11201 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11202 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11203 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11204 @end enumerate
11205
11206 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11207 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11208 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11209 invoking user-defined operators.
11210
11211 @node C Defaults
11212 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
11213
11214 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
11215
11216 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
11217 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
11218 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11219 selects the working language.
11220
11221 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
11222 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
11223 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
11224 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
11225 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
11226 for further details.
11227
11228 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
11229 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
11230 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
11231
11232 @node C Checks
11233 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
11234
11235 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
11236
11237 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
11238 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
11239 considers two variables type equivalent if:
11240
11241 @itemize @bullet
11242 @item
11243 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
11244 enumerated tag.
11245
11246 @item
11247 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
11248 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
11249
11250 @ignore
11251 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
11252 @c FIXME--beers?
11253 @item
11254 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
11255 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
11256 compilers.)
11257 @end ignore
11258 @end itemize
11259
11260 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
11261 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
11262 that is not itself an array.
11263
11264 @node Debugging C
11265 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
11266
11267 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
11268 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
11269 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
11270 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
11271
11272 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
11273 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
11274 ,Expressions}.
11275
11276 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
11277 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
11278
11279 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
11280
11281 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
11282 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
11283
11284 @table @code
11285 @cindex break in overloaded functions
11286 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
11287 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
11288 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
11289 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
11290 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
11291
11292 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
11293 @item rbreak @var{regex}
11294 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
11295 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
11296 classes.
11297 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11298
11299 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
11300 @item catch throw
11301 @itemx catch catch
11302 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
11303 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
11304
11305 @cindex inheritance
11306 @item ptype @var{typename}
11307 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
11308 @var{typename}.
11309 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
11310
11311 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
11312 @item set print demangle
11313 @itemx show print demangle
11314 @itemx set print asm-demangle
11315 @itemx show print asm-demangle
11316 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
11317 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
11318 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11319
11320 @item set print object
11321 @itemx show print object
11322 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
11323 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11324
11325 @item set print vtbl
11326 @itemx show print vtbl
11327 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
11328 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11329 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11330 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11331
11332 @kindex set overload-resolution
11333 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
11334 @item set overload-resolution on
11335 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
11336 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
11337 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
11338 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
11339 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
11340 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
11341
11342 @item set overload-resolution off
11343 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
11344 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11345 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
11346 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
11347 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11348 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
11349 argument types.
11350
11351 @kindex show overload-resolution
11352 @item show overload-resolution
11353 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
11354
11355 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
11356 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
11357 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
11358 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
11359 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
11360 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
11361 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @node Decimal Floating Point
11365 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
11366 @cindex decimal floating point format
11367
11368 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
11369 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
11370 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
11371 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
11372
11373 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
11374 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
11375 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
11376 target.
11377
11378 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
11379 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
11380 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
11381
11382 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
11383 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
11384 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
11385
11386 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
11387 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
11388 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
11389
11390 @node Objective-C
11391 @subsection Objective-C
11392
11393 @cindex Objective-C
11394 This section provides information about some commands and command
11395 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
11396 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
11397 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
11398
11399 @menu
11400 * Method Names in Commands::
11401 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
11402 @end menu
11403
11404 @node Method Names in Commands
11405 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
11406
11407 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
11408 names as line specifications:
11409
11410 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
11411 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
11412 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
11413 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
11414 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
11415 @itemize
11416 @item @code{clear}
11417 @item @code{break}
11418 @item @code{info line}
11419 @item @code{jump}
11420 @item @code{list}
11421 @end itemize
11422
11423 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
11424
11425 @smallexample
11426 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
11427 @end smallexample
11428
11429 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
11430 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
11431 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
11432 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
11433 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
11434 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
11435 debugged, enter:
11436
11437 @smallexample
11438 break -[Fruit create]
11439 @end smallexample
11440
11441 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
11442 enter:
11443
11444 @smallexample
11445 list +[NSText initialize]
11446 @end smallexample
11447
11448 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
11449 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
11450 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
11451 is also possible to specify just a method name:
11452
11453 @smallexample
11454 break create
11455 @end smallexample
11456
11457 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
11458 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
11459 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
11460 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
11461 none apply.
11462
11463 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
11464 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
11465
11466 @smallexample
11467 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
11468 @end smallexample
11469
11470 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
11471 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
11472 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
11473 @kindex print-object
11474 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
11475
11476 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
11477
11478 @smallexample
11479 print -[@var{object} hash]
11480 @end smallexample
11481
11482 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
11483 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
11484 @noindent
11485 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
11486 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
11487 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
11488 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
11489 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
11490 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
11491
11492 @node Fortran
11493 @subsection Fortran
11494 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
11495
11496 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
11497 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
11498
11499 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
11500 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
11501 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
11502 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
11503 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
11504 underscore.
11505
11506 @menu
11507 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
11508 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
11509 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
11510 @end menu
11511
11512 @node Fortran Operators
11513 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
11514
11515 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
11516
11517 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11518 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
11519 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
11520
11521 @table @code
11522 @item **
11523 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
11524 of the second one.
11525
11526 @item :
11527 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
11528 represent a section of array.
11529
11530 @item %
11531 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
11532 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
11533 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
11534 union type.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 @node Fortran Defaults
11538 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
11539
11540 @cindex Fortran Defaults
11541
11542 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
11543 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
11544 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
11545 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
11546
11547 @node Special Fortran Commands
11548 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
11549
11550 @cindex Special Fortran commands
11551
11552 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
11553 such as displaying common blocks.
11554
11555 @table @code
11556 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
11557 @kindex info common
11558 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
11559 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
11560 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
11561 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
11562 printed.
11563 @end table
11564
11565 @node Pascal
11566 @subsection Pascal
11567
11568 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
11569 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
11570 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
11571 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
11572 syntax.
11573
11574 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
11575 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
11576 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
11577
11578 @node Modula-2
11579 @subsection Modula-2
11580
11581 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
11582
11583 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
11584 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
11585 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
11586 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11587 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
11588 table.
11589
11590 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
11591 @menu
11592 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
11593 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
11594 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
11595 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
11596 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
11597 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
11598 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
11599 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11600 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11601 @end menu
11602
11603 @node M2 Operators
11604 @subsubsection Operators
11605 @cindex Modula-2 operators
11606
11607 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11608 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11609 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
11610 following definitions hold:
11611
11612 @itemize @bullet
11613
11614 @item
11615 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
11616 their subranges.
11617
11618 @item
11619 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
11620
11621 @item
11622 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
11623
11624 @item
11625 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
11626 @var{type}}.
11627
11628 @item
11629 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
11630
11631 @item
11632 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
11633
11634 @item
11635 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
11636 @end itemize
11637
11638 @noindent
11639 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
11640 increasing precedence:
11641
11642 @table @code
11643 @item ,
11644 Function argument or array index separator.
11645
11646 @item :=
11647 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
11648 @var{value}.
11649
11650 @item <@r{, }>
11651 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
11652 types.
11653
11654 @item <=@r{, }>=
11655 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
11656 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
11657 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
11658
11659 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
11660 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
11661 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
11662 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
11663 comment character.
11664
11665 @item IN
11666 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
11667 Same precedence as @code{<}.
11668
11669 @item OR
11670 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11671
11672 @item AND@r{, }&
11673 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11674
11675 @item @@
11676 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11677
11678 @item +@r{, }-
11679 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
11680 and difference on set types.
11681
11682 @item *
11683 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
11684 on set types.
11685
11686 @item /
11687 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
11688 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
11689
11690 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
11691 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
11692 precedence as @code{*}.
11693
11694 @item -
11695 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
11696
11697 @item ^
11698 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
11699
11700 @item NOT
11701 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
11702 @code{^}.
11703
11704 @item .
11705 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
11706 precedence as @code{^}.
11707
11708 @item []
11709 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11710
11711 @item ()
11712 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
11713 as @code{^}.
11714
11715 @item ::@r{, }.
11716 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
11717 @end table
11718
11719 @quotation
11720 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
11721 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
11722 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
11723 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
11724 @end quotation
11725
11726
11727 @node Built-In Func/Proc
11728 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
11729 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
11730
11731 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
11732 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
11733
11734 @table @var
11735
11736 @item a
11737 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
11738
11739 @item c
11740 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
11741
11742 @item i
11743 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
11744
11745 @item m
11746 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
11747 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
11748 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
11749
11750 @item n
11751 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
11752
11753 @item r
11754 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
11755
11756 @item t
11757 represents a type.
11758
11759 @item v
11760 represents a variable.
11761
11762 @item x
11763 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
11764 explanation of the function for details.
11765 @end table
11766
11767 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
11768
11769 @table @code
11770 @item ABS(@var{n})
11771 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
11772
11773 @item CAP(@var{c})
11774 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
11775 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
11776
11777 @item CHR(@var{i})
11778 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11779
11780 @item DEC(@var{v})
11781 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11782
11783 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
11784 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11785 new value.
11786
11787 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11788 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
11789 set.
11790
11791 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
11792 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
11793
11794 @item HIGH(@var{a})
11795 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
11796
11797 @item INC(@var{v})
11798 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11799
11800 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
11801 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11802 new value.
11803
11804 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11805 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
11806 there. Returns the new set.
11807
11808 @item MAX(@var{t})
11809 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
11810
11811 @item MIN(@var{t})
11812 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
11813
11814 @item ODD(@var{i})
11815 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
11816
11817 @item ORD(@var{x})
11818 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
11819 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
11820 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
11821 integral, character and enumerated types.
11822
11823 @item SIZE(@var{x})
11824 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11825
11826 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
11827 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
11828
11829 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
11830 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11831
11832 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
11833 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11834 @end table
11835
11836 @quotation
11837 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
11838 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
11839 an error.
11840 @end quotation
11841
11842 @cindex Modula-2 constants
11843 @node M2 Constants
11844 @subsubsection Constants
11845
11846 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
11847 ways:
11848
11849 @itemize @bullet
11850
11851 @item
11852 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
11853 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
11854 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
11855 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
11856
11857 @item
11858 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
11859 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
11860 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
11861 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
11862 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
11863 digits.
11864
11865 @item
11866 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
11867 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
11868 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
11869 followed by a @samp{C}.
11870
11871 @item
11872 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
11873 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
11874 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
11875 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
11876 sequences.
11877
11878 @item
11879 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
11880
11881 @item
11882 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
11883 @code{FALSE}.
11884
11885 @item
11886 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
11887
11888 @item
11889 Set constants are not yet supported.
11890 @end itemize
11891
11892 @node M2 Types
11893 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
11894 @cindex Modula-2 types
11895
11896 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
11897 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
11898 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
11899 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
11900 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
11901 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
11902
11903 The first example contains the following section of code:
11904
11905 @smallexample
11906 VAR
11907 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11908 r: [20..40] ;
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 @noindent
11912 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11913 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11914
11915 @smallexample
11916 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11917 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11918 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11919 SET OF CHAR
11920 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11921 21
11922 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11923 [20..40]
11924 @end smallexample
11925
11926 @noindent
11927 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11928
11929 @smallexample
11930 VAR
11931 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11932 @end smallexample
11933
11934 @noindent
11935 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11936
11937 @smallexample
11938 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11939 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11940 @end smallexample
11941
11942 @noindent
11943 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11944 expressions using the debugger.
11945
11946 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11947 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11948
11949 @smallexample
11950 VAR
11951 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11952 @end smallexample
11953
11954 @smallexample
11955 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11956 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11957 @end smallexample
11958
11959 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11960 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11961 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11962 above.
11963
11964 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11965
11966 @smallexample
11967 TYPE
11968 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11969 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11970 VAR
11971 s: t ;
11972 BEGIN
11973 s := blue ;
11974 @end smallexample
11975
11976 @noindent
11977 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11978 and value of a variable.
11979
11980 @smallexample
11981 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11982 $1 = blue
11983 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11984 type = [blue..yellow]
11985 @end smallexample
11986
11987 @noindent
11988 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11989 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11990 their @code{C} counterparts.
11991
11992 @smallexample
11993 VAR
11994 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11995 BEGIN
11996 s[1] := 1 ;
11997 @end smallexample
11998
11999 @smallexample
12000 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12001 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12002 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12003 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12004 @end smallexample
12005
12006 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12007 pointer types as shown in this example:
12008
12009 @smallexample
12010 VAR
12011 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12012 BEGIN
12013 NEW(s) ;
12014 s^[1] := 1 ;
12015 @end smallexample
12016
12017 @noindent
12018 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12019
12020 @smallexample
12021 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12022 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12023 @end smallexample
12024
12025 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12026 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12027 types:
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 TYPE
12031 foo = RECORD
12032 f1: CARDINAL ;
12033 f2: CHAR ;
12034 f3: myarray ;
12035 END ;
12036
12037 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12038 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12039 VAR
12040 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12041 @end smallexample
12042
12043 @noindent
12044 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12045 below.
12046
12047 @smallexample
12048 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12049 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12050 f1 : CARDINAL;
12051 f2 : CHAR;
12052 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12053 END
12054 @end smallexample
12055
12056 @node M2 Defaults
12057 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12058 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12059
12060 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12061 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12062 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12063 selected the working language.
12064
12065 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12066 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12067 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12068 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12069
12070 @node Deviations
12071 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12072 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12073
12074 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12075 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12076
12077 @itemize @bullet
12078 @item
12079 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12080 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12081 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12082 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12083 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12084 returned a pointer.)
12085
12086 @item
12087 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12088 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12089 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12090 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12091
12092 @item
12093 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12094 argument.
12095
12096 @item
12097 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12098 @end itemize
12099
12100 @node M2 Checks
12101 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12102 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12103
12104 @quotation
12105 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12106 range checking.
12107 @end quotation
12108 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12109
12110 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12111
12112 @itemize @bullet
12113 @item
12114 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12115 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12116
12117 @item
12118 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12119 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12120 @end itemize
12121
12122 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12123 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12124
12125 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12126 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12127
12128 @node M2 Scope
12129 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12130 @cindex scope
12131 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12132 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12133 @ifinfo
12134 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12135 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12136 @end ifinfo
12137 @ifnotinfo
12138 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12139 @end ifnotinfo
12140
12141 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12142 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12143 similar syntax:
12144
12145 @smallexample
12146
12147 @var{module} . @var{id}
12148 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12149 @end smallexample
12150
12151 @noindent
12152 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12153 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12154 identifier within your program, except another module.
12155
12156 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12157 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12158 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12159 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12160
12161 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12162 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12163 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12164 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12165 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
12166 @var{module}.
12167
12168 @node GDB/M2
12169 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12170
12171 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
12172 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
12173 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
12174 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
12175 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
12176 analogue in Modula-2.
12177
12178 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
12179 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
12180 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
12181 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
12182 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
12183 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
12184
12185 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
12186 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
12187 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
12188
12189 @node Ada
12190 @subsection Ada
12191 @cindex Ada
12192
12193 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
12194 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
12195 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
12196 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12197 to be difficult.
12198
12199
12200 @cindex expressions in Ada
12201 @menu
12202 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
12203 and semantics supported by Ada mode
12204 in @value{GDBN}.
12205 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
12206 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
12207 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
12208 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
12209 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12210 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
12211 @end menu
12212
12213 @node Ada Mode Intro
12214 @subsubsection Introduction
12215 @cindex Ada mode, general
12216
12217 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
12218 syntax, with some extensions.
12219 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
12220
12221 @itemize @bullet
12222 @item
12223 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
12224 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
12225 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
12226 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
12227
12228 @item
12229 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
12230 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12231
12232 @item
12233 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12234 @end itemize
12235
12236 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
12237 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
12238 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
12239 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
12240 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
12241
12242 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
12243 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
12244 was translated from an Ada source file.
12245
12246 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
12247 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
12248 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
12249 middle (to allow based literals).
12250
12251 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
12252 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
12253 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
12254 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
12255 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
12256 functions to procedures elsewhere.
12257
12258 @node Omissions from Ada
12259 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
12260 @cindex Ada, omissions from
12261
12262 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
12263
12264 @itemize @bullet
12265 @item
12266 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
12267
12268 @itemize @minus
12269 @item
12270 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
12271 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
12272
12273 @item
12274 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
12275
12276 @item
12277 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
12278
12279 @item
12280 @t{'Tag}.
12281
12282 @item
12283 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
12284 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
12285
12286 @item
12287 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
12288 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
12289
12290 @item
12291 @t{'Address}.
12292 @end itemize
12293
12294 @item
12295 The names in
12296 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
12297 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
12298 not currently available.
12299
12300 @item
12301 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
12302 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
12303 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
12304 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
12305 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
12306 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
12307 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
12308 indeterminate values.
12309
12310 @item
12311 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
12312 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
12313 are not implemented.
12314
12315 @item
12316 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
12317 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
12318 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
12319 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
12320 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
12324 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
12325 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
12326 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
12327 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
12328 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
12329 @end smallexample
12330
12331 Changing a
12332 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
12333 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
12334 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
12335 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
12336 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
12337 declared to have a type such as:
12338
12339 @smallexample
12340 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
12341 Id : Integer;
12342 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
12343 end record;
12344 @end smallexample
12345
12346 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
12347 assignments:
12348
12349 @smallexample
12350 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
12351 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
12355 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
12356 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
12357 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
12358 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
12359 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
12360 redundant component associations, although which component values are
12361 assigned in such cases is not defined.
12362
12363 @item
12364 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
12365
12366 @item
12367 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
12368 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
12369 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
12370 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
12371 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
12372 the proper resolution.
12373
12374 @item
12375 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
12376
12377 @item
12378 Entry calls are not implemented.
12379
12380 @item
12381 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
12382 formats are not supported.
12383
12384 @item
12385 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
12386
12387 @item
12388 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
12389 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
12390 context.
12391 Should your program
12392 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
12393 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
12394 @end itemize
12395
12396 @node Additions to Ada
12397 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
12398 @cindex Ada, deviations from
12399
12400 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
12401 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
12402
12403 @itemize @bullet
12404 @item
12405 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
12406 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
12407 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
12408 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
12409 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
12410 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
12411 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
12412 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
12413
12414 @item
12415 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
12416 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
12417 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
12418
12419 @item
12420 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
12421 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
12422
12423 @item
12424 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
12425 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
12426 @end itemize
12427
12428 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
12429 additions specific to Ada:
12430
12431 @itemize @bullet
12432 @item
12433 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
12434 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
12435
12436 @smallexample
12437 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
12438 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
12439 @end smallexample
12440
12441 @item
12442 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
12443 the value of its right-hand operand.
12444 This allows, for example,
12445 complex conditional breaks:
12446
12447 @smallexample
12448 (@value{GDBP}) break f
12449 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
12450 @end smallexample
12451
12452 @item
12453 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
12454 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
12455 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
12456 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
12457 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
12458 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
12459 in strings. For example,
12460 @smallexample
12461 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
12462 @end smallexample
12463 @noindent
12464 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
12465 after each period.
12466
12467 @item
12468 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
12469 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
12470 to write
12471
12472 @smallexample
12473 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
12474 @end smallexample
12475
12476 @item
12477 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
12478 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
12479 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
12480 of 3 might print as
12481
12482 @smallexample
12483 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
12484 @end smallexample
12485
12486 @noindent
12487 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
12488 clause.
12489
12490 @item
12491 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
12492 multi-character subsequence of
12493 their names (an exact match gets preference).
12494 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
12495 in place of @t{a'length}.
12496
12497 @item
12498 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
12499 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
12500 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
12501 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
12502 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
12503 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
12504 For example,
12505 @smallexample
12506 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
12507 @end smallexample
12508
12509 @item
12510 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
12511 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
12512 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
12513 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
12514 object.
12515
12516 @end itemize
12517
12518 @node Stopping Before Main Program
12519 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
12520
12521 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
12522 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
12523 before reaching the main procedure.
12524 As defined in the Ada Reference
12525 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
12526 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
12527 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
12528 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
12529
12530 @node Ada Tasks
12531 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
12532 @cindex Ada, tasking
12533
12534 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
12535 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
12536
12537 @table @code
12538 @kindex info tasks
12539 @item info tasks
12540 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
12541
12542
12543 @smallexample
12544 @iftex
12545 @leftskip=0.5cm
12546 @end iftex
12547 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12548 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12549 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12550 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
12551 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
12552 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
12553
12554 @end smallexample
12555
12556 @noindent
12557 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
12558 task currently being inspected.
12559
12560 @table @asis
12561 @item ID
12562 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
12563
12564 @item TID
12565 The Ada task ID.
12566
12567 @item P-ID
12568 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
12569
12570 @item Pri
12571 The base priority of the task.
12572
12573 @item State
12574 Current state of the task.
12575
12576 @table @code
12577 @item Unactivated
12578 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
12579 executing.
12580
12581 @item Runnable
12582 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
12583 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
12584
12585 @item Terminated
12586 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
12587 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
12588 terminated themselves.
12589
12590 @item Child Activation Wait
12591 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
12592
12593 @item Accept Statement
12594 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
12595
12596 @item Waiting on entry call
12597 The task is waiting on an entry call.
12598
12599 @item Async Select Wait
12600 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
12601 select statement.
12602
12603 @item Delay Sleep
12604 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
12605 alternative open.
12606
12607 @item Child Termination Wait
12608 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
12609 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
12610 waiting on a terminate Phase.
12611
12612 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
12613 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
12614 finish terminating.
12615
12616 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
12617 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
12618 @end table
12619
12620 @item Name
12621 Name of the task in the program.
12622
12623 @end table
12624
12625 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
12626 @item info task @var{taskno}
12627 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
12628 the following example:
12629 @smallexample
12630 @iftex
12631 @leftskip=0.5cm
12632 @end iftex
12633 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12634 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12635 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12636 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
12637 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
12638 Ada Task: 0x807c468
12639 Name: task_1
12640 Thread: 0x807f378
12641 Parent: 1 (main_task)
12642 Base Priority: 15
12643 State: Runnable
12644 @end smallexample
12645
12646 @item task
12647 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
12648 @cindex current Ada task ID
12649 This command prints the ID of the current task.
12650
12651 @smallexample
12652 @iftex
12653 @leftskip=0.5cm
12654 @end iftex
12655 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12656 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12657 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12658 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12659 (@value{GDBP}) task
12660 [Current task is 2]
12661 @end smallexample
12662
12663 @item task @var{taskno}
12664 @cindex Ada task switching
12665 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
12666 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
12667 from the current task to the given task.
12668
12669 @smallexample
12670 @iftex
12671 @leftskip=0.5cm
12672 @end iftex
12673 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12674 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12675 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12676 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12677 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
12678 [Switching to task 1]
12679 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12680 (@value{GDBP}) bt
12681 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12682 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
12683 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
12684 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
12685 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
12686 @end smallexample
12687
12688 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
12689 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
12690 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
12691 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
12692 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
12693 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
12694 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
12695 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
12696 in @ref{Specify Location}.
12697
12698 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
12699 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
12700 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
12701 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
12702 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
12703
12704 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
12705 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
12706 program.
12707
12708 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12709 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12710 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12711
12712 For example,
12713
12714 @smallexample
12715 @iftex
12716 @leftskip=0.5cm
12717 @end iftex
12718 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12719 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12720 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12721 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
12722 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12723 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
12724 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
12725 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
12726 (@value{GDBP}) cont
12727 Continuing.
12728 task # 1 running
12729 task # 2 running
12730
12731 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
12732 15 flush;
12733 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12734 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12735 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12736 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
12737 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12738 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
12739 @end smallexample
12740 @end table
12741
12742 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
12743 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12744 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
12745
12746 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
12747 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
12748 the platform being used.
12749 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
12750 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
12751 as usual.
12752
12753 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
12754 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
12755 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
12756 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
12757 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
12758 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
12759
12760 @node Ada Glitches
12761 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
12762 @cindex Ada, problems
12763
12764 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
12765 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
12766 @value{GDBN},
12767 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
12768 and the GNU Ada compiler.
12769
12770 @itemize @bullet
12771 @item
12772 Currently, the debugger
12773 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
12774 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
12775 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
12776 to get it printed properly.
12777
12778 @item
12779 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
12780 storage are invisible to the debugger.
12781
12782 @item
12783 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
12784 argument lists are treated as positional).
12785
12786 @item
12787 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
12788
12789 @item
12790 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
12791 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
12792 the host machine.
12793
12794 @item
12795 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
12796 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
12797 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
12798 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
12799 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
12800 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
12801 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
12802 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
12803 you can usually resolve the confusion
12804 by qualifying the problematic names with package
12805 @code{Standard} explicitly.
12806 @end itemize
12807
12808 @node Unsupported Languages
12809 @section Unsupported Languages
12810
12811 @cindex unsupported languages
12812 @cindex minimal language
12813 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
12814 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
12815 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
12816 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
12817 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
12818 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
12819
12820 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
12821 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
12822 language.
12823
12824 @node Symbols
12825 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
12826
12827 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
12828 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
12829 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
12830 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
12831 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
12832 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
12833 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12834
12835 @cindex symbol names
12836 @cindex names of symbols
12837 @cindex quoting names
12838 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
12839 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
12840 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
12841 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
12842 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
12843 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
12844 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
12845 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
12846
12847 @smallexample
12848 p 'foo.c'::x
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 @noindent
12852 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
12853
12854 @table @code
12855 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
12856 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
12857 @kindex set case-sensitive
12858 @item set case-sensitive on
12859 @itemx set case-sensitive off
12860 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
12861 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
12862 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
12863 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
12864 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
12865 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
12866 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
12867 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
12868 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
12869 case-insensitive matches.
12870
12871 @kindex show case-sensitive
12872 @item show case-sensitive
12873 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
12874 lookups.
12875
12876 @kindex info address
12877 @cindex address of a symbol
12878 @item info address @var{symbol}
12879 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
12880 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
12881 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
12882 is always stored.
12883
12884 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
12885 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
12886 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
12887
12888 @kindex info symbol
12889 @cindex symbol from address
12890 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
12891 @item info symbol @var{addr}
12892 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
12893 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
12894 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
12895
12896 @smallexample
12897 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
12898 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
12899 @end smallexample
12900
12901 @noindent
12902 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
12903 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
12904
12905 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12906 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12907
12908 @smallexample
12909 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12910 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12911 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12912 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12913 @end smallexample
12914
12915 @kindex whatis
12916 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12917 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12918 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12919 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12920 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12921 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12922 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12923 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12924 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12925 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12926 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12927
12928 @kindex ptype
12929 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12930 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12931 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12932 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12933
12934 For example, for this variable declaration:
12935
12936 @smallexample
12937 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12938 @end smallexample
12939
12940 @noindent
12941 the two commands give this output:
12942
12943 @smallexample
12944 @group
12945 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12946 type = struct complex
12947 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12948 type = struct complex @{
12949 double real;
12950 double imag;
12951 @}
12952 @end group
12953 @end smallexample
12954
12955 @noindent
12956 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12957 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12958
12959 @cindex incomplete type
12960 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12961 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12962 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12963 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12964 given these declarations:
12965
12966 @smallexample
12967 struct foo;
12968 struct foo *fooptr;
12969 @end smallexample
12970
12971 @noindent
12972 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12973
12974 @smallexample
12975 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12976 $1 = <incomplete type>
12977 @end smallexample
12978
12979 @noindent
12980 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12981 completely specified.
12982
12983 @kindex info types
12984 @item info types @var{regexp}
12985 @itemx info types
12986 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12987 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12988 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12989 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12990 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12991 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12992 name is @code{value}.
12993
12994 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12995 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12996 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12997
12998 @kindex info scope
12999 @cindex local variables
13000 @item info scope @var{location}
13001 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13002 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13003 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13004 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13005 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13006
13007 @smallexample
13008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13009 Scope for command_line_handler:
13010 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13011 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13012 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13013 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13014 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13015 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13016 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13017 @end smallexample
13018
13019 @noindent
13020 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13021 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13022 collect}.
13023
13024 @kindex info source
13025 @item info source
13026 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13027 the function containing the current point of execution:
13028 @itemize @bullet
13029 @item
13030 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13031 @item
13032 the directory it was compiled in,
13033 @item
13034 its length, in lines,
13035 @item
13036 which programming language it is written in,
13037 @item
13038 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13039 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13040 @item
13041 whether the debugging information includes information about
13042 preprocessor macros.
13043 @end itemize
13044
13045
13046 @kindex info sources
13047 @item info sources
13048 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13049 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13050 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13051
13052 @kindex info functions
13053 @item info functions
13054 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13055
13056 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13057 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13058 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13059 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13060 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13061 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13062 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13063 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13064
13065 @kindex info variables
13066 @item info variables
13067 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13068 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13069
13070 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13071 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13072 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13073 @var{regexp}.
13074
13075 @kindex info classes
13076 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13077 @item info classes
13078 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13079 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13080 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13081 expression.
13082
13083 @kindex info selectors
13084 @item info selectors
13085 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13086 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13087 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13088 expression.
13089
13090 @ignore
13091 This was never implemented.
13092 @kindex info methods
13093 @item info methods
13094 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13095 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13096 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13097 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13098 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13099 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
13100 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
13101 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
13102 @end ignore
13103
13104 @cindex reloading symbols
13105 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
13106 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
13107 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
13108 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
13109 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
13110
13111 @table @code
13112 @kindex set symbol-reloading
13113 @item set symbol-reloading on
13114 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
13115 object file with a particular name is seen again.
13116
13117 @item set symbol-reloading off
13118 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
13119 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
13120 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
13121 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
13122 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
13123 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
13124 name.
13125
13126 @kindex show symbol-reloading
13127 @item show symbol-reloading
13128 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
13129 @end table
13130
13131 @cindex opaque data types
13132 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
13133 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
13134 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
13135 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
13136 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
13137 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
13138 another source file. The default is on.
13139
13140 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
13141 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
13142
13143 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
13144 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
13145 is printed as follows:
13146 @smallexample
13147 @{<no data fields>@}
13148 @end smallexample
13149
13150 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
13151 @item show opaque-type-resolution
13152 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
13153
13154 @kindex maint print symbols
13155 @cindex symbol dump
13156 @kindex maint print psymbols
13157 @cindex partial symbol dump
13158 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
13159 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
13160 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
13161 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
13162 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
13163 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
13164 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
13165 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
13166 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
13167 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
13168 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
13169 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
13170 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
13171 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
13172 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
13173 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
13174 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
13175
13176 @kindex maint info symtabs
13177 @kindex maint info psymtabs
13178 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
13179 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13180 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13181 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13182 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13183 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13184
13185 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
13186 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
13187 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
13188 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
13189 structure in more detail. For example:
13190
13191 @smallexample
13192 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
13193 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13194 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13195 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13196 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
13197 readin no
13198 fullname (null)
13199 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
13200 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
13201 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
13202 dependencies (none)
13203 @}
13204 @}
13205 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13206 (@value{GDBP})
13207 @end smallexample
13208 @noindent
13209 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
13210 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
13211 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
13212 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
13213 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
13214
13215 @smallexample
13216 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
13217 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
13218 line 1574.
13219 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13220 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13221 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13222 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13223 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
13224 dirname (null)
13225 fullname (null)
13226 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
13227 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
13228 debugformat DWARF 2
13229 @}
13230 @}
13231 (@value{GDBP})
13232 @end smallexample
13233 @end table
13234
13235
13236 @node Altering
13237 @chapter Altering Execution
13238
13239 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
13240 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
13241 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
13242 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
13243 program.
13244
13245 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
13246 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
13247 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
13248
13249 @menu
13250 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
13251 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
13252 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
13253 * Returning:: Returning from a function
13254 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
13255 * Patching:: Patching your program
13256 @end menu
13257
13258 @node Assignment
13259 @section Assignment to Variables
13260
13261 @cindex assignment
13262 @cindex setting variables
13263 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
13264 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
13265
13266 @smallexample
13267 print x=4
13268 @end smallexample
13269
13270 @noindent
13271 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
13272 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
13273 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
13274 information on operators in supported languages.
13275
13276 @kindex set variable
13277 @cindex variables, setting
13278 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
13279 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
13280 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
13281 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
13282 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
13283
13284 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
13285 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
13286 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
13287 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
13288 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
13289 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
13290 command @code{set width}:
13291
13292 @smallexample
13293 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
13294 type = double
13295 (@value{GDBP}) p width
13296 $4 = 13
13297 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
13298 Invalid syntax in expression.
13299 @end smallexample
13300
13301 @noindent
13302 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
13303 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
13304
13305 @smallexample
13306 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
13307 @end smallexample
13308
13309 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
13310 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
13311 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
13312 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
13313 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
13314 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
13315
13316 @smallexample
13317 @group
13318 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
13319 type = double
13320 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13321 $1 = 1
13322 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
13323 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13324 $2 = 1
13325 (@value{GDBP}) r
13326 The program being debugged has been started already.
13327 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
13328 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
13329 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
13330 Invalid bfd target.
13331 (@value{GDBP}) show g
13332 The current BFD target is "=4".
13333 @end group
13334 @end smallexample
13335
13336 @noindent
13337 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
13338 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
13339 @code{g}, use
13340
13341 @smallexample
13342 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
13343 @end smallexample
13344
13345 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
13346 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
13347 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
13348 same length or shorter.
13349 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
13350 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
13351
13352 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
13353 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
13354 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
13355 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
13356 and representation in memory), and
13357
13358 @smallexample
13359 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
13360 @end smallexample
13361
13362 @noindent
13363 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
13364
13365 @node Jumping
13366 @section Continuing at a Different Address
13367
13368 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
13369 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
13370 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
13371
13372 @table @code
13373 @kindex jump
13374 @item jump @var{linespec}
13375 @itemx jump @var{location}
13376 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
13377 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
13378 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
13379 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
13380 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
13381 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13382
13383 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
13384 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
13385 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
13386 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
13387 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
13388 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
13389 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
13390 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
13391 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
13392 @end table
13393
13394 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
13395 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
13396 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
13397 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
13398 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
13399 example,
13400
13401 @smallexample
13402 set $pc = 0x485
13403 @end smallexample
13404
13405 @noindent
13406 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
13407 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
13408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
13409
13410 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
13411 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
13412 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
13413 detail.
13414
13415 @c @group
13416 @node Signaling
13417 @section Giving your Program a Signal
13418 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
13419
13420 @table @code
13421 @kindex signal
13422 @item signal @var{signal}
13423 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
13424 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
13425 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
13426 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
13427
13428 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
13429 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
13430 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
13431 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
13432 signal.
13433
13434 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
13435 after executing the command.
13436 @end table
13437 @c @end group
13438
13439 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
13440 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
13441 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
13442 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
13443 passes the signal directly to your program.
13444
13445
13446 @node Returning
13447 @section Returning from a Function
13448
13449 @table @code
13450 @cindex returning from a function
13451 @kindex return
13452 @item return
13453 @itemx return @var{expression}
13454 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
13455 command. If you give an
13456 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
13457 value.
13458 @end table
13459
13460 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
13461 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
13462 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
13463 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
13464
13465 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
13466 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
13467 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
13468 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
13469 of functions.
13470
13471 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
13472 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
13473 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
13474 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
13475 selected stack frame returns naturally.
13476
13477 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
13478 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
13479 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
13480 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
13481 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
13482 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
13483 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
13484 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
13485 assignment into the right register(s).
13486
13487 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
13488 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
13489 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
13490 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
13491 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
13492 into a @code{long long int}:
13493
13494 @smallexample
13495 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
13496 29 return 31;
13497 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13498 Make func return now? (y or n) y
13499 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
13500 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
13501 (@value{GDBP})
13502 @end smallexample
13503
13504 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
13505 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
13506 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
13507 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
13508 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
13509 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
13510 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
13511 an appropriate cast explicitly:
13512
13513 @smallexample
13514 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
13515 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13516 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
13517 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
13518 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
13519 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
13520 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
13521 (@value{GDBP})
13522 @end smallexample
13523
13524 @node Calling
13525 @section Calling Program Functions
13526
13527 @table @code
13528 @cindex calling functions
13529 @cindex inferior functions, calling
13530 @item print @var{expr}
13531 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
13532 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
13533 debugged.
13534
13535 @kindex call
13536 @item call @var{expr}
13537 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
13538 returned values.
13539
13540 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
13541 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
13542 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
13543 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
13544 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
13545 value history.
13546 @end table
13547
13548 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
13549 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
13550 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
13551 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
13552
13553 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
13554 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
13555 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
13556 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
13557 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
13558 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
13559 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
13560 in that case is controlled by the
13561 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
13562
13563 @table @code
13564 @item set unwindonsignal
13565 @kindex set unwindonsignal
13566 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
13567 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
13568 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
13569 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
13570 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
13571 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
13572 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
13573 received.
13574
13575 @item show unwindonsignal
13576 @kindex show unwindonsignal
13577 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13578 @value{GDBN}.
13579
13580 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13581 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13582 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
13583 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
13584 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
13585 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
13586 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
13587 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
13588 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
13589 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
13590
13591 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13592 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13593 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13594 @value{GDBN}.
13595
13596 @end table
13597
13598 @cindex weak alias functions
13599 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
13600 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
13601 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
13602 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
13603 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
13604 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
13605 function instead.
13606
13607 @node Patching
13608 @section Patching Programs
13609
13610 @cindex patching binaries
13611 @cindex writing into executables
13612 @cindex writing into corefiles
13613
13614 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
13615 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
13616 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
13617 patching your program's binary.
13618
13619 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
13620 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
13621 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
13622 repairs.
13623
13624 @table @code
13625 @kindex set write
13626 @item set write on
13627 @itemx set write off
13628 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
13629 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
13630 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
13631
13632 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
13633 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
13634 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
13635
13636 @item show write
13637 @kindex show write
13638 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
13639 as well as reading.
13640 @end table
13641
13642 @node GDB Files
13643 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
13644
13645 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
13646 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
13647 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
13648 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
13649
13650 @menu
13651 * Files:: Commands to specify files
13652 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
13653 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
13654 * Data Files:: GDB data files
13655 @end menu
13656
13657 @node Files
13658 @section Commands to Specify Files
13659
13660 @cindex symbol table
13661 @cindex core dump file
13662
13663 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
13664 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
13665 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
13666 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
13667
13668 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
13669 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
13670 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
13671 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
13672 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
13673 new files are useful.
13674
13675 @table @code
13676 @cindex executable file
13677 @kindex file
13678 @item file @var{filename}
13679 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
13680 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
13681 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
13682 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
13683 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
13684 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
13685 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
13686 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
13687
13688 @cindex unlinked object files
13689 @cindex patching object files
13690 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
13691 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
13692 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
13693 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
13694 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
13695 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
13696 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
13697 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
13698
13699 @item file
13700 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
13701 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
13702
13703 @kindex exec-file
13704 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13705 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
13706 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
13707 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
13708 discard information on the executable file.
13709
13710 @kindex symbol-file
13711 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13712 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
13713 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
13714 table and program to run from the same file.
13715
13716 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
13717 program's symbol table.
13718
13719 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
13720 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
13721 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
13722 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
13723 @value{GDBN}.
13724
13725 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
13726 executing it once.
13727
13728 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
13729 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
13730 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
13731 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
13732 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
13733 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
13734 optimized code.
13735
13736 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
13737 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
13738 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
13739 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
13740 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
13741
13742 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
13743 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
13744 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
13745 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
13746 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
13747 Warnings and Messages}.)
13748
13749 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
13750 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
13751 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
13752 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
13753 in stabs format.
13754
13755 @kindex readnow
13756 @cindex reading symbols immediately
13757 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
13758 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13759 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13760 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
13761 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
13762 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
13763 entire symbol table available.
13764
13765 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
13766 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
13767 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
13768 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
13769 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
13770 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
13771 @c files.
13772
13773 @kindex core-file
13774 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
13775 @itemx core
13776 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
13777 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
13778 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
13779 executable file itself for other parts.
13780
13781 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
13782 to be used.
13783
13784 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
13785 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
13786 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
13787 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
13788 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
13789
13790 @kindex add-symbol-file
13791 @cindex dynamic linking
13792 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
13793 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13794 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
13795 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
13796 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
13797 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
13798 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
13799 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
13800 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
13801 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
13802 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
13803 @var{address} as an expression.
13804
13805 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
13806 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
13807 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
13808 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
13809 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
13810
13811 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
13812 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
13813 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
13814 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
13815 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
13816 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
13817 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
13818 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
13819 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
13820
13821 @itemize @bullet
13822 @item
13823 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
13824 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
13825 @item
13826 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
13827 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
13828 @item
13829 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
13830 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13831 @end itemize
13832
13833 @noindent
13834 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
13835 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
13836 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
13837 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
13838 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
13839 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
13840 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
13841 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
13842 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
13843 way.
13844
13845 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
13846
13847 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
13848 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
13849 @cindex load symbols from memory
13850 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
13851 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
13852 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
13853 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
13854 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
13855 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
13856 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
13857 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
13858 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
13859
13860 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
13861 @kindex assf
13862 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
13863 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
13864 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
13865 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
13866 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
13867 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
13868 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
13869 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
13870 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
13871 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
13872
13873 @kindex section
13874 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
13875 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
13876 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
13877 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
13878 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
13879 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
13880 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
13881 their addresses.
13882
13883 @kindex info files
13884 @kindex info target
13885 @item info files
13886 @itemx info target
13887 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
13888 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
13889 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
13890 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
13891 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
13892 current ones.
13893
13894 @kindex maint info sections
13895 @item maint info sections
13896 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
13897 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
13898 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
13899 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
13900 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
13901 may be arbitrarily combined):
13902
13903 @table @code
13904 @item ALLOBJ
13905 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
13906 @item @var{sections}
13907 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
13908 @item @var{section-flags}
13909 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
13910 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
13911 @table @code
13912 @item ALLOC
13913 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
13914 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
13915 @item LOAD
13916 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13917 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13918 @item RELOC
13919 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13920 @item READONLY
13921 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13922 @item CODE
13923 Section contains executable code only.
13924 @item DATA
13925 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13926 @item ROM
13927 Section will reside in ROM.
13928 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13929 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13930 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13931 Section is not empty.
13932 @item NEVER_LOAD
13933 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13934 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13935 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13936 COFF shared library information.
13937 @item IS_COMMON
13938 Section contains common symbols.
13939 @end table
13940 @end table
13941 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13942 @cindex read-only sections
13943 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13944 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13945 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13946 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13947 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13948 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13949 enhancement to debugging performance.
13950
13951 The default is off.
13952
13953 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13954 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13955 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13956 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13957
13958 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13959 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13960 @end table
13961
13962 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13963 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13964 name and remembers it that way.
13965
13966 @cindex shared libraries
13967 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13968 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13969 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13970
13971 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13972 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13973
13974 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13975 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13976 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13977 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13978 debugging a core file).
13979
13980 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13981 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13982
13983 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13984 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13985 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13986
13987 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13988 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13989 particularly large or there are many of them.
13990
13991 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13992 commands:
13993
13994 @table @code
13995 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13996 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13997 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13998 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13999 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14000 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14001 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14002 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14003
14004 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14005 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14006 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14007 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14008 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14009 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14010 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14011 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14012 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14013
14014 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14015 @item show auto-solib-add
14016 Display the current autoloading mode.
14017 @end table
14018
14019 @cindex load shared library
14020 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14021 command:
14022
14023 @table @code
14024 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14025 @kindex info share
14026 @item info share @var{regex}
14027 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14028 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14029 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14030 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14031
14032 @kindex sharedlibrary
14033 @kindex share
14034 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14035 @itemx share @var{regex}
14036 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14037 Unix regular expression.
14038 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14039 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14040 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14041 loaded.
14042
14043 @item nosharedlibrary
14044 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14045 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14046 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14047 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14048 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14049 discarded.
14050 @end table
14051
14052 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14053 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14054 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14055
14056 @table @code
14057 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14058 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14059 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14060 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14061 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14062 shared library.
14063
14064 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14065 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14066 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14067 library events happen.
14068 @end table
14069
14070 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14071 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14072 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14073 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14074 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14075 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14076 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14077 not.
14078
14079 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14080 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14081 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14082 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14083 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14084
14085 @table @code
14086 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
14087 @cindex system root, alternate
14088 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14089 @kindex set sysroot
14090 @item set sysroot @var{path}
14091 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14092 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14093 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14094 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14095 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14096 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14097 under @var{path}.
14098
14099 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
14100 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
14101 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
14102 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
14103 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
14104 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
14105 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
14106 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
14107 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
14108
14109 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
14110 sysroot}.
14111
14112 @cindex default system root
14113 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
14114 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
14115 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
14116 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14117 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
14118 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14119 location.
14120
14121 @kindex show sysroot
14122 @item show sysroot
14123 Display the current shared library prefix.
14124
14125 @kindex set solib-search-path
14126 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
14127 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
14128 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
14129 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
14130 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
14131 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
14132 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
14133 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
14134 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
14135 of shared library symbols.
14136
14137 @kindex show solib-search-path
14138 @item show solib-search-path
14139 Display the current shared library search path.
14140 @end table
14141
14142
14143 @node Separate Debug Files
14144 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
14145 @cindex separate debugging information files
14146 @cindex debugging information in separate files
14147 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
14148 @cindex debugging information directory, global
14149 @cindex global debugging information directory
14150 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
14151 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
14152
14153 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
14154 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
14155 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
14156 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
14157 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
14158 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
14159 install only when they need to debug a problem.
14160
14161 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
14162 file:
14163
14164 @itemize @bullet
14165 @item
14166 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
14167 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
14168 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
14169 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
14170 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
14171 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
14172 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
14173 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
14174
14175 @item
14176 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
14177 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
14178 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
14179 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
14180 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
14181 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
14182 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
14183 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
14184 below.
14185 @end itemize
14186
14187 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
14188 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
14189
14190 @itemize @bullet
14191 @item
14192 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
14193 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
14194 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
14195 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
14196 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
14197
14198 @item
14199 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
14200 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
14201 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
14202 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
14203 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
14204 hex characters, not 10.)
14205 @end itemize
14206
14207 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
14208 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
14209 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
14210 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
14211 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
14212 debug information files, in the indicated order:
14213
14214 @itemize @minus
14215 @item
14216 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
14217 @item
14218 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
14219 @item
14220 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
14221 @item
14222 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
14223 @end itemize
14224
14225 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
14226 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
14227
14228 @table @code
14229
14230 @kindex set debug-file-directory
14231 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
14232 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14233 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
14234 concatenating them by a directory separator.
14235
14236 @kindex show debug-file-directory
14237 @item show debug-file-directory
14238 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14239 information files.
14240
14241 @end table
14242
14243 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
14244 @cindex debug link sections
14245 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
14246 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
14247
14248 @itemize
14249 @item
14250 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
14251 a zero byte,
14252 @item
14253 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
14254 boundary within the section, and
14255 @item
14256 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
14257 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
14258 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
14259 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
14260 @end itemize
14261
14262 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
14263 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
14264 described above.
14265
14266 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
14267 @cindex build ID sections
14268 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
14269 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
14270 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
14271 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
14272 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
14273 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
14274 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
14275 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
14276 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
14277
14278 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
14279 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
14280 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
14281 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
14282 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
14283 in an ordinary executable.
14284
14285 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
14286 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
14287 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
14288 following commands:
14289
14290 @smallexample
14291 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
14292 @kbd{strip -g foo}
14293 @end smallexample
14294
14295 @noindent
14296 These commands remove the debugging
14297 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
14298 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
14299 two files:
14300
14301 @itemize @bullet
14302 @item
14303 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
14304 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
14305
14306 @smallexample
14307 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
14308 @end smallexample
14309
14310 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
14311 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
14312 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
14313 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
14314
14315 @item
14316 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
14317 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
14318 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
14319 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
14320 @end itemize
14321
14322 @noindent
14323
14324 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
14325 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
14326 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
14327
14328 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
14329 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
14330 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
14331 @c different ways!
14332 @ifhtml
14333 @display
14334 @html
14335 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
14336 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
14337 @end html
14338 @end display
14339 @end ifhtml
14340 @ifnothtml
14341 @display
14342 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
14343 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
14344 @end display
14345 @end ifnothtml
14346
14347 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
14348 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
14349 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
14350 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
14351 CRC.
14352
14353 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
14354 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
14355 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
14356 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
14357 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
14358 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
14359
14360 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
14361 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
14362 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
14363 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
14364 @code{0xffffffff}.
14365
14366 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
14367 @smallexample
14368 unsigned long
14369 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
14370 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
14371 @{
14372 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
14373 @{
14374 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
14375 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
14376 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
14377 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
14378 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
14379 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
14380 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
14381 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
14382 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
14383 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
14384 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
14385 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
14386 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
14387 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
14388 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
14389 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
14390 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
14391 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
14392 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
14393 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
14394 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
14395 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
14396 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
14397 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
14398 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
14399 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
14400 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
14401 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
14402 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
14403 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
14404 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
14405 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
14406 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
14407 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
14408 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
14409 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
14410 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
14411 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
14412 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
14413 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
14414 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
14415 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
14416 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
14417 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
14418 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
14419 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
14420 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
14421 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
14422 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
14423 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
14424 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
14425 0x2d02ef8d
14426 @};
14427 unsigned char *end;
14428
14429 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14430 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
14431 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
14432 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14433 @}
14434 @end smallexample
14435
14436 @noindent
14437 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
14438
14439
14440 @node Symbol Errors
14441 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
14442
14443 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
14444 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
14445 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
14446 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
14447 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
14448 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
14449 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
14450 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
14451 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
14452 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14453 Messages}).
14454
14455 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
14456
14457 @table @code
14458 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
14459
14460 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
14461 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
14462 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
14463 in its outer scope blocks.
14464
14465 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
14466 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
14467 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
14468 function.
14469
14470 @item block at @var{address} out of order
14471
14472 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
14473 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
14474 do so.
14475
14476 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
14477 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
14478 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
14479 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14480 Messages}.)
14481
14482 @item bad block start address patched
14483
14484 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
14485 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
14486 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
14487
14488 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
14489 starting on the previous source line.
14490
14491 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
14492
14493 @cindex foo
14494 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
14495 larger than the size of the string table.
14496
14497 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
14498 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
14499 with this name.
14500
14501 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
14502
14503 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
14504 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
14505 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
14506
14507 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
14508 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
14509 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
14510 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
14511 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
14512 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
14513
14514 @item stub type has NULL name
14515
14516 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
14517
14518 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
14519 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
14520 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
14521 it.
14522
14523 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
14524
14525 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
14526
14527 @end table
14528
14529 @node Data Files
14530 @section GDB Data Files
14531
14532 @cindex prefix for data files
14533 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
14534 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
14535
14536 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
14537 is currently using.
14538
14539 @table @code
14540 @kindex set data-directory
14541 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
14542 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
14543 to @var{directory}.
14544
14545 @kindex show data-directory
14546 @item show data-directory
14547 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
14548 @end table
14549
14550 @cindex default data directory
14551 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
14552 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
14553 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
14554 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14555 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
14556 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14557 location.
14558
14559 @node Targets
14560 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
14561
14562 @cindex debugging target
14563 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
14564
14565 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
14566 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
14567 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
14568 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
14569 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
14570 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
14571 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
14572 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
14573
14574 @cindex target architecture
14575 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
14576 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
14577 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
14578 command.
14579
14580 @table @code
14581 @kindex set architecture
14582 @kindex show architecture
14583 @item set architecture @var{arch}
14584 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
14585 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
14586 supported architectures.
14587
14588 @item show architecture
14589 Show the current target architecture.
14590
14591 @item set processor
14592 @itemx processor
14593 @kindex set processor
14594 @kindex show processor
14595 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
14596 and @code{show architecture}.
14597 @end table
14598
14599 @menu
14600 * Active Targets:: Active targets
14601 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
14602 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
14603 @end menu
14604
14605 @node Active Targets
14606 @section Active Targets
14607
14608 @cindex stacking targets
14609 @cindex active targets
14610 @cindex multiple targets
14611
14612 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
14613 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
14614 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
14615 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
14616 a core file.
14617
14618 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
14619 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
14620 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
14621 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
14622 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
14623 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
14624 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
14625 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
14626 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
14627
14628 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
14629 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
14630 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
14631 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
14632 process target is active.
14633
14634 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
14635 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
14636 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
14637 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
14638 Process}).
14639
14640 @node Target Commands
14641 @section Commands for Managing Targets
14642
14643 @table @code
14644 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
14645 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
14646 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
14647 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
14648 protocol of the target machine.
14649
14650 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
14651 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
14652 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
14653
14654 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
14655 after executing the command.
14656
14657 @kindex help target
14658 @item help target
14659 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
14660 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
14661 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14662
14663 @item help target @var{name}
14664 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
14665 select it.
14666
14667 @kindex set gnutarget
14668 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
14669 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
14670 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
14671 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
14672 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
14673 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
14674
14675 @quotation
14676 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
14677 you must know the actual BFD name.
14678 @end quotation
14679
14680 @noindent
14681 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
14682
14683 @kindex show gnutarget
14684 @item show gnutarget
14685 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
14686 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
14687 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
14688 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
14689 @end table
14690
14691 @cindex common targets
14692 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
14693 configuration):
14694
14695 @table @code
14696 @kindex target
14697 @item target exec @var{program}
14698 @cindex executable file target
14699 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
14700 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
14701
14702 @item target core @var{filename}
14703 @cindex core dump file target
14704 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
14705 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
14706
14707 @item target remote @var{medium}
14708 @cindex remote target
14709 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
14710 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
14711 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
14712
14713 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
14714 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
14715
14716 @smallexample
14717 target remote /dev/ttya
14718 @end smallexample
14719
14720 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
14721 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
14722 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
14723 clobbered by the download.
14724
14725 @item target sim
14726 @cindex built-in simulator target
14727 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
14728 In general,
14729 @smallexample
14730 target sim
14731 load
14732 run
14733 @end smallexample
14734 @noindent
14735 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
14736 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
14737 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
14738 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
14739 Processors}.
14740
14741 @end table
14742
14743 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
14744
14745 @table @code
14746
14747 @item target nrom @var{dev}
14748 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
14749 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
14750
14751 @end table
14752
14753 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
14754 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
14755
14756 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
14757 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
14758 various aspects of this process.
14759
14760 @table @code
14761
14762 @item set hash
14763 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14764 @cindex hash mark while downloading
14765 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
14766 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
14767 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
14768 monitor.
14769
14770 @item show hash
14771 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14772 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
14773
14774 @item set debug monitor
14775 @kindex set debug monitor
14776 @cindex display remote monitor communications
14777 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
14778 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14779
14780 @item show debug monitor
14781 @kindex show debug monitor
14782 Show the current status of displaying communications between
14783 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14784 @end table
14785
14786 @table @code
14787
14788 @kindex load @var{filename}
14789 @item load @var{filename}
14790 @anchor{load}
14791 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
14792 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
14793 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
14794 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
14795 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
14796 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14797
14798 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
14799 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
14800 target is @dots{}}''
14801
14802 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
14803 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
14804 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
14805 specifies a fixed address.
14806 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
14807
14808 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
14809 load programs into flash memory.
14810
14811 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
14812 @end table
14813
14814 @node Byte Order
14815 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
14816
14817 @cindex choosing target byte order
14818 @cindex target byte order
14819
14820 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
14821 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
14822 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
14823 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
14824 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
14825 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
14826
14827 @table @code
14828 @kindex set endian
14829 @item set endian big
14830 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
14831
14832 @item set endian little
14833 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
14834
14835 @item set endian auto
14836 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
14837 executable.
14838
14839 @item show endian
14840 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
14841
14842 @end table
14843
14844 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
14845 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
14846 target system.
14847
14848
14849 @node Remote Debugging
14850 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
14851 @cindex remote debugging
14852
14853 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
14854 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
14855 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
14856 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
14857 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
14858
14859 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
14860 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
14861 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
14862 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
14863 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
14864 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
14865
14866 Other remote targets may be available in your
14867 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
14868
14869 @menu
14870 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
14871 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
14872 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
14873 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
14874 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
14875 @end menu
14876
14877 @node Connecting
14878 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
14879
14880 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
14881 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
14882 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
14883 program as the first argument.
14884
14885 @cindex @code{target remote}
14886 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
14887 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
14888 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
14889 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
14890 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
14891 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
14892
14893 @table @code
14894
14895 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
14896 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
14897 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
14898 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
14899
14900 @smallexample
14901 target remote /dev/ttyb
14902 @end smallexample
14903
14904 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
14905 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
14906 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
14907 @code{target} command.
14908
14909 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
14910 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14911 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
14912 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
14913 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
14914 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
14915 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
14916 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
14917 target.
14918
14919 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
14920 @code{manyfarms}:
14921
14922 @smallexample
14923 target remote manyfarms:2828
14924 @end smallexample
14925
14926 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
14927 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
14928 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
14929 port 1234 on your local machine:
14930
14931 @smallexample
14932 target remote :1234
14933 @end smallexample
14934 @noindent
14935
14936 Note that the colon is still required here.
14937
14938 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14939 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
14940 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
14941 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
14942
14943 @smallexample
14944 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
14945 @end smallexample
14946
14947 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
14948 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
14949 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
14950 cause havoc with your debugging session.
14951
14952 @item target remote | @var{command}
14953 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
14954 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
14955 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
14956 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
14957 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
14958 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
14959 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
14960 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
14961
14962 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
14963 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
14964 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
14965
14966 @end table
14967
14968 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
14969 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
14970 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
14971 need to use @kbd{run}.
14972
14973 @cindex interrupting remote programs
14974 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
14975 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
14976 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
14977 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
14978 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
14979 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
14980
14981 @smallexample
14982 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
14983 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
14984 @end smallexample
14985
14986 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14987 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14988 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14989 goes back to waiting.
14990
14991 @table @code
14992 @kindex detach (remote)
14993 @item detach
14994 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14995 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14996 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14997 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14998 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14999
15000 @kindex disconnect
15001 @item disconnect
15002 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
15003 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
15004 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
15005 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
15006 another target.
15007
15008 @cindex send command to remote monitor
15009 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
15010 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
15011 @kindex monitor
15012 @item monitor @var{cmd}
15013 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
15014 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
15015 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
15016 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
15017 and implement.
15018 @end table
15019
15020 @node File Transfer
15021 @section Sending files to a remote system
15022 @cindex remote target, file transfer
15023 @cindex file transfer
15024 @cindex sending files to remote systems
15025
15026 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
15027 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
15028 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
15029 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
15030 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
15031 the only way to upload or download files.
15032
15033 Not all remote targets support these commands.
15034
15035 @table @code
15036 @kindex remote put
15037 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
15038 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
15039 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
15040
15041 @kindex remote get
15042 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
15043 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
15044 on the host system.
15045
15046 @kindex remote delete
15047 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
15048 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
15049
15050 @end table
15051
15052 @node Server
15053 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
15054
15055 @kindex gdbserver
15056 @cindex remote connection without stubs
15057 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
15058 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
15059 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
15060
15061 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
15062 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
15063 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
15064 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
15065 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
15066 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
15067 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
15068 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
15069 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
15070 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
15071 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
15072 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
15073 choice for debugging.
15074
15075 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
15076 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
15077 protocol.
15078
15079 @quotation
15080 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
15081 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
15082 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
15083 target system with the same privileges as the user running
15084 @code{gdbserver}.
15085 @end quotation
15086
15087 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
15088 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
15089
15090 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
15091 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
15092 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
15093 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
15094 system does all the symbol handling.
15095
15096 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
15097 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
15098 syntax is:
15099
15100 @smallexample
15101 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
15102 @end smallexample
15103
15104 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
15105 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
15106 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
15107 @file{/dev/com1}:
15108
15109 @smallexample
15110 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
15111 @end smallexample
15112
15113 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
15114 with it.
15115
15116 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
15117
15118 @smallexample
15119 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
15120 @end smallexample
15121
15122 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
15123 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
15124 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
15125 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
15126 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
15127 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
15128 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
15129 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
15130 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
15131 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
15132 @code{target remote} command.
15133
15134 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
15135
15136 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
15137 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
15138
15139 @smallexample
15140 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
15141 @end smallexample
15142
15143 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
15144 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
15145
15146 @pindex pidof
15147 @cindex attach to a program by name
15148 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
15149 @code{pidof} utility:
15150
15151 @smallexample
15152 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
15153 @end smallexample
15154
15155 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
15156 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
15157 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
15158
15159 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
15160 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
15161 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
15162
15163 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
15164 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
15165 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
15166 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
15167
15168 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
15169 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
15170 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
15171 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
15172 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
15173 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
15174 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
15175 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
15176 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
15177
15178 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
15179 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
15180 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
15181 the program you want to debug.
15182
15183 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
15184 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
15185 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
15186
15187 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
15188
15189 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
15190 status information about the debugging process. The
15191 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
15192 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
15193 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
15194
15195 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
15196 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
15197 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
15198 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
15199
15200 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
15201 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
15202 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
15203 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
15204
15205 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
15206 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
15207 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
15208 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
15209
15210 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
15211 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
15212 environment:
15213
15214 @smallexample
15215 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
15216 @end smallexample
15217
15218 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
15219
15220 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
15221
15222 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
15223 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
15224 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
15225 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
15226
15227 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
15228 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
15229 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
15230 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
15231 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
15232 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
15233 programs.
15234
15235 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15236 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
15237 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
15238 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
15239 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
15240 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
15241 already on the target.
15242
15243 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
15244 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
15245 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
15246
15247 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
15248 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
15249 Here are the available commands.
15250
15251 @table @code
15252 @item monitor help
15253 List the available monitor commands.
15254
15255 @item monitor set debug 0
15256 @itemx monitor set debug 1
15257 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
15258
15259 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
15260 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
15261 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
15262 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
15263
15264 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
15265 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
15266 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15267 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
15268 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
15269 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
15270
15271 @item monitor exit
15272 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
15273 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
15274 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
15275 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
15276 of a multi-process mode debug session.
15277
15278 @end table
15279
15280 @node Remote Configuration
15281 @section Remote Configuration
15282
15283 @kindex set remote
15284 @kindex show remote
15285 This section documents the configuration options available when
15286 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
15287 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
15288 system-call-allowed}.
15289
15290 @table @code
15291 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
15292 @cindex address size for remote targets
15293 @cindex bits in remote address
15294 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
15295 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
15296 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
15297 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
15298
15299 @item show remoteaddresssize
15300 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
15301
15302 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
15303 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
15304 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
15305 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
15306 remote targets.
15307
15308 @item show remotebaud
15309 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
15310
15311 @item set remotebreak
15312 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15313 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
15314 @anchor{set remotebreak}
15315 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
15316 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
15317 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
15318 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
15319 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
15320
15321 @item show remotebreak
15322 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
15323 interrupt the remote program.
15324
15325 @item set remoteflow on
15326 @itemx set remoteflow off
15327 @kindex set remoteflow
15328 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
15329 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
15330
15331 @item show remoteflow
15332 @kindex show remoteflow
15333 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
15334
15335 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
15336 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
15337 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
15338 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
15339 @code{ascii}.
15340
15341 @item show remotelogbase
15342 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
15343 protocol.
15344
15345 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
15346 @cindex record serial communications on file
15347 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
15348 default is not to record at all.
15349
15350 @item show remotelogfile.
15351 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
15352 serial communications.
15353
15354 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
15355 @cindex timeout for serial communications
15356 @cindex remote timeout
15357 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
15358 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
15359
15360 @item show remotetimeout
15361 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
15362 responses.
15363
15364 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
15365 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
15366 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
15367 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
15368 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
15369 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
15370 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
15371 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
15372
15373 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
15374 @itemx show remote exec-file
15375 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
15376 @cindex executable file, for remote target
15377 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
15378 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
15379 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
15380 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
15381
15382 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
15383 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15384 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
15385 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
15386 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
15387 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
15388 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
15389 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
15390 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
15391 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
15392
15393 @item show interrupt-sequence
15394 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
15395 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
15396 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
15397 also known as Magic SysRq g.
15398
15399 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
15400 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
15401 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
15402 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
15403 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
15404 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
15405
15406 @item show interrupt-on-connect
15407 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
15408 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
15409
15410 @kindex set tcp
15411 @kindex show tcp
15412 @item set tcp auto-retry on
15413 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
15414 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
15415 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
15416 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
15417 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
15418 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
15419 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
15420 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
15421
15422 @item set tcp auto-retry off
15423 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
15424
15425 @item show tcp auto-retry
15426 Show the current auto-retry setting.
15427
15428 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
15429 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
15430 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
15431 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
15432 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
15433 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
15434 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
15435 value.
15436
15437 @item show tcp connect-timeout
15438 Show the current connection timeout setting.
15439 @end table
15440
15441 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
15442 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
15443 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
15444 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
15445 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
15446 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
15447 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
15448 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
15449 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
15450
15451 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
15452 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
15453 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
15454 @value{GDBN} developers.
15455
15456 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
15457 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
15458 are:
15459
15460 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
15461 @item Command Name
15462 @tab Remote Packet
15463 @tab Related Features
15464
15465 @item @code{fetch-register}
15466 @tab @code{p}
15467 @tab @code{info registers}
15468
15469 @item @code{set-register}
15470 @tab @code{P}
15471 @tab @code{set}
15472
15473 @item @code{binary-download}
15474 @tab @code{X}
15475 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
15476
15477 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
15478 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
15479 @tab @code{info auxv}
15480
15481 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
15482 @tab @code{qSymbol}
15483 @tab Detecting multiple threads
15484
15485 @item @code{attach}
15486 @tab @code{vAttach}
15487 @tab @code{attach}
15488
15489 @item @code{verbose-resume}
15490 @tab @code{vCont}
15491 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
15492
15493 @item @code{run}
15494 @tab @code{vRun}
15495 @tab @code{run}
15496
15497 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
15498 @tab @code{Z0}
15499 @tab @code{break}
15500
15501 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
15502 @tab @code{Z1}
15503 @tab @code{hbreak}
15504
15505 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
15506 @tab @code{Z2}
15507 @tab @code{watch}
15508
15509 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
15510 @tab @code{Z3}
15511 @tab @code{rwatch}
15512
15513 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
15514 @tab @code{Z4}
15515 @tab @code{awatch}
15516
15517 @item @code{target-features}
15518 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
15519 @tab @code{set architecture}
15520
15521 @item @code{library-info}
15522 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
15523 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
15524
15525 @item @code{memory-map}
15526 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
15527 @tab @code{info mem}
15528
15529 @item @code{read-spu-object}
15530 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
15531 @tab @code{info spu}
15532
15533 @item @code{write-spu-object}
15534 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
15535 @tab @code{info spu}
15536
15537 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
15538 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
15539 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
15540
15541 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
15542 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
15543 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
15544
15545 @item @code{threads}
15546 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
15547 @tab @code{info threads}
15548
15549 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
15550 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
15551 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
15552
15553 @item @code{search-memory}
15554 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
15555 @tab @code{find}
15556
15557 @item @code{supported-packets}
15558 @tab @code{qSupported}
15559 @tab Remote communications parameters
15560
15561 @item @code{pass-signals}
15562 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
15563 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
15564
15565 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
15566 @tab @code{vFile:close}
15567 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15568
15569 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
15570 @tab @code{vFile:open}
15571 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15572
15573 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
15574 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
15575 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15576
15577 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
15578 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
15579 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15580
15581 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
15582 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
15583 @tab @code{remote delete}
15584
15585 @item @code{noack-packet}
15586 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
15587 @tab Packet acknowledgment
15588
15589 @item @code{osdata}
15590 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
15591 @tab @code{info os}
15592
15593 @item @code{query-attached}
15594 @tab @code{qAttached}
15595 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
15596 @end multitable
15597
15598 @node Remote Stub
15599 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
15600
15601 @cindex debugging stub, example
15602 @cindex remote stub, example
15603 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
15604 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
15605 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
15606 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
15607 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
15608 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
15609 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
15610 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
15611
15612 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
15613 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
15614 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
15615 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
15616 program, you need:
15617
15618 @enumerate
15619 @item
15620 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
15621 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
15622 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
15623
15624 @item
15625 A C subroutine library to support your program's
15626 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
15627
15628 @item
15629 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
15630 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
15631 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
15632 documentation.
15633 @end enumerate
15634
15635 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
15636 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
15637 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
15638
15639 @table @emph
15640 @item On the host,
15641 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
15642 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
15643 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
15644
15645 @item On the target,
15646 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
15647 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
15648 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
15649
15650 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
15651 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
15652 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
15653 @end table
15654
15655 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
15656 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
15657 @sc{sparc} boards.
15658
15659 @cindex remote serial stub list
15660 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
15661
15662 @table @code
15663
15664 @item i386-stub.c
15665 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
15666 @cindex Intel
15667 @cindex i386
15668 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
15669
15670 @item m68k-stub.c
15671 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
15672 @cindex Motorola 680x0
15673 @cindex m680x0
15674 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
15675
15676 @item sh-stub.c
15677 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
15678 @cindex Renesas
15679 @cindex SH
15680 For Renesas SH architectures.
15681
15682 @item sparc-stub.c
15683 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
15684 @cindex Sparc
15685 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
15686
15687 @item sparcl-stub.c
15688 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
15689 @cindex Fujitsu
15690 @cindex SparcLite
15691 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
15692
15693 @end table
15694
15695 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
15696 recently added stubs.
15697
15698 @menu
15699 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
15700 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
15701 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
15702 @end menu
15703
15704 @node Stub Contents
15705 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
15706
15707 @cindex remote serial stub
15708 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
15709 subroutines:
15710
15711 @table @code
15712 @item set_debug_traps
15713 @findex set_debug_traps
15714 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
15715 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
15716 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
15717 beginning of your program.
15718
15719 @item handle_exception
15720 @findex handle_exception
15721 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
15722 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
15723 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
15724 run when a trap is triggered.
15725
15726 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
15727 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
15728 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
15729 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
15730 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
15731 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
15732 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
15733 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
15734 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
15735 machine.
15736
15737 @item breakpoint
15738 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
15739 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
15740 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
15741 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
15742 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
15743 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
15744 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
15745 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
15746 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
15747 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
15748 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
15749
15750 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
15751 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
15752 start of your debugging session.
15753 @end table
15754
15755 @node Bootstrapping
15756 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
15757
15758 @cindex remote stub, support routines
15759 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
15760 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
15761 debugging target machine.
15762
15763 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
15764 serial port.
15765
15766 @table @code
15767 @item int getDebugChar()
15768 @findex getDebugChar
15769 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
15770 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
15771 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15772
15773 @item void putDebugChar(int)
15774 @findex putDebugChar
15775 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
15776 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
15777 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15778 @end table
15779
15780 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
15781 @cindex interrupting remote targets
15782 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
15783 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
15784 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
15785 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
15786 remote system to stop.
15787
15788 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
15789 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
15790 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
15791 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
15792
15793 Other routines you need to supply are:
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
15797 @findex exceptionHandler
15798 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
15799 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
15800 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
15801 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
15802 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
15803 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
15804 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
15805 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
15806 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
15807 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
15808 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
15809 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
15810 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
15811
15812 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
15813 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
15814 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
15815 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
15816 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
15817
15818 @item void flush_i_cache()
15819 @findex flush_i_cache
15820 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
15821 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
15822 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
15823
15824 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
15825 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
15826 @end table
15827
15828 @noindent
15829 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
15830
15831 @table @code
15832 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
15833 @findex memset
15834 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
15835 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
15836 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
15837 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
15838 @end table
15839
15840 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
15841 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
15842 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
15843 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
15844
15845
15846 @node Debug Session
15847 @subsection Putting it All Together
15848
15849 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
15850 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
15851 steps.
15852
15853 @enumerate
15854 @item
15855 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
15856 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
15857 @display
15858 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
15859 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
15860 @end display
15861
15862 @item
15863 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
15864
15865 @smallexample
15866 set_debug_traps();
15867 breakpoint();
15868 @end smallexample
15869
15870 @item
15871 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
15872 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
15873
15874 @smallexample
15875 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
15876 @end smallexample
15877
15878 @noindent
15879 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
15880 function in your program, that function is called when
15881 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
15882 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
15883 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
15884
15885 @item
15886 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
15887 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
15888
15889 @item
15890 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
15891 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
15892
15893 @item
15894 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
15895 @c document that. FIXME.
15896 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
15897 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
15898
15899 @item
15900 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
15901 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15902
15903 @end enumerate
15904
15905 @node Configurations
15906 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
15907
15908 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
15909 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
15910 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
15911
15912 There are three major categories of configurations: native
15913 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
15914 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
15915 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
15916 are quite different from each other.
15917
15918 @menu
15919 * Native::
15920 * Embedded OS::
15921 * Embedded Processors::
15922 * Architectures::
15923 @end menu
15924
15925 @node Native
15926 @section Native
15927
15928 This section describes details specific to particular native
15929 configurations.
15930
15931 @menu
15932 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
15933 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
15934 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
15935 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
15936 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
15937 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
15938 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
15939 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
15940 @end menu
15941
15942 @node HP-UX
15943 @subsection HP-UX
15944
15945 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
15946 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
15947 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
15948
15949
15950 @node BSD libkvm Interface
15951 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
15952
15953 @cindex libkvm
15954 @cindex kernel memory image
15955 @cindex kernel crash dump
15956
15957 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
15958 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
15959 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
15960 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
15961 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
15962 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
15963 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
15964 @code{kvm} target:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
15968 @end smallexample
15969
15970 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
15971 argument:
15972
15973 @smallexample
15974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
15975 @end smallexample
15976
15977 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
15978 available:
15979
15980 @table @code
15981 @kindex kvm
15982 @item kvm pcb
15983 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
15984
15985 @item kvm proc
15986 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
15987 modern FreeBSD systems.
15988 @end table
15989
15990 @node SVR4 Process Information
15991 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
15992 @cindex /proc
15993 @cindex examine process image
15994 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
15995
15996 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
15997 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
15998 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
15999 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
16000 proc} is available to report information about the process running
16001 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
16002 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
16003 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
16004 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
16005
16006 @table @code
16007 @kindex info proc
16008 @cindex process ID
16009 @item info proc
16010 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
16011 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
16012 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
16013 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
16014 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
16015 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
16016 executable file's absolute file name.
16017
16018 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
16019 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
16020 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
16021 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
16022 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
16023 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
16024
16025 @item info proc mappings
16026 @cindex memory address space mappings
16027 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
16028 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
16029 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
16030 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
16031 memory access rights to that range.
16032
16033 @item info proc stat
16034 @itemx info proc status
16035 @cindex process detailed status information
16036 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
16037 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
16038 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
16039 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
16040 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
16041 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
16042 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
16043
16044 @item info proc all
16045 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
16046 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
16047
16048 @ignore
16049 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
16050 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
16051 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
16052 @kindex info proc times
16053 @item info proc times
16054 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
16055 its children.
16056
16057 @kindex info proc id
16058 @item info proc id
16059 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
16060 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
16061 @end ignore
16062
16063 @item set procfs-trace
16064 @kindex set procfs-trace
16065 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
16066 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
16067
16068 @item show procfs-trace
16069 @kindex show procfs-trace
16070 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
16071
16072 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
16073 @kindex set procfs-file
16074 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
16075 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
16076 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
16077 standard output.
16078
16079 @item show procfs-file
16080 @kindex show procfs-file
16081 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
16082
16083 @item proc-trace-entry
16084 @itemx proc-trace-exit
16085 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
16086 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
16087 @kindex proc-trace-entry
16088 @kindex proc-trace-exit
16089 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
16090 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
16091 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
16092 from the @code{syscall} interface.
16093
16094 @item info pidlist
16095 @kindex info pidlist
16096 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
16097 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
16098 processes and all the threads within each process.
16099
16100 @item info meminfo
16101 @kindex info meminfo
16102 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
16103 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
16104 @end table
16105
16106 @node DJGPP Native
16107 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
16108 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
16109 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
16110 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
16111
16112 @cindex DPMI
16113 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
16114 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
16115 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
16116 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
16117
16118 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
16119 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
16120 subsection describes those commands.
16121
16122 @table @code
16123 @kindex info dos
16124 @item info dos
16125 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
16126 information about the target system and important OS structures.
16127
16128 @kindex sysinfo
16129 @cindex MS-DOS system info
16130 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
16131 @item info dos sysinfo
16132 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
16133 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
16134 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
16135
16136 @cindex GDT
16137 @cindex LDT
16138 @cindex IDT
16139 @cindex segment descriptor tables
16140 @cindex descriptor tables display
16141 @item info dos gdt
16142 @itemx info dos ldt
16143 @itemx info dos idt
16144 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
16145 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
16146 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
16147 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
16148 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
16149 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
16150 rights.
16151
16152 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
16153 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
16154 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
16155 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
16156 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
16157
16158 @cindex garbled pointers
16159 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
16160 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
16161 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
16162 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
16163 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
16164 debugged program's data segment:
16165
16166 @smallexample
16167 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
16168 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
16169 @end smallexample
16170
16171 @noindent
16172 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
16173 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
16174
16175 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
16176 @item info dos pde
16177 @itemx info dos pte
16178 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
16179 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
16180 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
16181 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
16182 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
16183 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
16184 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
16185 that is currently in use.
16186
16187 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
16188 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
16189 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
16190 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
16191 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
16192 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
16193 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
16194
16195 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
16196 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
16197 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
16198 controller.
16199
16200 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
16201
16202 @cindex physical address from linear address
16203 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
16204 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
16205 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
16206 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
16207 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
16208 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
16209 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
16210
16211 @smallexample
16212 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
16213 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
16214 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
16215 @end smallexample
16216
16217 @noindent
16218 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
16219 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
16220 attributes of that page.
16221
16222 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
16223 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
16224 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
16225 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
16226 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
16227 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
16228
16229 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
16230 transfer buffer:
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
16234 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
16235 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
16236 @end smallexample
16237
16238 @noindent
16239 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
16240 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
16241 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
16242 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
16243 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
16244
16245 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
16246 @end table
16247
16248 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
16249 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
16250 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
16251 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
16252
16253 @table @code
16254 @kindex set com1base
16255 @kindex set com1irq
16256 @kindex set com2base
16257 @kindex set com2irq
16258 @kindex set com3base
16259 @kindex set com3irq
16260 @kindex set com4base
16261 @kindex set com4irq
16262 @item set com1base @var{addr}
16263 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
16264 port.
16265
16266 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
16267 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
16268 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
16269
16270 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
16271 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
16272 other 3 COM ports.
16273
16274 @kindex show com1base
16275 @kindex show com1irq
16276 @kindex show com2base
16277 @kindex show com2irq
16278 @kindex show com3base
16279 @kindex show com3irq
16280 @kindex show com4base
16281 @kindex show com4irq
16282 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
16283 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
16284 lines used by the COM ports.
16285
16286 @item info serial
16287 @kindex info serial
16288 @cindex DOS serial port status
16289 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
16290 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
16291 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
16292 counts of various errors encountered so far.
16293 @end table
16294
16295
16296 @node Cygwin Native
16297 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
16298 @cindex MS Windows debugging
16299 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
16300 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
16301
16302 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
16303 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
16304
16305 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
16306 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
16307 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
16308 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
16309 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
16310 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
16311 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
16312 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
16313
16314 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
16315 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
16316 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
16317
16318 @table @code
16319 @kindex info w32
16320 @item info w32
16321 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
16322 information about the target system and important OS structures.
16323
16324 @item info w32 selector
16325 This command displays information returned by
16326 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
16327 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
16328 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
16329 Without argument, this command displays information
16330 about the six segment registers.
16331
16332 @kindex info dll
16333 @item info dll
16334 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
16335
16336 @kindex dll-symbols
16337 @item dll-symbols
16338 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
16339 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
16340
16341 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
16342 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
16343 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
16344 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
16345 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
16346 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
16347 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
16348 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
16349 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
16350 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
16351 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
16352
16353 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
16354 @item show cygwin-exceptions
16355 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
16356 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
16357
16358 @kindex set new-console
16359 @item set new-console @var{mode}
16360 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
16361 be started in a new console on next start.
16362 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
16363 be started in the same console as the debugger.
16364
16365 @kindex show new-console
16366 @item show new-console
16367 Displays whether a new console is used
16368 when the debuggee is started.
16369
16370 @kindex set new-group
16371 @item set new-group @var{mode}
16372 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
16373 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
16374 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
16375 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
16376
16377 @kindex show new-group
16378 @item show new-group
16379 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
16380
16381 @kindex set debugevents
16382 @item set debugevents
16383 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
16384 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
16385 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
16386 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
16387 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
16388
16389 @kindex set debugexec
16390 @item set debugexec
16391 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
16392 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
16393
16394 @kindex set debugexceptions
16395 @item set debugexceptions
16396 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
16397 debuggee seen by the debugger.
16398
16399 @kindex set debugmemory
16400 @item set debugmemory
16401 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
16402 and writes by the debugger.
16403
16404 @kindex set shell
16405 @item set shell
16406 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
16407 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
16408
16409 @kindex show shell
16410 @item show shell
16411 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
16412
16413 @end table
16414
16415 @menu
16416 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
16417 @end menu
16418
16419 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
16420 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
16421 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
16422 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
16423
16424 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
16425 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
16426 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
16427 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
16428 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
16429 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
16430 ``minimal symbols''.
16431
16432 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
16433 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
16434 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
16435 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
16436 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
16437 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
16438 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
16439 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
16440 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
16441 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
16442
16443 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
16444
16445 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
16446 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
16447 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
16448 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
16449 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
16450 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
16451 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
16452 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
16453 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
16454
16455 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
16456 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
16457 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
16458 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
16459 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
16460 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
16461
16462 @smallexample
16463 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
16464 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
16465
16466 Non-debugging symbols:
16467 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
16468 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
16469 @end smallexample
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
16473 All functions matching regular expression "!":
16474
16475 Non-debugging symbols:
16476 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
16477 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
16478 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
16479 [etc...]
16480 @end smallexample
16481
16482 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
16483
16484 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
16485 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
16486 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
16487 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
16488 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
16489 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
16490 a function within a DLL without a running program.
16491
16492 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
16493 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
16494 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
16495 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
16496 problem:
16497
16498 @smallexample
16499 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
16500 $1 = 268572168
16501 @end smallexample
16502
16503 @smallexample
16504 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
16505 0x10021610: "\230y\""
16506 @end smallexample
16507
16508 And two possible solutions:
16509
16510 @smallexample
16511 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
16512 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16513 @end smallexample
16514
16515 @smallexample
16516 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
16517 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
16518 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
16519 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
16520 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
16521 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16522 @end smallexample
16523
16524 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
16525 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
16526 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
16527 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
16528 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
16529
16530 @smallexample
16531 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
16532 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
16533 @end smallexample
16534
16535 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
16536 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
16537 safe.
16538
16539 @node Hurd Native
16540 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
16541 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
16542
16543 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
16544 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
16545
16546 @table @code
16547 @item set signals
16548 @itemx set sigs
16549 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
16550 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16551 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
16552 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
16553 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
16554 @code{signals}.
16555
16556 @item show signals
16557 @itemx show sigs
16558 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
16559 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16560 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
16561
16562 @item set signal-thread
16563 @itemx set sigthread
16564 @kindex set signal-thread
16565 @kindex set sigthread
16566 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
16567 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
16568 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
16569 signal-thread}.
16570
16571 @item show signal-thread
16572 @itemx show sigthread
16573 @kindex show signal-thread
16574 @kindex show sigthread
16575 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
16576 delivered a signal.
16577
16578 @item set stopped
16579 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16580 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
16581 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
16582 continued by delivering a signal to it.
16583
16584 @item show stopped
16585 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16586 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
16587 stopped.
16588
16589 @item set exceptions
16590 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16591 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
16592 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
16593 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
16594 trapping on.
16595
16596 @item show exceptions
16597 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16598 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
16599
16600 @item set task pause
16601 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
16602 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16603 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16604 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
16605 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
16606 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
16607 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
16608 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
16609 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
16610
16611 @item show task pause
16612 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
16613 Show the current state of task suspension.
16614
16615 @item set task detach-suspend-count
16616 @cindex task suspend count
16617 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16618 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
16619 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
16620
16621 @item show task detach-suspend-count
16622 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
16623
16624 @item set task exception-port
16625 @itemx set task excp
16626 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16627 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
16628 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
16629 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
16630
16631 @item set noninvasive
16632 @cindex noninvasive task options
16633 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
16634 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
16635 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
16636 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
16637
16638 @item info send-rights
16639 @itemx info receive-rights
16640 @itemx info port-rights
16641 @itemx info port-sets
16642 @itemx info dead-names
16643 @itemx info ports
16644 @itemx info psets
16645 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16646 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16647 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16648 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16649 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16650 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
16651 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
16652 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
16653 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
16654
16655 @item set thread pause
16656 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
16657 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16658 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16659 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
16660 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
16661 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
16662 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
16663 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
16664 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
16665 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
16666 only the current thread.
16667
16668 @item show thread pause
16669 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
16670 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
16671
16672 @item set thread run
16673 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16674
16675 @item show thread run
16676 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16677
16678 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
16679 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16680 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16681 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
16682 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
16683 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
16684 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
16685
16686 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
16687 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
16688 detaching.
16689
16690 @item set thread exception-port
16691 @itemx set thread excp
16692 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
16693 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
16694 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
16695
16696 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
16697 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
16698 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
16699 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
16700
16701 @item set thread default
16702 @itemx show thread default
16703 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16704 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
16705 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
16706 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
16707 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
16708 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
16709 the non-default commands.
16710 @end table
16711
16712
16713 @node Neutrino
16714 @subsection QNX Neutrino
16715 @cindex QNX Neutrino
16716
16717 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
16718 Neutrino target:
16719
16720 @table @code
16721 @item set debug nto-debug
16722 @kindex set debug nto-debug
16723 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
16724 Neutrino support.
16725
16726 @item show debug nto-debug
16727 @kindex show debug nto-debug
16728 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
16729 @end table
16730
16731 @node Darwin
16732 @subsection Darwin
16733 @cindex Darwin
16734
16735 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
16736
16737 @table @code
16738 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
16739 @kindex set debug darwin
16740 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
16741 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
16742
16743 @item show debug darwin
16744 @kindex show debug darwin
16745 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
16746
16747 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
16748 @kindex set debug mach-o
16749 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
16750 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
16751 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
16752 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
16753 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
16754 usage.
16755
16756 @item show debug mach-o
16757 @kindex show debug mach-o
16758 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
16759
16760 @item set mach-exceptions on
16761 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
16762 @kindex set mach-exceptions
16763 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
16764 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
16765 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
16766 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
16767
16768 @item show mach-exceptions
16769 @kindex show mach-exceptions
16770 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
16771 @end table
16772
16773
16774 @node Embedded OS
16775 @section Embedded Operating Systems
16776
16777 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
16778 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
16779 architectures.
16780
16781 @menu
16782 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16783 @end menu
16784
16785 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
16786 various real-time operating systems.
16787
16788 @node VxWorks
16789 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16790
16791 @cindex VxWorks
16792
16793 @table @code
16794
16795 @kindex target vxworks
16796 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
16797 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
16798 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
16799
16800 @end table
16801
16802 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
16803 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
16804
16805 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
16806 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
16807 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16808 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
16809 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
16810 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
16811 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
16812
16813 @table @code
16814 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
16815 @kindex vxworks-timeout
16816 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
16817 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16818 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
16819 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
16820 of a thin network line.
16821 @end table
16822
16823 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
16824 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
16825 procedures.
16826
16827 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
16828 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
16829 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
16830 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
16831 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
16832 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
16833 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
16834 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
16835 manual.
16836 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
16837
16838 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
16839 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16840 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
16841 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
16842
16843 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16844
16845 @smallexample
16846 (vxgdb)
16847 @end smallexample
16848
16849 @menu
16850 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
16851 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
16852 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
16853 @end menu
16854
16855 @node VxWorks Connection
16856 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
16857
16858 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
16859 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
16860
16861 @smallexample
16862 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
16863 @end smallexample
16864
16865 @need 750
16866 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16867
16868 @smallexample
16869 Attaching remote machine across net...
16870 Connected to tt.
16871 @end smallexample
16872
16873 @need 1000
16874 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
16875 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
16876 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
16877 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
16878 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
16879
16880 @smallexample
16881 prog.o: No such file or directory.
16882 @end smallexample
16883
16884 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
16885 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
16886 command again.
16887
16888 @node VxWorks Download
16889 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
16890
16891 @cindex download to VxWorks
16892 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
16893 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
16894 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
16895 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
16896 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
16897 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
16898 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
16899 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
16900 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
16901 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
16902 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
16903 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
16904 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
16905 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
16906 program, type this on VxWorks:
16907
16908 @smallexample
16909 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
16910 @end smallexample
16911
16912 @noindent
16913 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16914
16915 @smallexample
16916 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
16917 (vxgdb) load prog.o
16918 @end smallexample
16919
16920 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
16921
16922 @smallexample
16923 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
16924 @end smallexample
16925
16926 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
16927 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
16928 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
16929 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
16930 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
16931 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
16932 table.)
16933
16934 @node VxWorks Attach
16935 @subsubsection Running Tasks
16936
16937 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
16938 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
16939 follows:
16940
16941 @smallexample
16942 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
16943 @end smallexample
16944
16945 @noindent
16946 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
16947 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
16948 the time of attachment.
16949
16950 @node Embedded Processors
16951 @section Embedded Processors
16952
16953 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
16954 configurations.
16955
16956 @cindex send command to simulator
16957 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
16958 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
16959
16960 @table @code
16961 @item sim @var{command}
16962 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
16963 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
16964 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
16965 acceptable commands.
16966 @end table
16967
16968
16969 @menu
16970 * ARM:: ARM RDI
16971 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
16972 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
16973 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
16974 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
16975 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
16976 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
16977 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
16978 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
16979 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
16980 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
16981 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
16982 * CRIS:: CRIS
16983 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
16984 @end menu
16985
16986 @node ARM
16987 @subsection ARM
16988 @cindex ARM RDI
16989
16990 @table @code
16991 @kindex target rdi
16992 @item target rdi @var{dev}
16993 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
16994 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
16995 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
16996
16997 @kindex target rdp
16998 @item target rdp @var{dev}
16999 ARM Demon monitor.
17000
17001 @end table
17002
17003 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
17004
17005 @table @code
17006 @item set arm disassembler
17007 @kindex set arm
17008 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
17009 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
17010
17011 @item show arm disassembler
17012 @kindex show arm
17013 Show the current disassembly style.
17014
17015 @item set arm apcs32
17016 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
17017 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
17018
17019 @item show arm apcs32
17020 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
17021
17022 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
17023 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
17024 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
17025
17026 @table @code
17027 @item auto
17028 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
17029 @item softfpa
17030 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
17031 processors.
17032 @item fpa
17033 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
17034 @item softvfp
17035 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
17036 @item vfp
17037 VFP co-processor.
17038 @end table
17039
17040 @item show arm fpu
17041 Show the current type of the FPU.
17042
17043 @item set arm abi
17044 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
17045
17046 @item show arm abi
17047 Show the currently used ABI.
17048
17049 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17050 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
17051 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
17052 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
17053 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
17054 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
17055 register).
17056
17057 @item show arm fallback-mode
17058 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
17059
17060 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17061 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
17062 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
17063 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
17064 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
17065
17066 @item show arm force-mode
17067 Show the current forced instruction mode.
17068
17069 @item set debug arm
17070 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
17071 target support subsystem.
17072
17073 @item show debug arm
17074 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
17075 @end table
17076
17077 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
17078 using the RDI interface:
17079
17080 @table @code
17081 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17082 @kindex rdilogfile
17083 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
17084 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
17085 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
17086 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
17087 @file{rdi.log}.
17088
17089 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
17090 @kindex rdilogenable
17091 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
17092 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
17093 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
17094 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
17095 are logged to a file.
17096
17097 @item set rdiromatzero
17098 @kindex set rdiromatzero
17099 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
17100 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
17101 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
17102 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
17103 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
17104
17105 @item show rdiromatzero
17106 @kindex show rdiromatzero
17107 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
17108
17109 @item set rdiheartbeat
17110 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
17111 @cindex RDI heartbeat
17112 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
17113 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
17114 well as the Angel monitor.
17115
17116 @item show rdiheartbeat
17117 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
17118 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
17119 @end table
17120
17121
17122 @node M32R/D
17123 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
17124
17125 @table @code
17126 @kindex target m32r
17127 @item target m32r @var{dev}
17128 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
17129
17130 @kindex target m32rsdi
17131 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
17132 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
17133 @end table
17134
17135 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
17136
17137 @table @code
17138 @item set download-path @var{path}
17139 @kindex set download-path
17140 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
17141 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17142
17143 @item show download-path
17144 @kindex show download-path
17145 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17146
17147 @item set board-address @var{addr}
17148 @kindex set board-address
17149 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
17150 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
17151
17152 @item show board-address
17153 @kindex show board-address
17154 Show the current IP address of the target board.
17155
17156 @item set server-address @var{addr}
17157 @kindex set server-address
17158 @cindex download server address (M32R)
17159 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
17160 host machine.
17161
17162 @item show server-address
17163 @kindex show server-address
17164 Display the IP address of the download server.
17165
17166 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17167 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
17168 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
17169 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
17170 executable file is uploaded.
17171
17172 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17173 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
17174 Test the @code{upload} command.
17175 @end table
17176
17177 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
17178
17179 @table @code
17180 @item sdireset
17181 @kindex sdireset
17182 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
17183 This command resets the SDI connection.
17184
17185 @item sdistatus
17186 @kindex sdistatus
17187 This command shows the SDI connection status.
17188
17189 @item debug_chaos
17190 @kindex debug_chaos
17191 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
17192 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
17193
17194 @item use_debug_dma
17195 @kindex use_debug_dma
17196 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
17197
17198 @item use_mon_code
17199 @kindex use_mon_code
17200 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
17201
17202 @item use_ib_break
17203 @kindex use_ib_break
17204 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
17205
17206 @item use_dbt_break
17207 @kindex use_dbt_break
17208 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
17209 @end table
17210
17211 @node M68K
17212 @subsection M68k
17213
17214 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
17215 target command for the following ROM monitor.
17216
17217 @table @code
17218
17219 @kindex target dbug
17220 @item target dbug @var{dev}
17221 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
17222
17223 @end table
17224
17225 @node MicroBlaze
17226 @subsection MicroBlaze
17227 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
17228 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
17229
17230 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
17231 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
17232 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
17233 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
17234 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
17235 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
17236 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
17237 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
17238 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
17239 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
17240 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
17241
17242 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
17243
17244 @table @code
17245 @item target remote :1234
17246 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
17247 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
17248
17249 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
17250 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
17251 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
17252
17253 @item load
17254 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
17255
17256 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
17257 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
17258
17259 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
17260 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
17261 @end table
17262
17263 @node MIPS Embedded
17264 @subsection MIPS Embedded
17265
17266 @cindex MIPS boards
17267 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
17268 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
17269 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
17270
17271 @need 1000
17272 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
17273
17274 @table @code
17275 @item target mips @var{port}
17276 @kindex target mips @var{port}
17277 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
17278 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
17279 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
17280 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
17281 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
17282 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
17283
17284 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
17285 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
17286 debugger:
17287
17288 @smallexample
17289 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
17290 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
17291 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
17292 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
17293 (@value{GDBP}) run
17294 @end smallexample
17295
17296 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
17297 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
17298 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
17299 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
17300 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
17301
17302 @item target pmon @var{port}
17303 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
17304 PMON ROM monitor.
17305
17306 @item target ddb @var{port}
17307 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
17308 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
17309
17310 @item target lsi @var{port}
17311 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
17312 LSI variant of PMON.
17313
17314 @kindex target r3900
17315 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
17316 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
17317
17318 @kindex target array
17319 @item target array @var{dev}
17320 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
17321
17322 @end table
17323
17324
17325 @noindent
17326 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
17327
17328 @table @code
17329 @item set mipsfpu double
17330 @itemx set mipsfpu single
17331 @itemx set mipsfpu none
17332 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
17333 @itemx show mipsfpu
17334 @kindex set mipsfpu
17335 @kindex show mipsfpu
17336 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
17337 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
17338 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
17339 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
17340 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
17341 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
17342 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
17343 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
17344 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
17345 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
17346 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
17347 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
17348 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
17349
17350 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
17351 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
17352 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
17353
17354 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
17355 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
17356
17357 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
17358 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
17359 @itemx show timeout
17360 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
17361 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
17362 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
17363 @kindex set timeout
17364 @kindex show timeout
17365 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
17366 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
17367 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
17368 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
17369 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
17370 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
17371 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
17372 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
17373 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
17374 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
17375
17376 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
17377 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
17378 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
17379 to run before stopping.
17380
17381 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
17382 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17383 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
17384 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
17385 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
17386 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
17387
17388 @item show syn-garbage-limit
17389 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17390 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
17391 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
17392
17393 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
17394 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17395 @cindex remote monitor prompt
17396 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
17397 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
17398 @table @asis
17399 @item pmon target
17400 @samp{PMON}
17401 @item ddb target
17402 @samp{NEC010}
17403 @item lsi target
17404 @samp{PMON>}
17405 @end table
17406
17407 @item show monitor-prompt
17408 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17409 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
17410 remote monitor.
17411
17412 @item set monitor-warnings
17413 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17414 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
17415 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
17416 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
17417 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
17418
17419 @item show monitor-warnings
17420 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17421 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
17422
17423 @item pmon @var{command}
17424 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
17425 @cindex send PMON command
17426 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
17427 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
17428 @end table
17429
17430 @node OpenRISC 1000
17431 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
17432 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
17433
17434 @cindex or1k boards
17435 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
17436 about platform and commands.
17437
17438 @table @code
17439
17440 @kindex target jtag
17441 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
17442
17443 Connects to remote JTAG server.
17444 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
17445 connected via parallel port to the board.
17446
17447 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
17448
17449 @kindex or1ksim
17450 @item or1ksim @var{command}
17451 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
17452 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
17453
17454 @kindex info or1k spr
17455 @item info or1k spr
17456 Displays spr groups.
17457
17458 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
17459 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
17460 Displays register names in selected group.
17461
17462 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
17463 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
17464 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
17465 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
17466 Shows information about specified spr register.
17467
17468 @kindex spr
17469 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
17470 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
17471 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
17472 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
17473 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
17474 @end table
17475
17476 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
17477 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
17478 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
17479 triggers can be set using:
17480 @table @code
17481 @item $LEA/$LDATA
17482 Load effective address/data
17483 @item $SEA/$SDATA
17484 Store effective address/data
17485 @item $AEA/$ADATA
17486 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
17487 @item $FETCH
17488 Fetch data
17489 @end table
17490
17491 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
17492 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
17493
17494 @code{htrace} commands:
17495 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
17496 @table @code
17497 @kindex hwatch
17498 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
17499 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
17500 or Data. For example:
17501
17502 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17503
17504 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17505
17506 @kindex htrace
17507 @item htrace info
17508 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
17509
17510 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
17511 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
17512
17513 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
17514 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
17515
17516 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
17517 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
17518
17519 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
17520 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
17521 triggered.
17522
17523 @item htrace enable
17524 @itemx htrace disable
17525 Enables/disables the HW trace.
17526
17527 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
17528 Clears currently recorded trace data.
17529
17530 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
17531 will be written there.
17532
17533 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
17534 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
17535
17536 @item htrace mode continuous
17537 Set continuous trace mode.
17538
17539 @item htrace mode suspend
17540 Set suspend trace mode.
17541
17542 @end table
17543
17544 @node PowerPC Embedded
17545 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
17546
17547 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
17548
17549 @table @code
17550 @kindex set powerpc
17551 @item set powerpc soft-float
17552 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
17553 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
17554 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
17555 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
17556
17557 @item set powerpc vector-abi
17558 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
17559 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
17560 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
17561 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
17562 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
17563 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
17564 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
17565
17566 @kindex target dink32
17567 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
17568 DINK32 ROM monitor.
17569
17570 @kindex target ppcbug
17571 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
17572 @kindex target ppcbug1
17573 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
17574 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
17575
17576 @kindex target sds
17577 @item target sds @var{dev}
17578 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
17579 @end table
17580
17581 @cindex SDS protocol
17582 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
17583 by @value{GDBN}:
17584
17585 @table @code
17586 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
17587 @kindex set sdstimeout
17588 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
17589 default is 2 seconds.
17590
17591 @item show sdstimeout
17592 @kindex show sdstimeout
17593 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
17594
17595 @item sds @var{command}
17596 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
17597 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
17598 @end table
17599
17600
17601 @node PA
17602 @subsection HP PA Embedded
17603
17604 @table @code
17605
17606 @kindex target op50n
17607 @item target op50n @var{dev}
17608 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
17609
17610 @kindex target w89k
17611 @item target w89k @var{dev}
17612 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
17613
17614 @end table
17615
17616 @node Sparclet
17617 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
17618
17619 @cindex Sparclet
17620
17621 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
17622 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
17623 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17624 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
17625 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
17626
17627 @table @code
17628 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
17629 @kindex remotetimeout
17630 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
17631 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17632 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
17633 @end table
17634
17635 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
17636 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
17637 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
17638 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
17639 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
17640
17641 @smallexample
17642 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
17643 @end smallexample
17644
17645 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
17646
17647 @smallexample
17648 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
17649 @end smallexample
17650
17651 @cindex running, on Sparclet
17652 Once you have set
17653 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17654 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
17655 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
17656
17657 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17658
17659 @smallexample
17660 (gdbslet)
17661 @end smallexample
17662
17663 @menu
17664 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
17665 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
17666 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
17667 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
17668 @end menu
17669
17670 @node Sparclet File
17671 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
17672
17673 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
17674
17675 @smallexample
17676 (gdbslet) file prog
17677 @end smallexample
17678
17679 @need 1000
17680 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
17681 @value{GDBN} locates
17682 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
17683 path.
17684 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
17685 files will be searched as well.
17686 @value{GDBN} locates
17687 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
17688 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
17689 If it fails
17690 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
17691
17692 @smallexample
17693 prog: No such file or directory.
17694 @end smallexample
17695
17696 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
17697 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
17698 @code{target} command again.
17699
17700 @node Sparclet Connection
17701 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
17702
17703 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
17704 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
17705
17706 @smallexample
17707 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
17708 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
17709 main () at ../prog.c:3
17710 @end smallexample
17711
17712 @need 750
17713 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17714
17715 @smallexample
17716 Connected to ttya.
17717 @end smallexample
17718
17719 @node Sparclet Download
17720 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
17721
17722 @cindex download to Sparclet
17723 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
17724 you can use the @value{GDBN}
17725 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
17726 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
17727 command.
17728 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
17729 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
17730 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
17731 of each of the file's sections.
17732 For instance, if the program
17733 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
17734 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
17738 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
17742 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
17743 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
17744
17745 @node Sparclet Execution
17746 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
17747
17748 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
17749 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
17750 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
17751 manual for the list of commands.
17752
17753 @smallexample
17754 (gdbslet) b main
17755 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
17756 (gdbslet) run
17757 Starting program: prog
17758 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
17759 3 char *symarg = 0;
17760 (gdbslet) step
17761 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
17762 (gdbslet)
17763 @end smallexample
17764
17765 @node Sparclite
17766 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
17767
17768 @table @code
17769
17770 @kindex target sparclite
17771 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
17772 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
17773 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
17774 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
17775 remote protocol.
17776
17777 @end table
17778
17779 @node Z8000
17780 @subsection Zilog Z8000
17781
17782 @cindex Z8000
17783 @cindex simulator, Z8000
17784 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
17785
17786 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
17787 a Z8000 simulator.
17788
17789 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
17790 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
17791 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
17792 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
17793
17794 @table @code
17795 @item target sim @var{args}
17796 @kindex sim
17797 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
17798 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
17799 options, specify them via @var{args}.
17800 @end table
17801
17802 @noindent
17803 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
17804 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
17805 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
17806 to run your program, and so on.
17807
17808 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
17809 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
17810 additional items of information as specially named registers:
17811
17812 @table @code
17813
17814 @item cycles
17815 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
17816
17817 @item insts
17818 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
17819
17820 @item time
17821 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
17822
17823 @end table
17824
17825 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
17826 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
17827 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
17828 simulated clock ticks.
17829
17830 @node AVR
17831 @subsection Atmel AVR
17832 @cindex AVR
17833
17834 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
17835 following AVR-specific commands:
17836
17837 @table @code
17838 @item info io_registers
17839 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
17840 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
17841 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
17842 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
17843 @end table
17844
17845 @node CRIS
17846 @subsection CRIS
17847 @cindex CRIS
17848
17849 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
17850 following CRIS-specific commands:
17851
17852 @table @code
17853 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
17854 @cindex CRIS version
17855 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
17856 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
17857 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
17858
17859 @item show cris-version
17860 Show the current CRIS version.
17861
17862 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
17863 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
17864 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
17865 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
17866 @code{R59}.
17867
17868 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
17869 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
17870
17871 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
17872 @cindex CRIS mode
17873 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
17874 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
17875 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
17876
17877 @item show cris-mode
17878 Show the current CRIS mode.
17879 @end table
17880
17881 @node Super-H
17882 @subsection Renesas Super-H
17883 @cindex Super-H
17884
17885 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
17886 commands:
17887
17888 @table @code
17889 @item regs
17890 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
17891 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
17892
17893 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
17894 @kindex set sh calling-convention
17895 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
17896 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
17897 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
17898 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
17899 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
17900 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
17901 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
17902 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
17903 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
17904 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
17905
17906 @item show sh calling-convention
17907 @kindex show sh calling-convention
17908 Show the current calling convention setting.
17909
17910 @end table
17911
17912
17913 @node Architectures
17914 @section Architectures
17915
17916 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
17917 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
17918
17919 @menu
17920 * i386::
17921 * A29K::
17922 * Alpha::
17923 * MIPS::
17924 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
17925 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17926 * PowerPC::
17927 @end menu
17928
17929 @node i386
17930 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
17931
17932 @table @code
17933 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
17934 @kindex set struct-convention
17935 @cindex struct return convention
17936 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
17937 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
17938 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
17939 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
17940 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
17941 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
17942 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
17943 be returned in a register.
17944
17945 @item show struct-convention
17946 @kindex show struct-convention
17947 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
17948 from functions.
17949 @end table
17950
17951 @node A29K
17952 @subsection A29K
17953
17954 @table @code
17955
17956 @kindex set rstack_high_address
17957 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
17958 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
17959 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
17960 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
17961 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
17962 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
17963 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
17964 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
17965 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
17966 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
17967 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
17968 hexadecimal.
17969
17970 @kindex show rstack_high_address
17971 @item show rstack_high_address
17972 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
17973 processors.
17974
17975 @end table
17976
17977 @node Alpha
17978 @subsection Alpha
17979
17980 See the following section.
17981
17982 @node MIPS
17983 @subsection MIPS
17984
17985 @cindex stack on Alpha
17986 @cindex stack on MIPS
17987 @cindex Alpha stack
17988 @cindex MIPS stack
17989 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
17990 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
17991 find the beginning of a function.
17992
17993 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
17994 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
17995 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
17996 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
17997 commands:
17998
17999 @table @code
18000 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
18001 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
18002 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
18003 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
18004 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
18005 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
18006 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
18007 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
18008
18009 @item show heuristic-fence-post
18010 Display the current limit.
18011 @end table
18012
18013 @noindent
18014 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
18015 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
18016
18017 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
18018 programs:
18019
18020 @table @code
18021 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
18022 @kindex set mips abi
18023 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
18024 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
18025 values of @var{arg} are:
18026
18027 @table @samp
18028 @item auto
18029 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
18030 default).
18031 @item o32
18032 @item o64
18033 @item n32
18034 @item n64
18035 @item eabi32
18036 @item eabi64
18037 @item auto
18038 @end table
18039
18040 @item show mips abi
18041 @kindex show mips abi
18042 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
18043
18044 @item set mipsfpu
18045 @itemx show mipsfpu
18046 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
18047
18048 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
18049 @kindex set mips mask-address
18050 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
18051 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
18052 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
18053 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
18054 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
18055
18056 @item show mips mask-address
18057 @kindex show mips mask-address
18058 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
18059 not.
18060
18061 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18062 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18063 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
18064 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
18065 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
18066 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
18067
18068 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18069 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18070 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
18071
18072 @item set debug mips
18073 @kindex set debug mips
18074 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
18075 target code in @value{GDBN}.
18076
18077 @item show debug mips
18078 @kindex show debug mips
18079 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
18080 @end table
18081
18082
18083 @node HPPA
18084 @subsection HPPA
18085 @cindex HPPA support
18086
18087 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
18088 following special commands:
18089
18090 @table @code
18091 @item set debug hppa
18092 @kindex set debug hppa
18093 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
18094 messages are to be displayed.
18095
18096 @item show debug hppa
18097 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
18098
18099 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
18100 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
18101 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
18102 given @var{address}.
18103
18104 @end table
18105
18106
18107 @node SPU
18108 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
18109 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
18110 @cindex SPU
18111
18112 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
18113 it provides the following special commands:
18114
18115 @table @code
18116 @item info spu event
18117 @kindex info spu
18118 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
18119 and pending event status.
18120
18121 @item info spu signal
18122 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
18123 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
18124 notification channels.
18125
18126 @item info spu mailbox
18127 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
18128 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
18129 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
18130
18131 @item info spu dma
18132 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18133 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18134 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18135
18136 @item info spu proxydma
18137 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18138 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18139 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18140
18141 @end table
18142
18143 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
18144 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
18145 special commands:
18146
18147 @table @code
18148 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
18149 @kindex set spu
18150 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
18151 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
18152 function. The default is @code{off}.
18153
18154 @item show spu stop-on-load
18155 @kindex show spu
18156 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
18157
18158 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
18159 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
18160 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
18161 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
18162 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
18163 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
18164
18165 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
18166 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
18167
18168 @end table
18169
18170 @node PowerPC
18171 @subsection PowerPC
18172 @cindex PowerPC architecture
18173
18174 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
18175 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
18176 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
18177 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
18178 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
18179
18180 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
18181 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
18182 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
18183
18184 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
18185 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
18186
18187
18188 @node Controlling GDB
18189 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
18190
18191 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
18192 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
18193 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
18194 described here.
18195
18196 @menu
18197 * Prompt:: Prompt
18198 * Editing:: Command editing
18199 * Command History:: Command history
18200 * Screen Size:: Screen size
18201 * Numbers:: Numbers
18202 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
18203 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
18204 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
18205 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
18206 @end menu
18207
18208 @node Prompt
18209 @section Prompt
18210
18211 @cindex prompt
18212
18213 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
18214 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
18215 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
18216 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
18217 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
18218 which one you are talking to.
18219
18220 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
18221 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
18222 or a prompt that does not.
18223
18224 @table @code
18225 @kindex set prompt
18226 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
18227 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
18228
18229 @kindex show prompt
18230 @item show prompt
18231 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
18232 @end table
18233
18234 @node Editing
18235 @section Command Editing
18236 @cindex readline
18237 @cindex command line editing
18238
18239 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
18240 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
18241 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
18242 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
18243 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
18244 debugging sessions.
18245
18246 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
18247 command @code{set}.
18248
18249 @table @code
18250 @kindex set editing
18251 @cindex editing
18252 @item set editing
18253 @itemx set editing on
18254 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
18255
18256 @item set editing off
18257 Disable command line editing.
18258
18259 @kindex show editing
18260 @item show editing
18261 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
18262 @end table
18263
18264 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
18265 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
18266 encouraged to read that chapter.
18267
18268 @node Command History
18269 @section Command History
18270 @cindex command history
18271
18272 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
18273 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
18274 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
18275 history facility.
18276
18277 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
18278 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
18279 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
18280
18281 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18282 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
18283 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
18284 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18285 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18286 pressed on a line by itself.
18287
18288 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
18289 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18290 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18291 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18292
18293 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
18294 history.
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @cindex history substitution
18298 @cindex history file
18299 @kindex set history filename
18300 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
18301 @item set history filename @var{fname}
18302 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
18303 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
18304 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
18305 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
18306 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
18307 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
18308 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
18309 is not set.
18310
18311 @cindex save command history
18312 @kindex set history save
18313 @item set history save
18314 @itemx set history save on
18315 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
18316 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
18317
18318 @item set history save off
18319 Stop recording command history in a file.
18320
18321 @cindex history size
18322 @kindex set history size
18323 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
18324 @item set history size @var{size}
18325 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
18326 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
18327 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
18328 @end table
18329
18330 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
18331 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
18332
18333 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
18334 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
18335 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
18336 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
18337 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
18338 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
18339 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
18340 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
18341
18342 The commands to control history expansion are:
18343
18344 @table @code
18345 @item set history expansion on
18346 @itemx set history expansion
18347 @kindex set history expansion
18348 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
18349
18350 @item set history expansion off
18351 Disable history expansion.
18352
18353 @c @group
18354 @kindex show history
18355 @item show history
18356 @itemx show history filename
18357 @itemx show history save
18358 @itemx show history size
18359 @itemx show history expansion
18360 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
18361 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
18362 @c @end group
18363 @end table
18364
18365 @table @code
18366 @kindex show commands
18367 @cindex show last commands
18368 @cindex display command history
18369 @item show commands
18370 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
18371
18372 @item show commands @var{n}
18373 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
18374
18375 @item show commands +
18376 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
18377 @end table
18378
18379 @node Screen Size
18380 @section Screen Size
18381 @cindex size of screen
18382 @cindex pauses in output
18383
18384 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
18385 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
18386 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
18387 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
18388 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
18389 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
18390 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
18391 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
18392
18393 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
18394 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
18395 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
18396 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
18397 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
18398 width} commands:
18399
18400 @table @code
18401 @kindex set height
18402 @kindex set width
18403 @kindex show width
18404 @kindex show height
18405 @item set height @var{lpp}
18406 @itemx show height
18407 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
18408 @itemx show width
18409 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
18410 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
18411 commands display the current settings.
18412
18413 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
18414 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
18415 file or to an editor buffer.
18416
18417 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
18418 from wrapping its output.
18419
18420 @item set pagination on
18421 @itemx set pagination off
18422 @kindex set pagination
18423 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
18424 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
18425
18426 @item show pagination
18427 @kindex show pagination
18428 Show the current pagination mode.
18429 @end table
18430
18431 @node Numbers
18432 @section Numbers
18433 @cindex number representation
18434 @cindex entering numbers
18435
18436 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
18437 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
18438 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
18439 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
18440 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
18441 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
18442 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
18443 both input and output with the commands described below.
18444
18445 @table @code
18446 @kindex set input-radix
18447 @item set input-radix @var{base}
18448 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
18449 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18450 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
18451 example, any of
18452
18453 @smallexample
18454 set input-radix 012
18455 set input-radix 10.
18456 set input-radix 0xa
18457 @end smallexample
18458
18459 @noindent
18460 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
18461 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
18462 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
18463 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
18464 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
18465 change the radix.
18466
18467 @kindex set output-radix
18468 @item set output-radix @var{base}
18469 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
18470 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18471 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
18472
18473 @kindex show input-radix
18474 @item show input-radix
18475 Display the current default base for numeric input.
18476
18477 @kindex show output-radix
18478 @item show output-radix
18479 Display the current default base for numeric display.
18480
18481 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
18482 @itemx show radix
18483 @kindex set radix
18484 @kindex show radix
18485 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
18486 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
18487 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
18488 default value of 10.
18489
18490 @end table
18491
18492 @node ABI
18493 @section Configuring the Current ABI
18494
18495 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
18496 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
18497 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
18498 current ABI.
18499
18500 @cindex OS ABI
18501 @kindex set osabi
18502 @kindex show osabi
18503
18504 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
18505 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
18506 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
18507 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
18508 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
18509 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
18510 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
18511 platform provides.
18512
18513 @table @code
18514 @item show osabi
18515 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
18516
18517 @item set osabi
18518 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
18519
18520 @item set osabi @var{abi}
18521 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
18522 @end table
18523
18524 @cindex float promotion
18525
18526 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
18527 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
18528 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
18529 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
18530 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
18531 @code{double} and then passed.
18532
18533 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
18534 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
18535 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
18536
18537 @table @code
18538 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
18539 @item set coerce-float-to-double
18540 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
18541 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
18542 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
18543
18544 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
18545 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
18546 functions.
18547
18548 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
18549 @item show coerce-float-to-double
18550 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
18551 @end table
18552
18553 @kindex set cp-abi
18554 @kindex show cp-abi
18555 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
18556 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
18557 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
18558 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
18559 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
18560 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
18561 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
18562 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
18563 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
18564 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
18565 ``auto''.
18566
18567 @table @code
18568 @item show cp-abi
18569 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
18570
18571 @item set cp-abi
18572 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
18573
18574 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
18575 @itemx set cp-abi auto
18576 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
18577 @end table
18578
18579 @node Messages/Warnings
18580 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
18581
18582 @cindex verbose operation
18583 @cindex optional warnings
18584 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
18585 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
18586 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
18587 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
18588
18589 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
18590 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
18591 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18592
18593 @table @code
18594 @kindex set verbose
18595 @item set verbose on
18596 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
18597
18598 @item set verbose off
18599 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
18600
18601 @kindex show verbose
18602 @item show verbose
18603 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
18604 @end table
18605
18606 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
18607 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
18608 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
18609 Symbol Files}).
18610
18611 @table @code
18612
18613 @kindex set complaints
18614 @item set complaints @var{limit}
18615 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
18616 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
18617 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
18618 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
18619
18620 @kindex show complaints
18621 @item show complaints
18622 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
18623
18624 @end table
18625
18626 @anchor{confirmation requests}
18627 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
18628 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
18629 you try to run a program which is already running:
18630
18631 @smallexample
18632 (@value{GDBP}) run
18633 The program being debugged has been started already.
18634 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
18635 @end smallexample
18636
18637 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
18638 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
18639
18640 @table @code
18641
18642 @kindex set confirm
18643 @cindex flinching
18644 @cindex confirmation
18645 @cindex stupid questions
18646 @item set confirm off
18647 Disables confirmation requests.
18648
18649 @item set confirm on
18650 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
18651
18652 @kindex show confirm
18653 @item show confirm
18654 Displays state of confirmation requests.
18655
18656 @end table
18657
18658 @cindex command tracing
18659 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
18660 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
18661 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
18662 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
18663
18664 @table @code
18665 @kindex set trace-commands
18666 @cindex command scripts, debugging
18667 @item set trace-commands on
18668 Enable command tracing.
18669 @item set trace-commands off
18670 Disable command tracing.
18671 @item show trace-commands
18672 Display the current state of command tracing.
18673 @end table
18674
18675 @node Debugging Output
18676 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
18677 @cindex optional debugging messages
18678
18679 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
18680 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
18681 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
18682 section documents those commands.
18683
18684 @table @code
18685 @kindex set exec-done-display
18686 @item set exec-done-display
18687 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
18688 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
18689 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
18690 @kindex show exec-done-display
18691 @item show exec-done-display
18692 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
18693 notification.
18694 @kindex set debug
18695 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
18696 @cindex architecture debugging info
18697 @item set debug arch
18698 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
18699 @kindex show debug
18700 @item show debug arch
18701 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
18702 @item set debug aix-thread
18703 @cindex AIX threads
18704 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
18705 module.
18706 @item show debug aix-thread
18707 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
18708 @item set debug dwarf2-die
18709 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
18710 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
18711 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
18712 A value of zero turns off the display.
18713 @item show debug dwarf2-die
18714 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
18715 @item set debug displaced
18716 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
18717 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
18718 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
18719 @item show debug displaced
18720 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
18721 related to displaced stepping.
18722 @item set debug event
18723 @cindex event debugging info
18724 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
18725 default is off.
18726 @item show debug event
18727 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
18728 info.
18729 @item set debug expression
18730 @cindex expression debugging info
18731 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
18732 expression parsing. The default is off.
18733 @item show debug expression
18734 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
18735 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
18736 @item set debug frame
18737 @cindex frame debugging info
18738 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
18739 default is off.
18740 @item show debug frame
18741 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
18742 info.
18743 @item set debug gnu-nat
18744 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
18745 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
18746 @item show debug gnu-nat
18747 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
18748 @item set debug infrun
18749 @cindex inferior debugging info
18750 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
18751 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
18752 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
18753 @item show debug infrun
18754 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
18755 @item set debug lin-lwp
18756 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
18757 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18758 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
18759 @item show debug lin-lwp
18760 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
18761 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
18762 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
18763 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18764 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
18765 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
18766 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
18767 @item set debug observer
18768 @cindex observer debugging info
18769 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
18770 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
18771 @item show debug observer
18772 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
18773 @item set debug overload
18774 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
18775 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
18776 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
18777 is off.
18778 @item show debug overload
18779 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
18780 debugging info.
18781 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
18782 @cindex serial connections, debugging
18783 @cindex debug remote protocol
18784 @cindex remote protocol debugging
18785 @cindex display remote packets
18786 @item set debug remote
18787 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
18788 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
18789 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
18790 @item show debug remote
18791 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
18792 @item set debug serial
18793 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
18794 default is off.
18795 @item show debug serial
18796 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
18797 info.
18798 @item set debug solib-frv
18799 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
18800 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
18801 @item show debug solib-frv
18802 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
18803 messages.
18804 @item set debug target
18805 @cindex target debugging info
18806 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
18807 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
18808 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
18809 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
18810 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
18811 @item show debug target
18812 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
18813 info.
18814 @item set debug timestamp
18815 @cindex timestampping debugging info
18816 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
18817 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
18818 message.
18819 @item show debug timestamp
18820 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
18821 debugging info.
18822 @item set debugvarobj
18823 @cindex variable object debugging info
18824 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
18825 info. The default is off.
18826 @item show debugvarobj
18827 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
18828 debugging info.
18829 @item set debug xml
18830 @cindex XML parser debugging
18831 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
18832 @item show debug xml
18833 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
18834 @end table
18835
18836 @node Other Misc Settings
18837 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
18838 @cindex miscellaneous settings
18839
18840 @table @code
18841 @kindex set interactive-mode
18842 @item set interactive-mode
18843 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
18844 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
18845 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
18846 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
18847
18848 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
18849 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
18850 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
18851 inside a cygwin window.
18852
18853 @kindex show interactive-mode
18854 @item show interactive-mode
18855 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
18856 @end table
18857
18858 @node Extending GDB
18859 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
18860 @cindex extending GDB
18861
18862 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
18863 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
18864 Python scripting language.
18865
18866 @menu
18867 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
18868 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18869 @end menu
18870
18871 @node Sequences
18872 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
18873
18874 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
18875 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
18876 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
18877 files.
18878
18879 @menu
18880 * Define:: How to define your own commands
18881 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
18882 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
18883 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
18884 @end menu
18885
18886 @node Define
18887 @subsection User-defined Commands
18888
18889 @cindex user-defined command
18890 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
18891 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
18892 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
18893 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
18894 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
18895 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
18896
18897 @smallexample
18898 define adder
18899 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18900 end
18901 @end smallexample
18902
18903 @noindent
18904 To execute the command use:
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 adder 1 2 3
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 @noindent
18911 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
18912 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
18913 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
18914 functions calls.
18915
18916 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
18917 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
18918 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
18919 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 define adder
18923 if $argc == 2
18924 print $arg0 + $arg1
18925 end
18926 if $argc == 3
18927 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18928 end
18929 end
18930 @end smallexample
18931
18932 @table @code
18933
18934 @kindex define
18935 @item define @var{commandname}
18936 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
18937 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
18938 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
18939 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
18940 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
18941 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
18942
18943 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
18944 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
18945 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18946
18947 @kindex document
18948 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
18949 @item document @var{commandname}
18950 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
18951 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
18952 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
18953 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
18954 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
18955 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
18956
18957 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
18958 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
18959 does not change the documentation.
18960
18961 @kindex dont-repeat
18962 @cindex don't repeat command
18963 @item dont-repeat
18964 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
18965 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
18966 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
18967
18968 @kindex help user-defined
18969 @item help user-defined
18970 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
18971 (if any) for each.
18972
18973 @kindex show user
18974 @item show user
18975 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
18976 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
18977 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
18978 definitions for all user-defined commands.
18979
18980 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
18981 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
18982 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
18983 @item show max-user-call-depth
18984 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
18985 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
18986 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
18987 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
18988 @end table
18989
18990 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
18991 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
18992
18993 When user-defined commands are executed, the
18994 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
18995 stops execution of the user-defined command.
18996
18997 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
18998 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
18999 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
19000 messages when used in a user-defined command.
19001
19002 @node Hooks
19003 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
19004 @cindex command hooks
19005 @cindex hooks, for commands
19006 @cindex hooks, pre-command
19007
19008 @kindex hook
19009 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
19010 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
19011 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
19012 before that command.
19013
19014 @cindex hooks, post-command
19015 @kindex hookpost
19016 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
19017 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
19018 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
19019 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
19020 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
19021
19022 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
19023 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
19024
19025 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
19026 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
19027
19028 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
19029 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
19030 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
19031 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
19032 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
19033
19034 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
19035 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
19036 you could define:
19037
19038 @smallexample
19039 define hook-stop
19040 handle SIGALRM nopass
19041 end
19042
19043 define hook-run
19044 handle SIGALRM pass
19045 end
19046
19047 define hook-continue
19048 handle SIGALRM pass
19049 end
19050 @end smallexample
19051
19052 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
19053 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
19054 you could define:
19055
19056 @smallexample
19057 define hook-echo
19058 echo <<<---
19059 end
19060
19061 define hookpost-echo
19062 echo --->>>\n
19063 end
19064
19065 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
19066 <<<---Hello World--->>>
19067 (@value{GDBP})
19068
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
19072 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
19073 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
19074 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
19075 @c or not?
19076 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
19077 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
19078 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
19079
19080 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
19081 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
19082 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
19083
19084 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
19085 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
19086
19087 @node Command Files
19088 @subsection Command Files
19089
19090 @cindex command files
19091 @cindex scripting commands
19092 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
19093 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
19094 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
19095 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
19096 terminal.
19097
19098 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
19099 command:
19100
19101 @table @code
19102 @kindex source
19103 @cindex execute commands from a file
19104 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
19105 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
19106 @end table
19107
19108 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
19109 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
19110 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
19111 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
19112 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
19113
19114 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
19115 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
19116
19117 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
19118 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
19119 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
19120
19121 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
19122 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
19123 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
19124 when called from command files.
19125
19126 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
19127 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
19128 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
19129 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
19130 the next command.
19131
19132 @smallexample
19133 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
19137 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
19138 would be directed to @file{log}.
19139
19140 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
19141 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
19142 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
19143 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
19144 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
19145 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
19146 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
19147 conditionally, etc.
19148
19149 @table @code
19150 @kindex if
19151 @kindex else
19152 @item if
19153 @itemx else
19154 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
19155 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
19156 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
19157 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
19158 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
19159 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
19160 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19161
19162 @kindex while
19163 @item while
19164 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
19165 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
19166 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
19167 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
19168 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
19169 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
19170
19171 @kindex loop_break
19172 @item loop_break
19173 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
19174 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
19175 line.
19176
19177 @kindex loop_continue
19178 @item loop_continue
19179 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
19180 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
19181 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
19182 the controlling expression.
19183
19184 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
19185 @item end
19186 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
19187 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
19188 @end table
19189
19190
19191 @node Output
19192 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
19193
19194 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
19195 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
19196 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
19197 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
19198 want.
19199
19200 @table @code
19201 @kindex echo
19202 @item echo @var{text}
19203 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
19204 @c because it is not in ANSI.
19205 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
19206 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
19207 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
19208 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
19209 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
19210 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
19211 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
19212 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
19213 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
19214
19215 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
19216 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
19217
19218 @smallexample
19219 echo This is some text\n\
19220 which is continued\n\
19221 onto several lines.\n
19222 @end smallexample
19223
19224 produces the same output as
19225
19226 @smallexample
19227 echo This is some text\n
19228 echo which is continued\n
19229 echo onto several lines.\n
19230 @end smallexample
19231
19232 @kindex output
19233 @item output @var{expression}
19234 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
19235 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
19236 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
19237 on expressions.
19238
19239 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
19240 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
19241 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
19242 Formats}, for more information.
19243
19244 @kindex printf
19245 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
19246 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
19247 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
19248 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
19249 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
19250 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
19251 executing the code below:
19252
19253 @smallexample
19254 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
19255 @end smallexample
19256
19257 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
19258 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
19259 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
19260 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
19261 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
19262 printed.
19263
19264 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
19265
19266 @smallexample
19267 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
19268 @end smallexample
19269
19270 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
19271 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
19272 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
19273
19274 @itemize @bullet
19275 @item
19276 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
19277
19278 @item
19279 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
19280 width.
19281
19282 @item
19283 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
19284 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
19285
19286 @item
19287 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
19288 supported.
19289
19290 @item
19291 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
19292
19293 @item
19294 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
19295 @end itemize
19296
19297 @noindent
19298 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
19299 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
19300 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
19301 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
19302
19303 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
19304 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
19305 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
19306 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
19307 supported.
19308
19309 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
19310 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
19311 together with a floating point specifier.
19312 letters:
19313
19314 @itemize @bullet
19315 @item
19316 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
19317
19318 @item
19319 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
19320
19321 @item
19322 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
19323 @end itemize
19324
19325 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
19326 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
19327 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
19328
19329 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
19330 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
19331
19332 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
19333 @smallexample
19334 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
19335 @end smallexample
19336
19337 @end table
19338
19339 @node Python
19340 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19341 @cindex python scripting
19342 @cindex scripting with python
19343
19344 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
19345 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
19346 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
19347
19348 @menu
19349 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
19350 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
19351 @end menu
19352
19353 @node Python Commands
19354 @subsection Python Commands
19355 @cindex python commands
19356 @cindex commands to access python
19357
19358 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
19359 and one related setting:
19360
19361 @table @code
19362 @kindex python
19363 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
19364 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
19365
19366 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
19367 argument as a Python command. For example:
19368
19369 @smallexample
19370 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
19371 23
19372 @end smallexample
19373
19374 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
19375 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
19376 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
19377 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
19378 containing @code{end}. For example:
19379
19380 @smallexample
19381 (@value{GDBP}) python
19382 Type python script
19383 End with a line saying just "end".
19384 >print 23
19385 >end
19386 23
19387 @end smallexample
19388
19389 @kindex maint set python print-stack
19390 @item maint set python print-stack
19391 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
19392 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
19393 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
19394 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
19395 disabled.
19396 @end table
19397
19398 @node Python API
19399 @subsection Python API
19400 @cindex python api
19401 @cindex programming in python
19402
19403 @cindex python stdout
19404 @cindex python pagination
19405 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
19406 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
19407 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
19408 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
19409 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
19410
19411 @menu
19412 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
19413 * Exception Handling::
19414 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
19415 * Values From Inferior::
19416 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
19417 * Pretty Printing:: Pretty-printing values.
19418 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
19419 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
19420 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
19421 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
19422 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
19423 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
19424 @end menu
19425
19426 @node Basic Python
19427 @subsubsection Basic Python
19428
19429 @cindex python functions
19430 @cindex python module
19431 @cindex gdb module
19432 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
19433 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
19434 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
19435 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
19436
19437 @findex gdb.execute
19438 @defun execute command [from_tty]
19439 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19440 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
19441 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
19442 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
19443
19444 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
19445 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
19446 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
19447 @end defun
19448
19449 @findex gdb.parameter
19450 @defun parameter parameter
19451 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
19452 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
19453 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
19454 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
19455
19456 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
19457 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
19458 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
19459 @end defun
19460
19461 @findex gdb.history
19462 @defun history number
19463 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
19464 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
19465 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
19466 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
19467 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
19468 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
19469 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
19470 raised.
19471
19472 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
19473 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
19474 @end defun
19475
19476 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
19477 @defun parse_and_eval expression
19478 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
19479 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
19480 @var{expression} must be a string.
19481
19482 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
19483 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
19484 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
19485 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
19486 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
19487 @end defun
19488
19489 @findex gdb.write
19490 @defun write string
19491 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
19492 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
19493 call this function.
19494 @end defun
19495
19496 @findex gdb.flush
19497 @defun flush
19498 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
19499 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
19500 function.
19501 @end defun
19502
19503 @node Exception Handling
19504 @subsubsection Exception Handling
19505 @cindex python exceptions
19506 @cindex exceptions, python
19507
19508 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
19509 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
19510 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
19511 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
19512 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
19513 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
19514 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
19515
19516 @smallexample
19517 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
19518 Traceback (most recent call last):
19519 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
19520 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
19521 @end smallexample
19522
19523 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
19524 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
19525 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
19526 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
19527 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
19528 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
19529 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
19530 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
19531 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
19532 traceback.
19533
19534 @node Auto-loading
19535 @subsubsection Auto-loading
19536 @cindex auto-loading, Python
19537
19538 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
19539 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
19540 @value{GDBN} will look for a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
19541 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
19542 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
19543 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
19544 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
19545
19546 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
19547 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
19548 then @value{GDBN} will use for its each separated directory component
19549 @code{component} the file named @file{@code{component}/@var{real-name}}, where
19550 @var{real-name} is the object file's real name, as described above.
19551
19552 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
19553 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
19554 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
19555 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
19556 is the object file's real name, as described above.
19557
19558 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the ``current
19559 objfile''. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
19560 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
19561 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
19562
19563 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
19564 debugging commands and scripts. You can enable or disable this
19565 feature, and view its current state.
19566
19567 @table @code
19568 @kindex maint set python auto-load
19569 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
19570 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
19571
19572 @kindex show python auto-load
19573 @item show python auto-load
19574 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
19575 @end table
19576
19577 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded.
19578 So, your @samp{-gdb.py} file should take care to ensure that it may be
19579 evaluated multiple times without error.
19580
19581 @node Values From Inferior
19582 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
19583 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
19584 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
19585
19586 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
19587 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
19588 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
19589 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
19590 fetching values when necessary.
19591
19592 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
19593 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
19594 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
19595
19596 @smallexample
19597 bar = some_val + 2
19598 @end smallexample
19599
19600 @noindent
19601 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
19602 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
19603
19604 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
19605 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
19606 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
19607 can access its @code{foo} element with:
19608
19609 @smallexample
19610 bar = some_val['foo']
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
19614
19615 The following attributes are provided:
19616
19617 @table @code
19618 @defivar Value address
19619 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
19620 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
19621 this attribute holds @code{None}.
19622 @end defivar
19623
19624 @cindex optimized out value in Python
19625 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
19626 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
19627 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
19628 @end defivar
19629
19630 @defivar Value type
19631 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
19632 @code{gdb.Type} object.
19633 @end defivar
19634 @end table
19635
19636 The following methods are provided:
19637
19638 @table @code
19639 @defmethod Value cast type
19640 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
19641 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
19642 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
19643 reason, this method throws an exception.
19644 @end defmethod
19645
19646 @defmethod Value dereference
19647 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
19648 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
19649 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
19650
19651 @smallexample
19652 int *foo;
19653 @end smallexample
19654
19655 @noindent
19656 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
19657 @code{foo} points to like this:
19658
19659 @smallexample
19660 bar = foo.dereference ()
19661 @end smallexample
19662
19663 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
19664 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
19665 @end defmethod
19666
19667 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
19668 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
19669 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
19670 throw an exception.
19671
19672 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
19673 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
19674 language.
19675
19676 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
19677 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
19678 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
19679 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
19680 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
19681
19682 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
19683 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
19684 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
19685 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
19686 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
19687 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
19688 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
19689 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
19690 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
19691
19692 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
19693 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
19694
19695 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
19696 fetched and converted to the given length.
19697 @end defmethod
19698
19699 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
19700 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
19701 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
19702 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
19703
19704 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
19705 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
19706 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
19707 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
19708 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
19709
19710 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
19711 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
19712 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
19713 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
19714 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
19715 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
19716
19717 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
19718 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
19719 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
19720 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
19721 @end defmethod
19722 @end table
19723
19724 @node Types In Python
19725 @subsubsection Types In Python
19726 @cindex types in Python
19727 @cindex Python, working with types
19728
19729 @tindex gdb.Type
19730 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
19731 @code{gdb.Type}.
19732
19733 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
19734 module:
19735
19736 @findex gdb.lookup_type
19737 @defun lookup_type name [block]
19738 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
19739 type to look up. It must be a string.
19740
19741 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
19742 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
19743 @end defun
19744
19745 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
19746
19747 @table @code
19748 @defivar Type code
19749 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
19750 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
19751 @end defivar
19752
19753 @defivar Type sizeof
19754 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
19755 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
19756 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
19757 @end defivar
19758
19759 @defivar Type tag
19760 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
19761 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
19762 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
19763 @code{None} is returned.
19764 @end defivar
19765 @end table
19766
19767 The following methods are provided:
19768
19769 @table @code
19770 @defmethod Type fields
19771 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
19772 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
19773 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
19774 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
19775 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
19776 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
19777
19778 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
19779 @table @code
19780 @item bitpos
19781 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
19782 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
19783 position of the field.
19784
19785 @item name
19786 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
19787
19788 @item artificial
19789 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
19790 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
19791 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
19792
19793 @item is_base_class
19794 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
19795 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
19796 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
19797 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
19798
19799 @item bitsize
19800 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
19801 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
19802 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
19803
19804 @item type
19805 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
19806 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
19807 @end table
19808 @end defmethod
19809
19810 @defmethod Type const
19811 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19812 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
19813 @end defmethod
19814
19815 @defmethod Type volatile
19816 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19817 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
19818 @end defmethod
19819
19820 @defmethod Type unqualified
19821 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
19822 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
19823 @code{volatile}.
19824 @end defmethod
19825
19826 @defmethod Type range
19827 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
19828 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
19829 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
19830 @code{RuntimeError} exception.
19831 @end defmethod
19832
19833 @defmethod Type reference
19834 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
19835 type.
19836 @end defmethod
19837
19838 @defmethod Type pointer
19839 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
19840 type.
19841 @end defmethod
19842
19843 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
19844 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
19845 after removing all layers of typedefs.
19846 @end defmethod
19847
19848 @defmethod Type target
19849 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
19850 of this type.
19851
19852 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
19853 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
19854 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
19855 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
19856 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
19857 target type is the aliased type.
19858
19859 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
19860 exception.
19861 @end defmethod
19862
19863 @defmethod Type template_argument n
19864 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
19865 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
19866 @var{n}th template argument.
19867
19868 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
19869 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
19870
19871 @var{name} is searched for globally.
19872 @end defmethod
19873 @end table
19874
19875
19876 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
19877 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
19878 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
19879
19880 @table @code
19881 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
19882 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
19883 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
19884 The type is a pointer.
19885
19886 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19887 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19888 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19889 The type is an array.
19890
19891 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19892 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19893 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19894 The type is a structure.
19895
19896 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
19897 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
19898 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
19899 The type is a union.
19900
19901 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19902 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19903 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19904 The type is an enum.
19905
19906 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19907 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19908 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19909 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
19910
19911 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19912 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19913 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19914 The type is a function.
19915
19916 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
19917 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
19918 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
19919 The type is an integer type.
19920
19921 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
19922 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
19923 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
19924 A floating point type.
19925
19926 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
19927 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
19928 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
19929 The special type @code{void}.
19930
19931 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
19932 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
19933 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
19934 A Pascal set type.
19935
19936 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19937 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19938 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19939 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
19940
19941 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
19942 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
19943 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
19944 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
19945 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
19946
19947 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19948 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19949 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19950 A string of bits.
19951
19952 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19953 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19954 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19955 An unknown or erroneous type.
19956
19957 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19958 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19959 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19960 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
19961
19962 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19963 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19964 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19965 A pointer-to-member-function.
19966
19967 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19968 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19969 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19970 A pointer-to-member.
19971
19972 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
19973 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
19974 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
19975 A reference type.
19976
19977 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19978 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19979 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19980 A character type.
19981
19982 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19983 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19984 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19985 A boolean type.
19986
19987 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19988 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19989 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19990 A complex float type.
19991
19992 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19993 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19994 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19995 A typedef to some other type.
19996
19997 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19998 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19999 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20000 A C@t{++} namespace.
20001
20002 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20003 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20004 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20005 A decimal floating point type.
20006
20007 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20008 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20009 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20010 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
20011 convenience functions.
20012 @end table
20013
20014 @node Pretty Printing
20015 @subsubsection Pretty Printing
20016
20017 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values
20018 using Python code. The pretty-printer API allows application-specific
20019 code to greatly simplify the display of complex objects. This
20020 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
20021
20022 For example, here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a
20023 pretty-printer:
20024
20025 @smallexample
20026 (@value{GDBP}) print s
20027 $1 = @{
20028 static npos = 4294967295,
20029 _M_dataplus = @{
20030 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
20031 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{<No data fields>@}, <No data fields>@},
20032 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
20033 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
20034 @}
20035 @}
20036 @end smallexample
20037
20038 After a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} has been installed, only
20039 the contents are printed:
20040
20041 @smallexample
20042 (@value{GDBP}) print s
20043 $2 = "abcd"
20044 @end smallexample
20045
20046 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
20047 specific interface, defined here.
20048
20049 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
20050 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
20051 children of the pretty-printer's value.
20052
20053 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
20054 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
20055 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
20056 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
20057 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
20058
20059 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
20060 as though the value has no children.
20061 @end defop
20062
20063 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
20064 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
20065 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
20066 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
20067 printed.
20068
20069 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
20070 string.
20071
20072 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
20073
20074 @table @samp
20075 @item array
20076 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
20077 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
20078 @code{set print array}.
20079
20080 @item map
20081 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
20082 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
20083 values.
20084
20085 @item string
20086 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
20087 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
20088 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
20089 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
20090 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
20091 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
20092 @end table
20093 @end defop
20094
20095 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
20096 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
20097 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
20098
20099 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
20100 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
20101 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
20102 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
20103 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
20104 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
20105 the result of @code{children}.
20106
20107 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
20108
20109 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
20110 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
20111 another pretty-printer.
20112
20113 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
20114 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
20115 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
20116 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
20117 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
20118
20119 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
20120 @end defop
20121
20122 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
20123 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
20124
20125 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
20126 functions that have been registered via addition as a pretty-printer.
20127 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
20128 attribute.
20129
20130 A function on one of these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
20131 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
20132 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). If a function
20133 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
20134 @code{None}.
20135
20136 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
20137 @code{gdb.Objfile} and iteratively calls each function in the list for
20138 that @code{gdb.Objfile} until it receives a pretty-printer object.
20139 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
20140 @code{gdb.pretty-printers} list, again calling each function until an
20141 object is returned.
20142
20143 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
20144 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
20145 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
20146 object is returned.
20147
20148 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
20149 written:
20150
20151 @smallexample
20152 class StdStringPrinter:
20153 "Print a std::string"
20154
20155 def __init__ (self, val):
20156 self.val = val
20157
20158 def to_string (self):
20159 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
20160
20161 def display_hint (self):
20162 return 'string'
20163 @end smallexample
20164
20165 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
20166 example above might be written.
20167
20168 @smallexample
20169 def str_lookup_function (val):
20170
20171 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
20172 regex = re.compile ("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
20173 if lookup_tag == None:
20174 return None
20175 if regex.match (lookup_tag):
20176 return StdStringPrinter (val)
20177
20178 return None
20179 @end smallexample
20180
20181 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
20182 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
20183 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
20184 returns @code{None}.
20185
20186 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
20187 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
20188 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
20189 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
20190 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
20191 different names.
20192
20193 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
20194 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
20195 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
20196 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
20197 the current objfile.
20198
20199 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
20200 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
20201 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
20202 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
20203 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
20204 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
20205 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
20206 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
20207 inferior.
20208
20209 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
20210 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
20211
20212 @smallexample
20213 def register_printers (objfile):
20214 objfile.pretty_printers.add (str_lookup_function)
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217 @noindent
20218 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
20219
20220 @smallexample
20221 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
20222 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers (gdb.current_objfile ())
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 @node Commands In Python
20226 @subsubsection Commands In Python
20227
20228 @cindex commands in python
20229 @cindex python commands
20230 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
20231 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
20232 class, most commonly using a subclass.
20233
20234 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
20235 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
20236 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
20237 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
20238
20239 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
20240 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
20241 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
20242 an exception is raised.
20243
20244 There is no support for multi-line commands.
20245
20246 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
20247 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
20248 new command in the help system.
20249
20250 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
20251 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
20252 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
20253 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
20254 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
20255 error will occur when completion is attempted.
20256
20257 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
20258 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
20259 registered.
20260
20261 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
20262 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
20263 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
20264 not documented.'' is used.
20265 @end defmethod
20266
20267 @cindex don't repeat Python command
20268 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
20269 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
20270 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
20271 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
20272 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
20273 @end defmethod
20274
20275 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
20276 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
20277
20278 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
20279 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
20280
20281 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
20282 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
20283 that the command came from elsewhere.
20284
20285 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
20286 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
20287 @end defmethod
20288
20289 @cindex completion of Python commands
20290 @defmethod Command complete text word
20291 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
20292 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
20293 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
20294 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
20295 complete}).
20296
20297 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
20298 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
20299 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
20300 using a word-breaking heuristic.
20301
20302 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
20303 @itemize @bullet
20304 @item
20305 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
20306 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
20307 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
20308 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
20309 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
20310 sequence are ignored.
20311
20312 @item
20313 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
20314 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
20315 function is invoked, and its result is used.
20316
20317 @item
20318 All other results are treated as though there were no available
20319 completions.
20320 @end itemize
20321 @end defmethod
20322
20323 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
20324 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
20325 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
20326 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
20327 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
20328 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20329
20330 @table @code
20331 @findex COMMAND_NONE
20332 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
20333 @item COMMAND_NONE
20334 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
20335 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
20336
20337 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
20338 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
20339 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
20340 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
20341 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
20342 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20343 commands in this category.
20344
20345 @findex COMMAND_DATA
20346 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
20347 @item COMMAND_DATA
20348 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
20349 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
20350 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
20351 in this category.
20352
20353 @findex COMMAND_STACK
20354 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
20355 @item COMMAND_STACK
20356 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
20357 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
20358 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
20359 list of commands in this category.
20360
20361 @findex COMMAND_FILES
20362 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
20363 @item COMMAND_FILES
20364 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
20365 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
20366 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20367 commands in this category.
20368
20369 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
20370 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
20371 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
20372 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
20373 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
20374 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
20375 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
20376 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20377 commands in this category.
20378
20379 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
20380 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
20381 @item COMMAND_STATUS
20382 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
20383 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
20384 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
20385 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
20386
20387 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20388 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20389 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20390 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
20391 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20392 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
20393 this category.
20394
20395 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20396 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20397 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20398 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
20399 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
20400 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20401 commands in this category.
20402
20403 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
20404 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
20405 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
20406 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
20407 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
20408 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20409 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
20410 category.
20411
20412 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20413 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20414 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20415 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
20416 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
20417 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20418 commands in this category.
20419 @end table
20420
20421 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
20422 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
20423 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
20424 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20425
20426 @table @code
20427 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
20428 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
20429 @item COMPLETE_NONE
20430 This constant means that no completion should be done.
20431
20432 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
20433 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
20434 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
20435 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
20436
20437 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
20438 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
20439 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
20440 This constant means that location completion should be done.
20441 @xref{Specify Location}.
20442
20443 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
20444 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
20445 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
20446 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
20447 command names.
20448
20449 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20450 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20451 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20452 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
20453 as the source.
20454 @end table
20455
20456 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
20457 implemented in Python:
20458
20459 @smallexample
20460 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20461 """Greet the whole world."""
20462
20463 def __init__ (self):
20464 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20465
20466 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
20467 print "Hello, World!"
20468
20469 HelloWorld ()
20470 @end smallexample
20471
20472 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
20473 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
20474 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
20475 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
20476
20477 @node Functions In Python
20478 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
20479
20480 @cindex writing convenience functions
20481 @cindex convenience functions in python
20482 @cindex python convenience functions
20483 @tindex gdb.Function
20484 @tindex Function
20485 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
20486 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
20487 class @code{gdb.Function}.
20488
20489 @defmethod Function __init__ name
20490 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
20491 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
20492 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
20493 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
20494 the given @var{name}.
20495
20496 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
20497 string for the new class.
20498 @end defmethod
20499
20500 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
20501 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
20502 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
20503 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
20504 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
20505 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
20506 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
20507 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
20508
20509 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
20510 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
20511 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
20512 @end defmethod
20513
20514 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
20515 be implemented in Python:
20516
20517 @smallexample
20518 class Greet (gdb.Function):
20519 """Return string to greet someone.
20520 Takes a name as argument."""
20521
20522 def __init__ (self):
20523 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
20524
20525 def invoke (self, name):
20526 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
20527
20528 Greet ()
20529 @end smallexample
20530
20531 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
20532 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
20533 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
20534 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
20535
20536 @node Objfiles In Python
20537 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
20538
20539 @cindex objfiles in python
20540 @tindex gdb.Objfile
20541 @tindex Objfile
20542 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
20543 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
20544 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
20545 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
20546 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
20547
20548 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
20549 @code{gdb} module:
20550
20551 @findex gdb.current_objfile
20552 @defun current_objfile
20553 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
20554 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
20555 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
20556 this function returns @code{None}.
20557 @end defun
20558
20559 @findex gdb.objfiles
20560 @defun objfiles
20561 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
20562 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
20563 @end defun
20564
20565 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
20566 class.
20567
20568 @defivar Objfile filename
20569 The file name of the objfile as a string.
20570 @end defivar
20571
20572 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
20573 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
20574 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
20575 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
20576 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
20577 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing}, for more
20578 information.
20579 @end defivar
20580
20581 @node Frames In Python
20582 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20583
20584 @cindex frames in python
20585 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
20586 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
20587 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
20588 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
20589 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
20590 exception.
20591
20592 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
20593 operator, like:
20594
20595 @smallexample
20596 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
20597 True
20598 @end smallexample
20599
20600 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
20601
20602 @findex gdb.selected_frame
20603 @defun selected_frame
20604 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
20605 @end defun
20606
20607 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
20608 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
20609 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
20610 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
20611 @end defun
20612
20613 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
20614
20615 @table @code
20616 @defmethod Frame is_valid
20617 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
20618 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
20619 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
20620 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
20621 @end defmethod
20622
20623 @defmethod Frame name
20624 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
20625 obtained.
20626 @end defmethod
20627
20628 @defmethod Frame type
20629 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
20630 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
20631 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
20632 @end defmethod
20633
20634 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
20635 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
20636 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
20637 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
20638 function to a string.
20639 @end defmethod
20640
20641 @defmethod Frame pc
20642 Returns the frame's resume address.
20643 @end defmethod
20644
20645 @defmethod Frame older
20646 Return the frame that called this frame.
20647 @end defmethod
20648
20649 @defmethod Frame newer
20650 Return the frame called by this frame.
20651 @end defmethod
20652
20653 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
20654 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
20655 be a string.
20656 @end defmethod
20657 @end table
20658
20659 @node Lazy Strings In Python
20660 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
20661
20662 @cindex lazy strings in python
20663 @tindex gdb.LazyString
20664
20665 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
20666 encoded until it is needed.
20667
20668 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
20669 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
20670 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
20671 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
20672 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
20673 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
20674 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
20675 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
20676 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
20677
20678 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
20679
20680 @defmethod LazyString value
20681 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
20682 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
20683 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
20684 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
20685 @end defmethod
20686
20687 @defivar LazyString address
20688 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
20689 writable.
20690 @end defivar
20691
20692 @defivar LazyString length
20693 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
20694 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
20695 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
20696 @end defivar
20697
20698 @defivar LazyString encoding
20699 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
20700 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
20701 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
20702 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
20703 is not writable.
20704 @end defivar
20705
20706 @defivar LazyString type
20707 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
20708 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
20709 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
20710 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
20711 writable.
20712 @end defivar
20713
20714 @node Interpreters
20715 @chapter Command Interpreters
20716 @cindex command interpreters
20717
20718 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
20719 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
20720 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
20721
20722 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
20723 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
20724 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
20725 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
20726
20727 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
20728 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
20729 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
20730 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
20731
20732 @table @code
20733 @item console
20734 @cindex console interpreter
20735 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
20736 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
20737 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
20738
20739 @item mi
20740 @cindex mi interpreter
20741 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
20742 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
20743 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
20744 Interface}.
20745
20746 @item mi2
20747 @cindex mi2 interpreter
20748 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
20749
20750 @item mi1
20751 @cindex mi1 interpreter
20752 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
20753
20754 @end table
20755
20756 @cindex invoke another interpreter
20757 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
20758 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
20759 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
20760 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
20761 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
20762 the IDE inoperable!
20763
20764 @kindex interpreter-exec
20765 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
20766 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
20767 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
20768 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
20769
20770 @smallexample
20771 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
20772 @end smallexample
20773
20774 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
20775 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
20776
20777 @node TUI
20778 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
20779 @cindex TUI
20780 @cindex Text User Interface
20781
20782 @menu
20783 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
20784 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
20785 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
20786 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
20787 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
20788 @end menu
20789
20790 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
20791 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
20792 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
20793 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
20794 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
20795 is available.
20796
20797 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
20798 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
20799 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
20800 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
20801 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
20802 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
20803
20804 @node TUI Overview
20805 @section TUI Overview
20806
20807 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
20808
20809 @table @emph
20810 @item command
20811 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
20812 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
20813 managed using readline.
20814
20815 @item source
20816 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
20817 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
20818
20819 @item assembly
20820 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
20821
20822 @item register
20823 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
20824 when their values change.
20825 @end table
20826
20827 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
20828 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
20829 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
20830 indicates the breakpoint type:
20831
20832 @table @code
20833 @item B
20834 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20835
20836 @item b
20837 Breakpoint which was never hit.
20838
20839 @item H
20840 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20841
20842 @item h
20843 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
20844 @end table
20845
20846 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
20847
20848 @table @code
20849 @item +
20850 Breakpoint is enabled.
20851
20852 @item -
20853 Breakpoint is disabled.
20854 @end table
20855
20856 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
20857 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
20858 changes.
20859
20860 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
20861 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
20862 layouts:
20863
20864 @itemize @bullet
20865 @item
20866 source only,
20867
20868 @item
20869 assembly only,
20870
20871 @item
20872 source and assembly,
20873
20874 @item
20875 source and registers, or
20876
20877 @item
20878 assembly and registers.
20879 @end itemize
20880
20881 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
20882
20883 @table @emph
20884 @item target
20885 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
20886 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20887
20888 @item process
20889 Gives the current process or thread number.
20890 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
20891
20892 @item function
20893 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
20894 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
20895 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
20896 the string @code{??} is displayed.
20897
20898 @item line
20899 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
20900 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
20901
20902 @item pc
20903 Indicates the current program counter address.
20904 @end table
20905
20906 @node TUI Keys
20907 @section TUI Key Bindings
20908 @cindex TUI key bindings
20909
20910 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
20911 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
20912 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
20913
20914 @table @kbd
20915 @kindex C-x C-a
20916 @item C-x C-a
20917 @kindex C-x a
20918 @itemx C-x a
20919 @kindex C-x A
20920 @itemx C-x A
20921 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
20922 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
20923 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
20924 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
20925 The screen is then refreshed.
20926
20927 @kindex C-x 1
20928 @item C-x 1
20929 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
20930 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
20931 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
20932
20933 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
20934
20935 @kindex C-x 2
20936 @item C-x 2
20937 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
20938 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
20939 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
20940 previous layout and the new one.
20941
20942 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
20943
20944 @kindex C-x o
20945 @item C-x o
20946 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
20947 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
20948 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
20949
20950 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
20951
20952 @kindex C-x s
20953 @item C-x s
20954 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
20955 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
20956 @end table
20957
20958 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
20959
20960 @table @asis
20961 @kindex PgUp
20962 @item @key{PgUp}
20963 Scroll the active window one page up.
20964
20965 @kindex PgDn
20966 @item @key{PgDn}
20967 Scroll the active window one page down.
20968
20969 @kindex Up
20970 @item @key{Up}
20971 Scroll the active window one line up.
20972
20973 @kindex Down
20974 @item @key{Down}
20975 Scroll the active window one line down.
20976
20977 @kindex Left
20978 @item @key{Left}
20979 Scroll the active window one column left.
20980
20981 @kindex Right
20982 @item @key{Right}
20983 Scroll the active window one column right.
20984
20985 @kindex C-L
20986 @item @kbd{C-L}
20987 Refresh the screen.
20988 @end table
20989
20990 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
20991 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
20992 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
20993 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
20994 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
20995
20996 @node TUI Single Key Mode
20997 @section TUI Single Key Mode
20998 @cindex TUI single key mode
20999
21000 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
21001 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
21002 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
21003
21004 @table @kbd
21005 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21006 @item c
21007 continue
21008
21009 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21010 @item d
21011 down
21012
21013 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21014 @item f
21015 finish
21016
21017 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21018 @item n
21019 next
21020
21021 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21022 @item q
21023 exit the SingleKey mode.
21024
21025 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21026 @item r
21027 run
21028
21029 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21030 @item s
21031 step
21032
21033 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21034 @item u
21035 up
21036
21037 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21038 @item v
21039 info locals
21040
21041 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
21042 @item w
21043 where
21044 @end table
21045
21046 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
21047 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
21048 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
21049 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
21050 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
21051 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
21052
21053
21054 @node TUI Commands
21055 @section TUI-specific Commands
21056 @cindex TUI commands
21057
21058 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
21059 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
21060 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
21061 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
21062
21063 @table @code
21064 @item info win
21065 @kindex info win
21066 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
21067
21068 @item layout next
21069 @kindex layout
21070 Display the next layout.
21071
21072 @item layout prev
21073 Display the previous layout.
21074
21075 @item layout src
21076 Display the source window only.
21077
21078 @item layout asm
21079 Display the assembly window only.
21080
21081 @item layout split
21082 Display the source and assembly window.
21083
21084 @item layout regs
21085 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
21086
21087 @item focus next
21088 @kindex focus
21089 Make the next window active for scrolling.
21090
21091 @item focus prev
21092 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
21093
21094 @item focus src
21095 Make the source window active for scrolling.
21096
21097 @item focus asm
21098 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
21099
21100 @item focus regs
21101 Make the register window active for scrolling.
21102
21103 @item focus cmd
21104 Make the command window active for scrolling.
21105
21106 @item refresh
21107 @kindex refresh
21108 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
21109
21110 @item tui reg float
21111 @kindex tui reg
21112 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
21113
21114 @item tui reg general
21115 Show the general registers in the register window.
21116
21117 @item tui reg next
21118 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
21119 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
21120 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
21121 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
21122
21123 @item tui reg system
21124 Show the system registers in the register window.
21125
21126 @item update
21127 @kindex update
21128 Update the source window and the current execution point.
21129
21130 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
21131 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
21132 @kindex winheight
21133 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
21134 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
21135 decrease it.
21136
21137 @item tabset @var{nchars}
21138 @kindex tabset
21139 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
21140 @end table
21141
21142 @node TUI Configuration
21143 @section TUI Configuration Variables
21144 @cindex TUI configuration variables
21145
21146 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
21147
21148 @table @code
21149 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
21150 @kindex set tui border-kind
21151 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
21152 The possible values are the following:
21153 @table @code
21154 @item space
21155 Use a space character to draw the border.
21156
21157 @item ascii
21158 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
21159
21160 @item acs
21161 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
21162 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
21163 @end table
21164
21165 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
21166 @kindex set tui border-mode
21167 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
21168 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
21169 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
21170 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
21171 @table @code
21172 @item normal
21173 Use normal attributes to display the border.
21174
21175 @item standout
21176 Use standout mode.
21177
21178 @item reverse
21179 Use reverse video mode.
21180
21181 @item half
21182 Use half bright mode.
21183
21184 @item half-standout
21185 Use half bright and standout mode.
21186
21187 @item bold
21188 Use extra bright or bold mode.
21189
21190 @item bold-standout
21191 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
21192 @end table
21193 @end table
21194
21195 @node Emacs
21196 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
21197
21198 @cindex Emacs
21199 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
21200 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
21201 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
21202 @value{GDBN}.
21203
21204 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
21205 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
21206 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
21207 created Emacs buffer.
21208 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
21209
21210 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
21211 things:
21212
21213 @itemize @bullet
21214 @item
21215 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
21216 the GUD buffer.
21217
21218 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
21219 and output done by the program you are debugging.
21220
21221 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
21222 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
21223 in this way.
21224
21225 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
21226 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
21227 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
21228 stop.
21229
21230 @item
21231 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
21232
21233 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
21234 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
21235 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
21236 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
21237 and the source.
21238
21239 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
21240 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
21241 @end itemize
21242
21243 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
21244 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
21245 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
21246 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
21247
21248 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
21249 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
21250 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
21251 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
21252 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
21253 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
21254 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
21255 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
21256 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
21257
21258 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
21259 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
21260 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
21261 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
21262
21263 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
21264 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
21265 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
21266 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
21267 one you want.
21268
21269 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
21270 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
21271
21272 @table @kbd
21273 @item C-h m
21274 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
21275
21276 @item C-c C-s
21277 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
21278 update the display window to show the current file and location.
21279
21280 @item C-c C-n
21281 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
21282 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
21283 to show the current file and location.
21284
21285 @item C-c C-i
21286 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
21287 display window accordingly.
21288
21289 @item C-c C-f
21290 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
21291 @code{finish} command.
21292
21293 @item C-c C-r
21294 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
21295 command.
21296
21297 @item C-c <
21298 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
21299 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
21300 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
21301
21302 @item C-c >
21303 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
21304 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
21305 @end table
21306
21307 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
21308 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
21309
21310 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
21311 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
21312 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
21313 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
21314 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
21315 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
21316 speedbar displays watch expressions.
21317
21318 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
21319 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
21320 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
21321 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
21322 frame.
21323
21324 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
21325 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
21326 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
21327 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
21328 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
21329 to correspond properly with the code.
21330
21331 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
21332 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
21333 Emacs Manual}).
21334
21335 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
21336 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
21337 @ignore
21338 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
21339 @kindex Epoch
21340 @kindex inspect
21341
21342 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
21343 called the @code{epoch}
21344 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
21345 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
21346 each value is printed in its own window.
21347 @end ignore
21348
21349
21350 @node GDB/MI
21351 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
21352
21353 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
21354
21355 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
21356 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
21357 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
21358 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
21359 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
21360 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
21361
21362 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
21363 in the form of a reference manual.
21364
21365 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
21366 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
21367 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
21368
21369 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
21370
21371 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
21372 This chapter uses the following notation:
21373
21374 @itemize @bullet
21375 @item
21376 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
21377
21378 @item
21379 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
21380 it may or may not be given.
21381
21382 @item
21383 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
21384 may repeat zero or more times.
21385
21386 @item
21387 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
21388 may repeat one or more times.
21389
21390 @item
21391 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
21392 @end itemize
21393
21394 @ignore
21395 @heading Dependencies
21396 @end ignore
21397
21398 @menu
21399 * GDB/MI General Design::
21400 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
21401 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
21402 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
21403 * GDB/MI Output Records::
21404 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
21405 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
21406 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
21407 * GDB/MI Program Context::
21408 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
21409 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
21410 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
21411 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
21412 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
21413 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
21414 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
21415 * GDB/MI File Commands::
21416 @ignore
21417 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
21418 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
21419 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
21420 @end ignore
21421 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
21422 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
21423 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
21424 @end menu
21425
21426 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21427 @node GDB/MI General Design
21428 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
21429 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
21430
21431 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
21432 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
21433 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
21434 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
21435 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
21436 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
21437 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
21438 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
21439 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
21440 a command and reported as part of that command response.
21441
21442 The important examples of notifications are:
21443 @itemize @bullet
21444
21445 @item
21446 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
21447 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
21448 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
21449 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
21450 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
21451 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
21452 command itself was successfully executed.
21453
21454 @item
21455 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
21456 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
21457 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
21458 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
21459 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
21460 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
21461
21462 @item
21463 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
21464 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
21465 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
21466 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
21467 orthogonal frontend design.
21468
21469 @end itemize
21470
21471 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
21472 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
21473 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
21474 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
21475 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
21476 the user interface.
21477
21478
21479 @menu
21480 * Context management::
21481 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
21482 * Thread groups::
21483 @end menu
21484
21485 @node Context management
21486 @subsection Context management
21487
21488 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
21489 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
21490 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
21491 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
21492 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
21493 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
21494 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
21495 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
21496 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
21497
21498 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
21499 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
21500 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
21501 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
21502 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
21503 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
21504 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
21505 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
21506 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
21507 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
21508 for thread and frame to operate on.
21509
21510 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
21511 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
21512 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
21513 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
21514 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
21515 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
21516 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
21517 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
21518 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
21519 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
21520
21521 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
21522 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
21523 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
21524 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
21525 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
21526 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
21527 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
21528 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
21529 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
21530 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
21531 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
21532 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
21533 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
21534 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
21535 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
21536 @samp{--frame} options.
21537
21538 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
21539 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
21540
21541 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
21542 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
21543 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
21544 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
21545 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
21546 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
21547 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
21548 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
21549 @code{-list-target-features} command.
21550
21551 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
21552 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
21553 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
21554 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
21555 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
21556 are running.
21557
21558 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
21559 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
21560 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
21561 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
21562 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
21563 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
21564 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
21565 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
21566 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
21567 @samp{--thread} option).
21568
21569 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
21570 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
21571 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
21572 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
21573
21574 @node Thread groups
21575 @subsection Thread groups
21576 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
21577 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
21578 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
21579 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
21580 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
21581
21582 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
21583 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
21584 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
21585 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
21586 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
21587 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
21588 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
21589 into processes.
21590
21591 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
21592 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
21593 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
21594 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
21595 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
21596 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
21597 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
21598 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
21599 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
21600 the members of specific thread group.
21601
21602 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
21603 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
21604 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
21605 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
21606 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
21607 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
21608 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
21609 after attaching to that thread group.
21610
21611 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21612 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
21613 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
21614
21615 @menu
21616 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
21617 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
21618 @end menu
21619
21620 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
21621 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
21622
21623 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
21624 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
21625 @table @code
21626 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
21627 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
21628
21629 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
21630 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
21631 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
21632
21633 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
21634 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
21635 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
21636
21637 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
21638 "any sequence of digits"
21639
21640 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
21641 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
21642
21643 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
21644 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
21645
21646 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
21647 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
21648
21649 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
21650 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
21651 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
21652
21653 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
21654 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
21655
21656 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
21657 @code{CR | CR-LF}
21658 @end table
21659
21660 @noindent
21661 Notes:
21662
21663 @itemize @bullet
21664 @item
21665 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
21666 output is described below.
21667
21668 @item
21669 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
21670 finishes.
21671
21672 @item
21673 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
21674 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
21675 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
21676 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
21677 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
21678 @end itemize
21679
21680 Pragmatics:
21681
21682 @itemize @bullet
21683 @item
21684 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
21685
21686 @item
21687 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
21688 @end itemize
21689
21690 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
21691 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
21692
21693 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
21694 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
21695 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
21696 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
21697 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
21698 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
21699
21700 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
21701 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
21702 @var{token}.
21703
21704 @table @code
21705 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
21706 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
21707
21708 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
21709 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
21710
21711 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
21712 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
21713
21714 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
21715 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
21716
21717 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
21718 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
21719
21720 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
21721 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
21722
21723 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
21724 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
21725
21726 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
21727 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
21728
21729 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
21730 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
21731
21732 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
21733 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
21734 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
21735
21736 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
21737 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
21738
21739 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
21740 @code{ @var{string} }
21741
21742 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
21743 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
21744
21745 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
21746 @code{@var{c-string}}
21747
21748 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
21749 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
21750
21751 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
21752 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
21753 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
21754
21755 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
21756 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
21757
21758 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
21759 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
21760
21761 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
21762 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
21763
21764 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
21765 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
21766
21767 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
21768 @code{CR | CR-LF}
21769
21770 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
21771 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
21772 @end table
21773
21774 @noindent
21775 Notes:
21776
21777 @itemize @bullet
21778 @item
21779 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
21780
21781 @item
21782 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
21783 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
21784 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
21785 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
21786 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
21787 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
21788 prior command.
21789
21790 @item
21791 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21792 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
21793 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
21794 prefixed by @samp{+}.
21795
21796 @item
21797 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21798 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
21799 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
21800 @samp{*}.
21801
21802 @item
21803 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21804 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
21805 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
21806 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
21807
21808 @item
21809 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21810 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
21811 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
21812 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
21813
21814 @item
21815 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21816 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
21817 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
21818
21819 @item
21820 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21821 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
21822 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
21823 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
21824
21825 @item
21826 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21827 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
21828 @var{values}.
21829
21830
21831 @end itemize
21832
21833 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
21834 details about the various output records.
21835
21836 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21837 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
21838 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
21839
21840 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
21841 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
21842
21843 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
21844 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
21845 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
21846 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
21847 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
21848 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
21849
21850 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
21851 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
21852 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
21853
21854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21855 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
21856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
21857 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
21858
21859 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
21860 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
21861
21862 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
21863 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
21864 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
21865 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
21866 might change.
21867
21868 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
21869 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
21870 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
21871 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
21872
21873 @itemize @bullet
21874 @item
21875 New MI commands may be added.
21876
21877 @item
21878 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
21879
21880 @item
21881 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
21882 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
21883
21884 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
21885 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
21886
21887 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
21888 @c resolve inconsistencies.
21889 @end itemize
21890
21891 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
21892 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
21893 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
21894 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
21895 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
21896
21897 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
21898 @c version?
21899
21900 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
21901 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
21902 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
21903 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
21904 @cindex mailing lists
21905
21906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21907 @node GDB/MI Output Records
21908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
21909
21910 @menu
21911 * GDB/MI Result Records::
21912 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
21913 * GDB/MI Async Records::
21914 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
21915 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
21916 @end menu
21917
21918 @node GDB/MI Result Records
21919 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
21920
21921 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21922 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
21923 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
21924 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
21925
21926 @table @code
21927 @findex ^done
21928 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
21929 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
21930 values.
21931
21932 @item "^running"
21933 @findex ^running
21934 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
21935 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
21936 running.
21937
21938 @item "^connected"
21939 @findex ^connected
21940 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
21941
21942 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
21943 @findex ^error
21944 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
21945 error message.
21946
21947 @item "^exit"
21948 @findex ^exit
21949 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
21950
21951 @end table
21952
21953 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
21954 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
21955
21956 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
21957 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21958 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
21959 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
21960 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
21961
21962 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
21963 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
21964 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
21965 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
21966 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
21967
21968 @table @code
21969 @item "~" @var{string-output}
21970 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
21971 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
21972
21973 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
21974 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
21975 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
21976 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
21977
21978 @item "&" @var{string-output}
21979 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
21980 internals.
21981 @end table
21982
21983 @node GDB/MI Async Records
21984 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
21985
21986 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21987 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
21988 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
21989 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
21990 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
21991 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
21992
21993 The following is the list of possible async records:
21994
21995 @table @code
21996
21997 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
21998 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
21999 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
22000 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
22001 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
22002 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
22003 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
22004 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
22005 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
22006 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
22007
22008 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
22009 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
22010 following values:
22011
22012 @table @code
22013 @item breakpoint-hit
22014 A breakpoint was reached.
22015 @item watchpoint-trigger
22016 A watchpoint was triggered.
22017 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
22018 A read watchpoint was triggered.
22019 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
22020 An access watchpoint was triggered.
22021 @item function-finished
22022 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
22023 @item location-reached
22024 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
22025 @item watchpoint-scope
22026 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
22027 @item end-stepping-range
22028 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
22029 similar CLI command was accomplished.
22030 @item exited-signalled
22031 The inferior exited because of a signal.
22032 @item exited
22033 The inferior exited.
22034 @item exited-normally
22035 The inferior exited normally.
22036 @item signal-received
22037 A signal was received by the inferior.
22038 @end table
22039
22040 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
22041 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
22042 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
22043 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
22044 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
22045 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
22046 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
22047 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
22048 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
22049 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
22050 if such information is not available.
22051
22052 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
22053 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
22054 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
22055 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
22056 thread group.
22057
22058 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
22059 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
22060 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
22061 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
22062 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
22063
22064 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
22065 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
22066 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
22067 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
22068 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
22069 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
22070 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
22071
22072 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
22073 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
22074 that thread.
22075
22076 @item =library-loaded,...
22077 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
22078 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
22079 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
22080 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
22081 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
22082 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
22083 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
22084 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
22085 library are loaded.
22086
22087 @item =library-unloaded,...
22088 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
22089 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
22090 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
22091
22092 @end table
22093
22094 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
22095 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
22096
22097 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
22098 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
22099 fields:
22100
22101 @table @code
22102 @item level
22103 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
22104 zero. This field is always present.
22105
22106 @item func
22107 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
22108 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
22109
22110 @item addr
22111 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
22112
22113 @item file
22114 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
22115 address. This field may be absent.
22116
22117 @item line
22118 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
22119 may be absent.
22120
22121 @item from
22122 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
22123 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
22124
22125 @end table
22126
22127 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
22128 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
22129
22130 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
22131 uses a tuple with the following fields:
22132
22133 @table @code
22134 @item id
22135 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
22136 always present.
22137
22138 @item target-id
22139 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
22140
22141 @item details
22142 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
22143 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
22144 frontend. This field is optional.
22145
22146 @item state
22147 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
22148 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
22149
22150 @item core
22151 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
22152 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
22153 @end table
22154
22155
22156 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22157 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
22158 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
22159 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
22160
22161 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
22162 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
22163 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
22164 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
22165
22166 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
22167 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
22168
22169 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
22170
22171 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
22172 information of the breakpoint.
22173
22174 @smallexample
22175 -> -break-insert main
22176 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
22177 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22178 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
22179 <- (gdb)
22180 @end smallexample
22181
22182 @subheading Program Execution
22183
22184 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
22185 reason that execution stopped.
22186
22187 @smallexample
22188 -> -exec-run
22189 <- ^running
22190 <- (gdb)
22191 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22192 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
22193 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
22194 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
22195 <- (gdb)
22196 -> -exec-continue
22197 <- ^running
22198 <- (gdb)
22199 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
22200 <- (gdb)
22201 @end smallexample
22202
22203 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
22204
22205 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
22206
22207 @smallexample
22208 -> (gdb)
22209 <- -gdb-exit
22210 <- ^exit
22211 @end smallexample
22212
22213 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
22214 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
22215 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
22216 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
22217 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
22218 fails to exit in reasonable time.
22219
22220 @subheading A Bad Command
22221
22222 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
22223
22224 @smallexample
22225 -> -rubbish
22226 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
22227 <- (gdb)
22228 @end smallexample
22229
22230
22231 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22232 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
22233 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
22234
22235 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
22236 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
22237
22238 @subheading Motivation
22239
22240 The motivation for this collection of commands.
22241
22242 @subheading Introduction
22243
22244 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
22245
22246 @subheading Commands
22247
22248 For each command in the block, the following is described:
22249
22250 @subsubheading Synopsis
22251
22252 @smallexample
22253 -command @var{args}@dots{}
22254 @end smallexample
22255
22256 @subsubheading Result
22257
22258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22259
22260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
22261
22262 @subsubheading Example
22263
22264 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
22265 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
22266
22267
22268 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22269 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
22270 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
22271
22272 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
22273 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
22274 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
22275 breakpoints.
22276
22277 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
22278 @findex -break-after
22279
22280 @subsubheading Synopsis
22281
22282 @smallexample
22283 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
22284 @end smallexample
22285
22286 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
22287 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
22288 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
22289 @samp{-break-list} command below.
22290
22291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22292
22293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
22294
22295 @subsubheading Example
22296
22297 @smallexample
22298 (gdb)
22299 -break-insert main
22300 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
22301 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
22302 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
22303 (gdb)
22304 -break-after 1 3
22305 ~
22306 ^done
22307 (gdb)
22308 -break-list
22309 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22310 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22311 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22312 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22313 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22314 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22315 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22316 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22317 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22318 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
22319 (gdb)
22320 @end smallexample
22321
22322 @ignore
22323 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
22324 @findex -break-catch
22325 @end ignore
22326
22327 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
22328 @findex -break-commands
22329
22330 @subsubheading Synopsis
22331
22332 @smallexample
22333 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
22334 @end smallexample
22335
22336 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
22337 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
22338 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
22339 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
22340 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
22341 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
22342
22343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22344
22345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
22346
22347 @subsubheading Example
22348
22349 @smallexample
22350 (gdb)
22351 -break-insert main
22352 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
22353 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
22354 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
22355 (gdb)
22356 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
22357 ^done
22358 (gdb)
22359 @end smallexample
22360
22361 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
22362 @findex -break-condition
22363
22364 @subsubheading Synopsis
22365
22366 @smallexample
22367 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
22368 @end smallexample
22369
22370 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
22371 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
22372 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
22373 command below).
22374
22375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22376
22377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
22378
22379 @subsubheading Example
22380
22381 @smallexample
22382 (gdb)
22383 -break-condition 1 1
22384 ^done
22385 (gdb)
22386 -break-list
22387 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22388 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22389 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22390 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22391 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22392 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22393 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22394 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22395 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22396 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
22397 (gdb)
22398 @end smallexample
22399
22400 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
22401 @findex -break-delete
22402
22403 @subsubheading Synopsis
22404
22405 @smallexample
22406 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22407 @end smallexample
22408
22409 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
22410 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
22411
22412 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22413
22414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
22415
22416 @subsubheading Example
22417
22418 @smallexample
22419 (gdb)
22420 -break-delete 1
22421 ^done
22422 (gdb)
22423 -break-list
22424 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
22425 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22426 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22427 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22428 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22429 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22430 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22431 body=[]@}
22432 (gdb)
22433 @end smallexample
22434
22435 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
22436 @findex -break-disable
22437
22438 @subsubheading Synopsis
22439
22440 @smallexample
22441 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22442 @end smallexample
22443
22444 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
22445 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
22446
22447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22448
22449 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
22450
22451 @subsubheading Example
22452
22453 @smallexample
22454 (gdb)
22455 -break-disable 2
22456 ^done
22457 (gdb)
22458 -break-list
22459 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22460 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22461 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22462 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22463 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22464 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22465 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22466 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
22467 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22468 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
22469 (gdb)
22470 @end smallexample
22471
22472 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
22473 @findex -break-enable
22474
22475 @subsubheading Synopsis
22476
22477 @smallexample
22478 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22479 @end smallexample
22480
22481 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
22482
22483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22484
22485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
22486
22487 @subsubheading Example
22488
22489 @smallexample
22490 (gdb)
22491 -break-enable 2
22492 ^done
22493 (gdb)
22494 -break-list
22495 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22496 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22497 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22498 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22499 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22500 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22501 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22502 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22503 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22504 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
22505 (gdb)
22506 @end smallexample
22507
22508 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
22509 @findex -break-info
22510
22511 @subsubheading Synopsis
22512
22513 @smallexample
22514 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
22515 @end smallexample
22516
22517 @c REDUNDANT???
22518 Get information about a single breakpoint.
22519
22520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22521
22522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
22523
22524 @subsubheading Example
22525 N.A.
22526
22527 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
22528 @findex -break-insert
22529
22530 @subsubheading Synopsis
22531
22532 @smallexample
22533 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
22534 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
22535 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
22536 @end smallexample
22537
22538 @noindent
22539 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
22540
22541 @itemize @bullet
22542 @item function
22543 @c @item +offset
22544 @c @item -offset
22545 @c @item linenum
22546 @item filename:linenum
22547 @item filename:function
22548 @item *address
22549 @end itemize
22550
22551 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
22552
22553 @table @samp
22554 @item -t
22555 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
22556 @item -h
22557 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
22558 @item -c @var{condition}
22559 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
22560 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
22561 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
22562 @item -f
22563 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
22564 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
22565 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
22566 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
22567 cannot be parsed.
22568 @item -d
22569 Create a disabled breakpoint.
22570 @end table
22571
22572 @subsubheading Result
22573
22574 The result is in the form:
22575
22576 @smallexample
22577 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
22578 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
22579 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
22580 times="@var{times}"@}
22581 @end smallexample
22582
22583 @noindent
22584 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
22585 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
22586 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
22587 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
22588 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
22589 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
22590 which use the same output).
22591
22592 Note: this format is open to change.
22593 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
22594
22595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22596
22597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
22598 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
22599
22600 @subsubheading Example
22601
22602 @smallexample
22603 (gdb)
22604 -break-insert main
22605 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
22606 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
22607 (gdb)
22608 -break-insert -t foo
22609 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
22610 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
22611 (gdb)
22612 -break-list
22613 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22614 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22615 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22616 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22617 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22618 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22619 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22620 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22621 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
22622 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
22623 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
22624 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
22625 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
22626 (gdb)
22627 -break-insert -r foo.*
22628 ~int foo(int, int);
22629 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
22630 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
22631 (gdb)
22632 @end smallexample
22633
22634 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
22635 @findex -break-list
22636
22637 @subsubheading Synopsis
22638
22639 @smallexample
22640 -break-list
22641 @end smallexample
22642
22643 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
22644
22645 @table @samp
22646 @item Number
22647 number of the breakpoint
22648 @item Type
22649 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
22650 @item Disposition
22651 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
22652 or @samp{nokeep}
22653 @item Enabled
22654 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
22655 @item Address
22656 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
22657 @item What
22658 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
22659 name, line number
22660 @item Times
22661 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
22662 @end table
22663
22664 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
22665 @code{body} field is an empty list.
22666
22667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22668
22669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
22670
22671 @subsubheading Example
22672
22673 @smallexample
22674 (gdb)
22675 -break-list
22676 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22677 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22678 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22679 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22680 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22681 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22682 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22683 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22684 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
22685 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22686 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22687 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
22688 (gdb)
22689 @end smallexample
22690
22691 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
22692
22693 @smallexample
22694 (gdb)
22695 -break-list
22696 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
22697 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22698 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22699 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22700 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22701 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22702 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22703 body=[]@}
22704 (gdb)
22705 @end smallexample
22706
22707 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
22708 @findex -break-watch
22709
22710 @subsubheading Synopsis
22711
22712 @smallexample
22713 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
22714 @end smallexample
22715
22716 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
22717 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
22718 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
22719 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
22720 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
22721 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
22722 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
22723 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
22724
22725 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
22726 breakpoints inserted.
22727
22728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22729
22730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
22731 @samp{rwatch}.
22732
22733 @subsubheading Example
22734
22735 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
22736
22737 @smallexample
22738 (gdb)
22739 -break-watch x
22740 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
22741 (gdb)
22742 -exec-continue
22743 ^running
22744 (gdb)
22745 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
22746 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
22747 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
22748 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
22749 (gdb)
22750 @end smallexample
22751
22752 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
22753 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
22754 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
22755
22756 @smallexample
22757 (gdb)
22758 -break-watch C
22759 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
22760 (gdb)
22761 -exec-continue
22762 ^running
22763 (gdb)
22764 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
22765 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
22766 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22767 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22768 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
22769 (gdb)
22770 -exec-continue
22771 ^running
22772 (gdb)
22773 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
22774 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
22775 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22776 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22777 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22778 (gdb)
22779 @end smallexample
22780
22781 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
22782 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
22783 deleted.
22784
22785 @smallexample
22786 (gdb)
22787 -break-watch C
22788 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
22789 (gdb)
22790 -break-list
22791 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22792 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22793 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22794 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22795 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22796 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22797 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22798 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22799 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22800 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22801 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
22802 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22803 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
22804 (gdb)
22805 -exec-continue
22806 ^running
22807 (gdb)
22808 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
22809 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
22810 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22811 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22812 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
22813 (gdb)
22814 -break-list
22815 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22816 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22817 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22818 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22819 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22820 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22821 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22822 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22823 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22824 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22825 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
22826 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22827 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
22828 (gdb)
22829 -exec-continue
22830 ^running
22831 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
22832 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
22833 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22834 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22835 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22836 (gdb)
22837 -break-list
22838 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22839 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22840 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22841 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22842 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22843 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22844 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22845 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22846 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22847 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22848 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
22849 times="1"@}]@}
22850 (gdb)
22851 @end smallexample
22852
22853 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22854 @node GDB/MI Program Context
22855 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
22856
22857 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
22858 @findex -exec-arguments
22859
22860
22861 @subsubheading Synopsis
22862
22863 @smallexample
22864 -exec-arguments @var{args}
22865 @end smallexample
22866
22867 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
22868 @samp{-exec-run}.
22869
22870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22871
22872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
22873
22874 @subsubheading Example
22875
22876 @smallexample
22877 (gdb)
22878 -exec-arguments -v word
22879 ^done
22880 (gdb)
22881 @end smallexample
22882
22883
22884 @ignore
22885 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
22886 @findex -exec-show-arguments
22887
22888 @subsubheading Synopsis
22889
22890 @smallexample
22891 -exec-show-arguments
22892 @end smallexample
22893
22894 Print the arguments of the program.
22895
22896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22897
22898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
22899
22900 @subsubheading Example
22901 N.A.
22902 @end ignore
22903
22904
22905 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
22906 @findex -environment-cd
22907
22908 @subsubheading Synopsis
22909
22910 @smallexample
22911 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
22912 @end smallexample
22913
22914 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
22915
22916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22917
22918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
22919
22920 @subsubheading Example
22921
22922 @smallexample
22923 (gdb)
22924 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22925 ^done
22926 (gdb)
22927 @end smallexample
22928
22929
22930 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
22931 @findex -environment-directory
22932
22933 @subsubheading Synopsis
22934
22935 @smallexample
22936 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22937 @end smallexample
22938
22939 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
22940 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
22941 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
22942 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22943 occurs as normal.
22944 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22945 multiple directories in a single command
22946 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22947 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22948 If blanks are needed as
22949 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
22950 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
22951 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
22952 character must not be used
22953 in any directory name.
22954 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
22955
22956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22957
22958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
22959
22960 @subsubheading Example
22961
22962 @smallexample
22963 (gdb)
22964 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22965 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22966 (gdb)
22967 -environment-directory ""
22968 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22969 (gdb)
22970 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
22971 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
22972 (gdb)
22973 -environment-directory -r
22974 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
22975 (gdb)
22976 @end smallexample
22977
22978
22979 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
22980 @findex -environment-path
22981
22982 @subsubheading Synopsis
22983
22984 @smallexample
22985 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22986 @end smallexample
22987
22988 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
22989 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
22990 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
22991 supplied in addition to the
22992 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22993 occurs as normal.
22994 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22995 multiple directories in a single command
22996 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22997 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22998 If blanks are needed as
22999 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
23000 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
23001 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
23002 character must not be used
23003 in any directory name.
23004 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
23005
23006
23007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23008
23009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
23010
23011 @subsubheading Example
23012
23013 @smallexample
23014 (gdb)
23015 -environment-path
23016 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
23017 (gdb)
23018 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
23019 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
23020 (gdb)
23021 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
23022 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
23023 (gdb)
23024 @end smallexample
23025
23026
23027 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
23028 @findex -environment-pwd
23029
23030 @subsubheading Synopsis
23031
23032 @smallexample
23033 -environment-pwd
23034 @end smallexample
23035
23036 Show the current working directory.
23037
23038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23039
23040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
23041
23042 @subsubheading Example
23043
23044 @smallexample
23045 (gdb)
23046 -environment-pwd
23047 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
23048 (gdb)
23049 @end smallexample
23050
23051 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23052 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
23053 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
23054
23055
23056 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
23057 @findex -thread-info
23058
23059 @subsubheading Synopsis
23060
23061 @smallexample
23062 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
23063 @end smallexample
23064
23065 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
23066 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
23067 threads. When printing information about all threads,
23068 also reports the current thread.
23069
23070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23071
23072 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
23073 about all threads.
23074
23075 @subsubheading Example
23076
23077 @smallexample
23078 -thread-info
23079 ^done,threads=[
23080 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
23081 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
23082 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
23083 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
23084 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
23085 current-thread-id="1"
23086 (gdb)
23087 @end smallexample
23088
23089 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
23090
23091 @table @code
23092 @item stopped
23093 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
23094 threads.
23095
23096 @item running
23097 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
23098 threads.
23099
23100 @end table
23101
23102 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
23103 @findex -thread-list-ids
23104
23105 @subsubheading Synopsis
23106
23107 @smallexample
23108 -thread-list-ids
23109 @end smallexample
23110
23111 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
23112 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
23113
23114 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
23115 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
23116
23117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23118
23119 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
23120
23121 @subsubheading Example
23122
23123 @smallexample
23124 (gdb)
23125 -thread-list-ids
23126 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
23127 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
23128 (gdb)
23129 @end smallexample
23130
23131
23132 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
23133 @findex -thread-select
23134
23135 @subsubheading Synopsis
23136
23137 @smallexample
23138 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
23139 @end smallexample
23140
23141 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
23142 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
23143
23144 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
23145 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
23146
23147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23148
23149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
23150
23151 @subsubheading Example
23152
23153 @smallexample
23154 (gdb)
23155 -exec-next
23156 ^running
23157 (gdb)
23158 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
23159 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
23160 (gdb)
23161 -thread-list-ids
23162 ^done,
23163 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
23164 number-of-threads="3"
23165 (gdb)
23166 -thread-select 3
23167 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
23168 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
23169 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
23170 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
23171 (gdb)
23172 @end smallexample
23173
23174 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23175 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
23176 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
23177
23178 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
23179 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
23180 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
23181 other cases.
23182
23183 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
23184 @findex -exec-continue
23185
23186 @subsubheading Synopsis
23187
23188 @smallexample
23189 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
23190 @end smallexample
23191
23192 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
23193 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
23194 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
23195 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
23196 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
23197 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
23198 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
23199 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
23200 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
23201 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
23202 thread group are resumed.
23203
23204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23205
23206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
23207
23208 @subsubheading Example
23209
23210 @smallexample
23211 -exec-continue
23212 ^running
23213 (gdb)
23214 @@Hello world
23215 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
23216 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
23217 line="13"@}
23218 (gdb)
23219 @end smallexample
23220
23221
23222 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
23223 @findex -exec-finish
23224
23225 @subsubheading Synopsis
23226
23227 @smallexample
23228 -exec-finish
23229 @end smallexample
23230
23231 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
23232 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
23233
23234 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23235
23236 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
23237
23238 @subsubheading Example
23239
23240 Function returning @code{void}.
23241
23242 @smallexample
23243 -exec-finish
23244 ^running
23245 (gdb)
23246 @@hello from foo
23247 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
23248 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
23249 (gdb)
23250 @end smallexample
23251
23252 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
23253 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
23254 value itself.
23255
23256 @smallexample
23257 -exec-finish
23258 ^running
23259 (gdb)
23260 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
23261 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
23262 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23263 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
23264 (gdb)
23265 @end smallexample
23266
23267
23268 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
23269 @findex -exec-interrupt
23270
23271 @subsubheading Synopsis
23272
23273 @smallexample
23274 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
23275 @end smallexample
23276
23277 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
23278 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
23279 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
23280 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
23281 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
23282
23283 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
23284 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
23285 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
23286 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
23287
23288 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
23289 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
23290 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
23291 threads in that group will be interrupted.
23292
23293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23294
23295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
23296
23297 @subsubheading Example
23298
23299 @smallexample
23300 (gdb)
23301 111-exec-continue
23302 111^running
23303
23304 (gdb)
23305 222-exec-interrupt
23306 222^done
23307 (gdb)
23308 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
23309 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23310 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
23311 (gdb)
23312
23313 (gdb)
23314 -exec-interrupt
23315 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
23316 (gdb)
23317 @end smallexample
23318
23319 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
23320 @findex -exec-jump
23321
23322 @subsubheading Synopsis
23323
23324 @smallexample
23325 -exec-jump @var{location}
23326 @end smallexample
23327
23328 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
23329 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
23330 different forms of @var{location}.
23331
23332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23333
23334 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
23335
23336 @subsubheading Example
23337
23338 @smallexample
23339 -exec-jump foo.c:10
23340 *running,thread-id="all"
23341 ^running
23342 @end smallexample
23343
23344
23345 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
23346 @findex -exec-next
23347
23348 @subsubheading Synopsis
23349
23350 @smallexample
23351 -exec-next
23352 @end smallexample
23353
23354 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
23355 of the next source line is reached.
23356
23357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23358
23359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
23360
23361 @subsubheading Example
23362
23363 @smallexample
23364 -exec-next
23365 ^running
23366 (gdb)
23367 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
23368 (gdb)
23369 @end smallexample
23370
23371
23372 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
23373 @findex -exec-next-instruction
23374
23375 @subsubheading Synopsis
23376
23377 @smallexample
23378 -exec-next-instruction
23379 @end smallexample
23380
23381 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
23382 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
23383 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
23384 printed as well.
23385
23386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23387
23388 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
23389
23390 @subsubheading Example
23391
23392 @smallexample
23393 (gdb)
23394 -exec-next-instruction
23395 ^running
23396
23397 (gdb)
23398 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23399 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
23400 (gdb)
23401 @end smallexample
23402
23403
23404 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
23405 @findex -exec-return
23406
23407 @subsubheading Synopsis
23408
23409 @smallexample
23410 -exec-return
23411 @end smallexample
23412
23413 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
23414 Displays the new current frame.
23415
23416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23417
23418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
23419
23420 @subsubheading Example
23421
23422 @smallexample
23423 (gdb)
23424 200-break-insert callee4
23425 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
23426 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
23427 (gdb)
23428 000-exec-run
23429 000^running
23430 (gdb)
23431 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
23432 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
23433 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23434 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
23435 (gdb)
23436 205-break-delete
23437 205^done
23438 (gdb)
23439 111-exec-return
23440 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
23441 args=[@{name="strarg",
23442 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
23443 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23444 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
23445 (gdb)
23446 @end smallexample
23447
23448
23449 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
23450 @findex -exec-run
23451
23452 @subsubheading Synopsis
23453
23454 @smallexample
23455 -exec-run
23456 @end smallexample
23457
23458 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
23459 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
23460 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
23461 the program has exited exceptionally.
23462
23463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23464
23465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
23466
23467 @subsubheading Examples
23468
23469 @smallexample
23470 (gdb)
23471 -break-insert main
23472 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
23473 (gdb)
23474 -exec-run
23475 ^running
23476 (gdb)
23477 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
23478 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
23479 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
23480 (gdb)
23481 @end smallexample
23482
23483 @noindent
23484 Program exited normally:
23485
23486 @smallexample
23487 (gdb)
23488 -exec-run
23489 ^running
23490 (gdb)
23491 x = 55
23492 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
23493 (gdb)
23494 @end smallexample
23495
23496 @noindent
23497 Program exited exceptionally:
23498
23499 @smallexample
23500 (gdb)
23501 -exec-run
23502 ^running
23503 (gdb)
23504 x = 55
23505 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
23506 (gdb)
23507 @end smallexample
23508
23509 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
23510 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
23511
23512 @smallexample
23513 (gdb)
23514 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
23515 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
23516 @end smallexample
23517
23518
23519 @c @subheading -exec-signal
23520
23521
23522 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
23523 @findex -exec-step
23524
23525 @subsubheading Synopsis
23526
23527 @smallexample
23528 -exec-step
23529 @end smallexample
23530
23531 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
23532 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
23533 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
23534 function.
23535
23536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23537
23538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
23539
23540 @subsubheading Example
23541
23542 Stepping into a function:
23543
23544 @smallexample
23545 -exec-step
23546 ^running
23547 (gdb)
23548 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23549 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
23550 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
23551 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
23552 (gdb)
23553 @end smallexample
23554
23555 Regular stepping:
23556
23557 @smallexample
23558 -exec-step
23559 ^running
23560 (gdb)
23561 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
23562 (gdb)
23563 @end smallexample
23564
23565
23566 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
23567 @findex -exec-step-instruction
23568
23569 @subsubheading Synopsis
23570
23571 @smallexample
23572 -exec-step-instruction
23573 @end smallexample
23574
23575 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
23576 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
23577 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
23578 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
23579 well.
23580
23581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23582
23583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
23584
23585 @subsubheading Example
23586
23587 @smallexample
23588 (gdb)
23589 -exec-step-instruction
23590 ^running
23591
23592 (gdb)
23593 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23594 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23595 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
23596 (gdb)
23597 -exec-step-instruction
23598 ^running
23599
23600 (gdb)
23601 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23602 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23603 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
23604 (gdb)
23605 @end smallexample
23606
23607
23608 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
23609 @findex -exec-until
23610
23611 @subsubheading Synopsis
23612
23613 @smallexample
23614 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
23615 @end smallexample
23616
23617 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
23618 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
23619 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
23620 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
23621
23622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23623
23624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
23625
23626 @subsubheading Example
23627
23628 @smallexample
23629 (gdb)
23630 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
23631 ^running
23632 (gdb)
23633 x = 55
23634 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
23635 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
23636 (gdb)
23637 @end smallexample
23638
23639 @ignore
23640 @subheading -file-clear
23641 Is this going away????
23642 @end ignore
23643
23644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23645 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
23646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
23647
23648
23649 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
23650 @findex -stack-info-frame
23651
23652 @subsubheading Synopsis
23653
23654 @smallexample
23655 -stack-info-frame
23656 @end smallexample
23657
23658 Get info on the selected frame.
23659
23660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23661
23662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
23663 (without arguments).
23664
23665 @subsubheading Example
23666
23667 @smallexample
23668 (gdb)
23669 -stack-info-frame
23670 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
23671 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23672 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
23673 (gdb)
23674 @end smallexample
23675
23676 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
23677 @findex -stack-info-depth
23678
23679 @subsubheading Synopsis
23680
23681 @smallexample
23682 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
23683 @end smallexample
23684
23685 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
23686 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
23687
23688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23689
23690 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23691
23692 @subsubheading Example
23693
23694 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
23695
23696 @smallexample
23697 (gdb)
23698 -stack-info-depth
23699 ^done,depth="12"
23700 (gdb)
23701 -stack-info-depth 4
23702 ^done,depth="4"
23703 (gdb)
23704 -stack-info-depth 12
23705 ^done,depth="12"
23706 (gdb)
23707 -stack-info-depth 11
23708 ^done,depth="11"
23709 (gdb)
23710 -stack-info-depth 13
23711 ^done,depth="12"
23712 (gdb)
23713 @end smallexample
23714
23715 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
23716 @findex -stack-list-arguments
23717
23718 @subsubheading Synopsis
23719
23720 @smallexample
23721 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
23722 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
23723 @end smallexample
23724
23725 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
23726 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
23727 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
23728 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
23729 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
23730 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
23731 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
23732 which case only existing frames will be returned.
23733
23734 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23735 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23736 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23737 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23738 structures and unions.
23739
23740 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
23741 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
23742
23743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23744
23745 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
23746 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
23747 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
23748
23749 @subsubheading Example
23750
23751 @smallexample
23752 (gdb)
23753 -stack-list-frames
23754 ^done,
23755 stack=[
23756 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
23757 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23758 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
23759 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
23760 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23761 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
23762 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
23763 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23764 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
23765 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
23766 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23767 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
23768 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
23769 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23770 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
23771 (gdb)
23772 -stack-list-arguments 0
23773 ^done,
23774 stack-args=[
23775 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
23776 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
23777 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
23778 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
23779 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
23780 (gdb)
23781 -stack-list-arguments 1
23782 ^done,
23783 stack-args=[
23784 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
23785 frame=@{level="1",
23786 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23787 frame=@{level="2",args=[
23788 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23789 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23790 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
23791 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23792 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
23793 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
23794 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
23795 (gdb)
23796 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
23797 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
23798 (gdb)
23799 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
23800 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
23801 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23802 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
23803 (gdb)
23804 @end smallexample
23805
23806 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
23807
23808
23809 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
23810 @findex -stack-list-frames
23811
23812 @subsubheading Synopsis
23813
23814 @smallexample
23815 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
23816 @end smallexample
23817
23818 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
23819 following info:
23820
23821 @table @samp
23822 @item @var{level}
23823 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
23824 @item @var{addr}
23825 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
23826 @item @var{func}
23827 Function name.
23828 @item @var{file}
23829 File name of the source file where the function lives.
23830 @item @var{line}
23831 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
23832 @end table
23833
23834 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
23835 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
23836 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
23837 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
23838 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
23839 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
23840 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
23841
23842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23843
23844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
23845
23846 @subsubheading Example
23847
23848 Full stack backtrace:
23849
23850 @smallexample
23851 (gdb)
23852 -stack-list-frames
23853 ^done,stack=
23854 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
23855 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
23856 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23857 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23858 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23859 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23860 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23861 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23862 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23863 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23864 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23865 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23866 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23867 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23868 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23869 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23870 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23871 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23872 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23873 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23874 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23875 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23876 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
23877 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
23878 (gdb)
23879 @end smallexample
23880
23881 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
23882
23883 @smallexample
23884 (gdb)
23885 -stack-list-frames 3 5
23886 ^done,stack=
23887 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23888 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23889 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23890 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23891 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23892 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23893 (gdb)
23894 @end smallexample
23895
23896 Show a single frame:
23897
23898 @smallexample
23899 (gdb)
23900 -stack-list-frames 3 3
23901 ^done,stack=
23902 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23903 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23904 (gdb)
23905 @end smallexample
23906
23907
23908 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
23909 @findex -stack-list-locals
23910
23911 @subsubheading Synopsis
23912
23913 @smallexample
23914 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
23915 @end smallexample
23916
23917 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
23918 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23919 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23920 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23921 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23922 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
23923 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
23924 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
23925 more detail.
23926
23927 This command is deprecated in favor of the
23928 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
23929
23930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23931
23932 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
23933
23934 @subsubheading Example
23935
23936 @smallexample
23937 (gdb)
23938 -stack-list-locals 0
23939 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
23940 (gdb)
23941 -stack-list-locals --all-values
23942 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
23943 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
23944 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
23945 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
23946 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
23947 (gdb)
23948 @end smallexample
23949
23950 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
23951 @findex -stack-list-variables
23952
23953 @subsubheading Synopsis
23954
23955 @smallexample
23956 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
23957 @end smallexample
23958
23959 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
23960 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23961 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23962 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23963 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23964 structures and unions.
23965
23966 @subsubheading Example
23967
23968 @smallexample
23969 (gdb)
23970 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
23971 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
23972 (gdb)
23973 @end smallexample
23974
23975
23976 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
23977 @findex -stack-select-frame
23978
23979 @subsubheading Synopsis
23980
23981 @smallexample
23982 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
23983 @end smallexample
23984
23985 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
23986 the stack.
23987
23988 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
23989 option to every command.
23990
23991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23992
23993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
23994 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
23995
23996 @subsubheading Example
23997
23998 @smallexample
23999 (gdb)
24000 -stack-select-frame 2
24001 ^done
24002 (gdb)
24003 @end smallexample
24004
24005 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24006 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
24007 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
24008
24009 @ignore
24010
24011 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
24012
24013 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
24014 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
24015 used by @code{Insight}.
24016
24017 The two main reasons for that are:
24018
24019 @enumerate 1
24020 @item
24021 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
24022
24023 @item
24024 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
24025 now).
24026 @end enumerate
24027
24028 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
24029 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
24030 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
24031 hints about their use.
24032
24033 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
24034 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
24035 least, the following operations:
24036
24037 @itemize @bullet
24038 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
24039 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
24040 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
24041 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
24042 @end itemize
24043
24044 @end ignore
24045
24046 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
24047
24048 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
24049
24050 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
24051 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
24052 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
24053 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
24054 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
24055 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
24056 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
24057 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
24058 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
24059 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
24060 object, or to change display format.
24061
24062 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
24063 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
24064 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
24065 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
24066 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
24067 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
24068 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
24069 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
24070 child will be created.
24071
24072 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
24073 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
24074 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
24075 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
24076 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
24077
24078 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
24079 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
24080 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
24081 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
24082 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
24083 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
24084 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
24085 variables that frontend has created.
24086
24087 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
24088 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
24089 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
24090 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
24091 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
24092 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
24093 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
24094 implicitly updated.
24095
24096 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
24097 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
24098 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
24099 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
24100 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
24101 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
24102 frame. Consider this example:
24103
24104 @smallexample
24105 void do_work(...)
24106 @{
24107 struct work_state state;
24108
24109 if (...)
24110 do_work(...);
24111 @}
24112 @end smallexample
24113
24114 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
24115 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
24116 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
24117 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
24118 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
24119
24120 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
24121 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
24122 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
24123 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
24124 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
24125 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
24126
24127 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
24128 access this functionality:
24129
24130 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
24131 @item @strong{Operation}
24132 @tab @strong{Description}
24133
24134 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
24135 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
24136 @item @code{-var-create}
24137 @tab create a variable object
24138 @item @code{-var-delete}
24139 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
24140 @item @code{-var-set-format}
24141 @tab set the display format of this variable
24142 @item @code{-var-show-format}
24143 @tab show the display format of this variable
24144 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
24145 @tab tells how many children this object has
24146 @item @code{-var-list-children}
24147 @tab return a list of the object's children
24148 @item @code{-var-info-type}
24149 @tab show the type of this variable object
24150 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
24151 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
24152 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
24153 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
24154 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
24155 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
24156 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
24157 @tab get the value of this variable
24158 @item @code{-var-assign}
24159 @tab set the value of this variable
24160 @item @code{-var-update}
24161 @tab update the variable and its children
24162 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
24163 @tab set frozeness attribute
24164 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
24165 @tab set range of children to display on update
24166 @end multitable
24167
24168 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
24169 how it can be used.
24170
24171 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
24172
24173 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
24174 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
24175
24176 @smallexample
24177 -enable-pretty-printing
24178 @end smallexample
24179
24180 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
24181 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
24182 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
24183 request that this functionality be enabled.
24184
24185 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
24186
24187 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
24188 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
24189
24190 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
24191 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
24192
24193 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
24194 @findex -var-create
24195
24196 @subsubheading Synopsis
24197
24198 @smallexample
24199 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
24200 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
24201 @end smallexample
24202
24203 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
24204 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
24205 register.
24206
24207 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
24208 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
24209 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
24210 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
24211 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
24212
24213 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
24214 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
24215 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
24216 object must be created.
24217
24218 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
24219 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
24220
24221 @itemize @bullet
24222 @item
24223 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
24224
24225 @item
24226 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
24227
24228 @item
24229 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
24230 @end itemize
24231
24232 @cindex dynamic varobj
24233 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
24234 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
24235 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
24236 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
24237 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
24238 compatibility for existing clients.
24239
24240 @subsubheading Result
24241
24242 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
24243 are:
24244
24245 @table @samp
24246 @item name
24247 The name of the varobj.
24248
24249 @item numchild
24250 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
24251 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
24252 @samp{has_more} attribute.
24253
24254 @item value
24255 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
24256 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
24257 will not be interesting.
24258
24259 @item type
24260 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
24261 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
24262
24263 @item thread-id
24264 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
24265 thread's identifier.
24266
24267 @item has_more
24268 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
24269 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
24270
24271 @item dynamic
24272 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
24273 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
24274 then this attribute will not be present.
24275
24276 @item displayhint
24277 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
24278 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
24279 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing}.
24280 @end table
24281
24282 Typical output will look like this:
24283
24284 @smallexample
24285 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
24286 has_more="@var{has_more}"
24287 @end smallexample
24288
24289
24290 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
24291 @findex -var-delete
24292
24293 @subsubheading Synopsis
24294
24295 @smallexample
24296 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
24297 @end smallexample
24298
24299 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
24300 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
24301
24302 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
24303
24304
24305 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
24306 @findex -var-set-format
24307
24308 @subsubheading Synopsis
24309
24310 @smallexample
24311 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
24312 @end smallexample
24313
24314 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
24315 @var{format-spec}.
24316
24317 @anchor{-var-set-format}
24318 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
24319
24320 @smallexample
24321 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
24322 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
24323 @end smallexample
24324
24325 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
24326 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
24327 for pointers, etc.).
24328
24329 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
24330 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
24331
24332 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
24333 @findex -var-show-format
24334
24335 @subsubheading Synopsis
24336
24337 @smallexample
24338 -var-show-format @var{name}
24339 @end smallexample
24340
24341 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
24342
24343 @smallexample
24344 @var{format} @expansion{}
24345 @var{format-spec}
24346 @end smallexample
24347
24348
24349 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
24350 @findex -var-info-num-children
24351
24352 @subsubheading Synopsis
24353
24354 @smallexample
24355 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
24356 @end smallexample
24357
24358 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
24359
24360 @smallexample
24361 numchild=@var{n}
24362 @end smallexample
24363
24364 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
24365 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
24366 be available.
24367
24368
24369 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
24370 @findex -var-list-children
24371
24372 @subsubheading Synopsis
24373
24374 @smallexample
24375 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
24376 @end smallexample
24377 @anchor{-var-list-children}
24378
24379 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
24380 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
24381 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
24382 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
24383 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
24384 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
24385 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
24386 and unions.
24387
24388 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
24389 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
24390 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
24391 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
24392 reported.
24393
24394 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
24395 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
24396 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
24397 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
24398 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
24399 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
24400 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
24401 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
24402 the visible items.
24403
24404 For each child the following results are returned:
24405
24406 @table @var
24407
24408 @item name
24409 Name of the variable object created for this child.
24410
24411 @item exp
24412 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
24413 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
24414
24415 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
24416 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
24417
24418 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
24419 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
24420 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
24421 type and value are not present.
24422
24423 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
24424 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
24425 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
24426
24427 @item numchild
24428 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
24429 0.
24430
24431 @item type
24432 The type of the child.
24433
24434 @item value
24435 If values were requested, this is the value.
24436
24437 @item thread-id
24438 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
24439 Otherwise this result is not present.
24440
24441 @item frozen
24442 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
24443 @end table
24444
24445 The result may have its own attributes:
24446
24447 @table @samp
24448 @item displayhint
24449 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
24450 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
24451 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing}.
24452
24453 @item has_more
24454 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
24455 remaining after the end of the selected range.
24456 @end table
24457
24458 @subsubheading Example
24459
24460 @smallexample
24461 (gdb)
24462 -var-list-children n
24463 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
24464 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
24465 (gdb)
24466 -var-list-children --all-values n
24467 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
24468 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
24469 @end smallexample
24470
24471
24472 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
24473 @findex -var-info-type
24474
24475 @subsubheading Synopsis
24476
24477 @smallexample
24478 -var-info-type @var{name}
24479 @end smallexample
24480
24481 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
24482 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
24483 @value{GDBN} CLI:
24484
24485 @smallexample
24486 type=@var{typename}
24487 @end smallexample
24488
24489
24490 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
24491 @findex -var-info-expression
24492
24493 @subsubheading Synopsis
24494
24495 @smallexample
24496 -var-info-expression @var{name}
24497 @end smallexample
24498
24499 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
24500 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
24501 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
24502
24503 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
24504 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
24505
24506 @smallexample
24507 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
24508 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
24509 @end smallexample
24510
24511 @noindent
24512 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
24513
24514 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
24515 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
24516 is of limited use.
24517
24518 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
24519 @findex -var-info-path-expression
24520
24521 @subsubheading Synopsis
24522
24523 @smallexample
24524 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
24525 @end smallexample
24526
24527 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
24528 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
24529 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
24530 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
24531 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
24532 watchpoint from a variable object.
24533
24534 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
24535 and will give an error when invoked on one.
24536
24537 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
24538 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
24539 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
24540 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
24541 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
24542 @smallexample
24543 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
24544 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
24545 @end smallexample
24546
24547 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
24548 @findex -var-show-attributes
24549
24550 @subsubheading Synopsis
24551
24552 @smallexample
24553 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
24554 @end smallexample
24555
24556 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
24557
24558 @smallexample
24559 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
24560 @end smallexample
24561
24562 @noindent
24563 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
24564
24565 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
24566 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
24567
24568 @subsubheading Synopsis
24569
24570 @smallexample
24571 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
24572 @end smallexample
24573
24574 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
24575 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
24576 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
24577 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
24578 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
24579 the current display format will be used. The current display format
24580 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
24581
24582 @smallexample
24583 value=@var{value}
24584 @end smallexample
24585
24586 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
24587 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
24588
24589 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
24590 @findex -var-assign
24591
24592 @subsubheading Synopsis
24593
24594 @smallexample
24595 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
24596 @end smallexample
24597
24598 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
24599 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
24600 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
24601 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
24602
24603 @subsubheading Example
24604
24605 @smallexample
24606 (gdb)
24607 -var-assign var1 3
24608 ^done,value="3"
24609 (gdb)
24610 -var-update *
24611 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
24612 (gdb)
24613 @end smallexample
24614
24615 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
24616 @findex -var-update
24617
24618 @subsubheading Synopsis
24619
24620 @smallexample
24621 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
24622 @end smallexample
24623
24624 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
24625 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
24626 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
24627 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
24628 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
24629 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
24630 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
24631 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
24632 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
24633 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
24634 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
24635 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
24636 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
24637
24638 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
24639 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
24640 diagnostic.
24641
24642 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
24643 only the selected range of children will be reported.
24644
24645 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
24646 @samp{changelist}.
24647
24648 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
24649
24650 @table @samp
24651 @item name
24652 The name of the varobj.
24653
24654 @item value
24655 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
24656 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
24657
24658 @item in_scope
24659 @anchor{-var-update}
24660 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
24661
24662 @table @code
24663 @item "true"
24664 The variable object's current value is valid.
24665
24666 @item "false"
24667 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
24668 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
24669 scope.
24670
24671 @item "invalid"
24672 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
24673 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
24674 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
24675 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
24676 objects.
24677 @end table
24678
24679 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
24680 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
24681
24682 @item type_changed
24683 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
24684 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
24685 be @samp{false}.
24686
24687 @item new_type
24688 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
24689 hold the new type.
24690
24691 @item new_num_children
24692 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
24693 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
24694
24695 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
24696 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
24697 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
24698 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
24699 children which may be available.
24700
24701 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
24702 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
24703 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
24704 only happen at the end of the update range).
24705
24706 @item displayhint
24707 The display hint, if any.
24708
24709 @item has_more
24710 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
24711 available outside the varobj's update range.
24712
24713 @item dynamic
24714 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
24715 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
24716 then this attribute will not be present.
24717
24718 @item new_children
24719 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
24720 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
24721 be listed in this attribute.
24722 @end table
24723
24724 @subsubheading Example
24725
24726 @smallexample
24727 (gdb)
24728 -var-assign var1 3
24729 ^done,value="3"
24730 (gdb)
24731 -var-update --all-values var1
24732 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
24733 type_changed="false"@}]
24734 (gdb)
24735 @end smallexample
24736
24737 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
24738 @findex -var-set-frozen
24739 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
24740
24741 @subsubheading Synopsis
24742
24743 @smallexample
24744 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
24745 @end smallexample
24746
24747 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
24748 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
24749 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
24750 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
24751 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
24752 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
24753 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
24754 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
24755 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
24756 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
24757 @code{-var-update} does.
24758
24759 @subsubheading Example
24760
24761 @smallexample
24762 (gdb)
24763 -var-set-frozen V 1
24764 ^done
24765 (gdb)
24766 @end smallexample
24767
24768 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
24769 @findex -var-set-update-range
24770 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
24771
24772 @subsubheading Synopsis
24773
24774 @smallexample
24775 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
24776 @end smallexample
24777
24778 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
24779 @code{-var-update}.
24780
24781 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
24782 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
24783 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
24784 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
24785
24786 @subsubheading Example
24787
24788 @smallexample
24789 (gdb)
24790 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
24791 ^done
24792 @end smallexample
24793
24794 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
24795 @findex -var-set-visualizer
24796 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
24797
24798 @subsubheading Synopsis
24799
24800 @smallexample
24801 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
24802 @end smallexample
24803
24804 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
24805
24806 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
24807 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
24808
24809 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
24810 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
24811 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
24812 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
24813 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
24814 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
24815 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
24816
24817 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
24818 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
24819 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
24820 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
24821
24822 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
24823 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
24824 can be used to check this.
24825
24826 @subsubheading Example
24827
24828 Resetting the visualizer:
24829
24830 @smallexample
24831 (gdb)
24832 -var-set-visualizer V None
24833 ^done
24834 @end smallexample
24835
24836 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
24837
24838 @smallexample
24839 (gdb)
24840 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
24841 ^done
24842 @end smallexample
24843
24844 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
24845 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
24846
24847 @smallexample
24848 (gdb)
24849 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
24850 ^done
24851 @end smallexample
24852
24853 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24854 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
24855 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
24856
24857 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
24858 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
24859 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
24860 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
24861
24862 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
24863 @c @subheading -data-assign
24864 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
24865 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
24866 @c set variable
24867 @c @subsubheading Example
24868 @c N.A.
24869
24870 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
24871 @findex -data-disassemble
24872
24873 @subsubheading Synopsis
24874
24875 @smallexample
24876 -data-disassemble
24877 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
24878 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
24879 -- @var{mode}
24880 @end smallexample
24881
24882 @noindent
24883 Where:
24884
24885 @table @samp
24886 @item @var{start-addr}
24887 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
24888 @item @var{end-addr}
24889 is the end address
24890 @item @var{filename}
24891 is the name of the file to disassemble
24892 @item @var{linenum}
24893 is the line number to disassemble around
24894 @item @var{lines}
24895 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
24896 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
24897 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
24898 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
24899 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
24900 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
24901 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
24902 are displayed.
24903 @item @var{mode}
24904 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
24905 disassembly).
24906 @end table
24907
24908 @subsubheading Result
24909
24910 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
24911
24912 @itemize @bullet
24913 @item Address
24914 @item Func-name
24915 @item Offset
24916 @item Instruction
24917 @end itemize
24918
24919 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
24920 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
24921
24922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24923
24924 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
24925
24926 @subsubheading Example
24927
24928 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
24929
24930 @smallexample
24931 (gdb)
24932 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
24933 ^done,
24934 asm_insns=[
24935 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24936 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24937 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24938 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24939 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
24940 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
24941 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
24942 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24943 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
24944 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
24945 (gdb)
24946 @end smallexample
24947
24948 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
24949 @code{main}.
24950
24951 @smallexample
24952 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
24953 ^done,asm_insns=[
24954 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24955 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
24956 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24957 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24958 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24959 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24960 [@dots{}]
24961 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
24962 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
24963 (gdb)
24964 @end smallexample
24965
24966 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
24967
24968 @smallexample
24969 (gdb)
24970 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
24971 ^done,asm_insns=[
24972 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24973 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
24974 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24975 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24976 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24977 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
24978 (gdb)
24979 @end smallexample
24980
24981 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
24982
24983 @smallexample
24984 (gdb)
24985 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
24986 ^done,asm_insns=[
24987 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
24988 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
24989 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
24990 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24991 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
24992 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
24993 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
24994 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
24995 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24996 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24997 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24998 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
24999 (gdb)
25000 @end smallexample
25001
25002
25003 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
25004 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
25005
25006 @subsubheading Synopsis
25007
25008 @smallexample
25009 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
25010 @end smallexample
25011
25012 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
25013 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
25014 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
25015
25016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25017
25018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
25019 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
25020 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
25021
25022 @subsubheading Example
25023
25024 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
25025 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
25026 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
25027 output.
25028
25029 @smallexample
25030 211-data-evaluate-expression A
25031 211^done,value="1"
25032 (gdb)
25033 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
25034 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
25035 (gdb)
25036 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
25037 411^done,value="4"
25038 (gdb)
25039 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
25040 511^done,value="4"
25041 (gdb)
25042 @end smallexample
25043
25044
25045 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
25046 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
25047
25048 @subsubheading Synopsis
25049
25050 @smallexample
25051 -data-list-changed-registers
25052 @end smallexample
25053
25054 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
25055
25056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25057
25058 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
25059 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
25060
25061 @subsubheading Example
25062
25063 On a PPC MBX board:
25064
25065 @smallexample
25066 (gdb)
25067 -exec-continue
25068 ^running
25069
25070 (gdb)
25071 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
25072 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
25073 line="5"@}
25074 (gdb)
25075 -data-list-changed-registers
25076 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
25077 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
25078 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
25079 (gdb)
25080 @end smallexample
25081
25082
25083 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
25084 @findex -data-list-register-names
25085
25086 @subsubheading Synopsis
25087
25088 @smallexample
25089 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
25090 @end smallexample
25091
25092 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
25093 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
25094 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
25095 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
25096 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
25097 include empty register names.
25098
25099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25100
25101 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
25102 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
25103 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
25104
25105 @subsubheading Example
25106
25107 For the PPC MBX board:
25108 @smallexample
25109 (gdb)
25110 -data-list-register-names
25111 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
25112 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
25113 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
25114 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
25115 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
25116 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
25117 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
25118 (gdb)
25119 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
25120 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
25121 (gdb)
25122 @end smallexample
25123
25124 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
25125 @findex -data-list-register-values
25126
25127 @subsubheading Synopsis
25128
25129 @smallexample
25130 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
25131 @end smallexample
25132
25133 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
25134 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
25135 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
25136 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
25137
25138 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
25139
25140 @table @code
25141 @item x
25142 Hexadecimal
25143 @item o
25144 Octal
25145 @item t
25146 Binary
25147 @item d
25148 Decimal
25149 @item r
25150 Raw
25151 @item N
25152 Natural
25153 @end table
25154
25155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25156
25157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
25158 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
25159
25160 @subsubheading Example
25161
25162 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
25163 don't appear in the actual output):
25164
25165 @smallexample
25166 (gdb)
25167 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
25168 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
25169 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
25170 (gdb)
25171 -data-list-register-values x
25172 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
25173 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
25174 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
25175 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
25176 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
25177 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
25178 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
25179 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
25180 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
25181 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
25182 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
25183 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
25184 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
25185 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
25186 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
25187 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
25188 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
25189 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
25190 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
25191 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
25192 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
25193 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
25194 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
25195 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
25196 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
25197 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
25198 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
25199 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
25200 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
25201 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
25202 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
25203 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
25204 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
25205 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
25206 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
25207 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
25208 (gdb)
25209 @end smallexample
25210
25211
25212 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
25213 @findex -data-read-memory
25214
25215 @subsubheading Synopsis
25216
25217 @smallexample
25218 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
25219 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
25220 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
25221 @end smallexample
25222
25223 @noindent
25224 where:
25225
25226 @table @samp
25227 @item @var{address}
25228 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
25229 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
25230 quoted using the C convention.
25231
25232 @item @var{word-format}
25233 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
25234 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
25235 ,Output Formats}).
25236
25237 @item @var{word-size}
25238 The size of each memory word in bytes.
25239
25240 @item @var{nr-rows}
25241 The number of rows in the output table.
25242
25243 @item @var{nr-cols}
25244 The number of columns in the output table.
25245
25246 @item @var{aschar}
25247 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
25248 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
25249 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
25250 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
25251
25252 @item @var{byte-offset}
25253 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
25254 @end table
25255
25256 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
25257 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
25258 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
25259 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
25260 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
25261 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
25262 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
25263 @samp{addr}.
25264
25265 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
25266 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
25267 @samp{prev-page}.
25268
25269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25270
25271 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
25272 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
25273
25274 @subsubheading Example
25275
25276 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
25277 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
25278 word. Display each word in hex.
25279
25280 @smallexample
25281 (gdb)
25282 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
25283 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
25284 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
25285 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
25286 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
25287 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
25288 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
25289 (gdb)
25290 @end smallexample
25291
25292 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
25293 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
25294
25295 @smallexample
25296 (gdb)
25297 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
25298 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
25299 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
25300 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
25301 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
25302 (gdb)
25303 @end smallexample
25304
25305 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
25306 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
25307 used as the non-printable character.
25308
25309 @smallexample
25310 (gdb)
25311 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
25312 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
25313 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
25314 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
25315 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25316 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25317 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25318 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25319 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
25320 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
25321 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
25322 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
25323 (gdb)
25324 @end smallexample
25325
25326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25327 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
25328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
25329
25330 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
25331
25332 @c @subheading -trace-actions
25333
25334 @c @subheading -trace-delete
25335
25336 @c @subheading -trace-disable
25337
25338 @c @subheading -trace-dump
25339
25340 @c @subheading -trace-enable
25341
25342 @c @subheading -trace-exists
25343
25344 @c @subheading -trace-find
25345
25346 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
25347
25348 @c @subheading -trace-info
25349
25350 @c @subheading -trace-insert
25351
25352 @c @subheading -trace-list
25353
25354 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
25355
25356 @c @subheading -trace-save
25357
25358 @c @subheading -trace-start
25359
25360 @c @subheading -trace-stop
25361
25362
25363 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25364 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
25365 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
25366
25367
25368 @ignore
25369 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
25370 @findex -symbol-info-address
25371
25372 @subsubheading Synopsis
25373
25374 @smallexample
25375 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
25376 @end smallexample
25377
25378 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
25379
25380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25381
25382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
25383
25384 @subsubheading Example
25385 N.A.
25386
25387
25388 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
25389 @findex -symbol-info-file
25390
25391 @subsubheading Synopsis
25392
25393 @smallexample
25394 -symbol-info-file
25395 @end smallexample
25396
25397 Show the file for the symbol.
25398
25399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25400
25401 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
25402 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
25403
25404 @subsubheading Example
25405 N.A.
25406
25407
25408 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
25409 @findex -symbol-info-function
25410
25411 @subsubheading Synopsis
25412
25413 @smallexample
25414 -symbol-info-function
25415 @end smallexample
25416
25417 Show which function the symbol lives in.
25418
25419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25420
25421 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
25422
25423 @subsubheading Example
25424 N.A.
25425
25426
25427 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
25428 @findex -symbol-info-line
25429
25430 @subsubheading Synopsis
25431
25432 @smallexample
25433 -symbol-info-line
25434 @end smallexample
25435
25436 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
25437
25438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25439
25440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
25441 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
25442
25443 @subsubheading Example
25444 N.A.
25445
25446
25447 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
25448 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
25449
25450 @subsubheading Synopsis
25451
25452 @smallexample
25453 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
25454 @end smallexample
25455
25456 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
25457
25458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25459
25460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
25461
25462 @subsubheading Example
25463 N.A.
25464
25465
25466 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
25467 @findex -symbol-list-functions
25468
25469 @subsubheading Synopsis
25470
25471 @smallexample
25472 -symbol-list-functions
25473 @end smallexample
25474
25475 List the functions in the executable.
25476
25477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25478
25479 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
25480 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25481
25482 @subsubheading Example
25483 N.A.
25484 @end ignore
25485
25486
25487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
25488 @findex -symbol-list-lines
25489
25490 @subsubheading Synopsis
25491
25492 @smallexample
25493 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
25494 @end smallexample
25495
25496 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
25497 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
25498 ascending PC order.
25499
25500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25501
25502 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
25503
25504 @subsubheading Example
25505 @smallexample
25506 (gdb)
25507 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
25508 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
25509 (gdb)
25510 @end smallexample
25511
25512
25513 @ignore
25514 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
25515 @findex -symbol-list-types
25516
25517 @subsubheading Synopsis
25518
25519 @smallexample
25520 -symbol-list-types
25521 @end smallexample
25522
25523 List all the type names.
25524
25525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25526
25527 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
25528 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25529
25530 @subsubheading Example
25531 N.A.
25532
25533
25534 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
25535 @findex -symbol-list-variables
25536
25537 @subsubheading Synopsis
25538
25539 @smallexample
25540 -symbol-list-variables
25541 @end smallexample
25542
25543 List all the global and static variable names.
25544
25545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25546
25547 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25548
25549 @subsubheading Example
25550 N.A.
25551
25552
25553 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
25554 @findex -symbol-locate
25555
25556 @subsubheading Synopsis
25557
25558 @smallexample
25559 -symbol-locate
25560 @end smallexample
25561
25562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25563
25564 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
25565
25566 @subsubheading Example
25567 N.A.
25568
25569
25570 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
25571 @findex -symbol-type
25572
25573 @subsubheading Synopsis
25574
25575 @smallexample
25576 -symbol-type @var{variable}
25577 @end smallexample
25578
25579 Show type of @var{variable}.
25580
25581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25582
25583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
25584 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
25585
25586 @subsubheading Example
25587 N.A.
25588 @end ignore
25589
25590
25591 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25592 @node GDB/MI File Commands
25593 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
25594
25595 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
25596 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
25597
25598 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
25599 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
25600
25601 @subsubheading Synopsis
25602
25603 @smallexample
25604 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
25605 @end smallexample
25606
25607 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
25608 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
25609 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
25610 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
25611 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
25612 notification.
25613
25614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25615
25616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
25617
25618 @subsubheading Example
25619
25620 @smallexample
25621 (gdb)
25622 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25623 ^done
25624 (gdb)
25625 @end smallexample
25626
25627
25628 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
25629 @findex -file-exec-file
25630
25631 @subsubheading Synopsis
25632
25633 @smallexample
25634 -file-exec-file @var{file}
25635 @end smallexample
25636
25637 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
25638 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
25639 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
25640 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
25641 notification.
25642
25643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25644
25645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
25646
25647 @subsubheading Example
25648
25649 @smallexample
25650 (gdb)
25651 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25652 ^done
25653 (gdb)
25654 @end smallexample
25655
25656
25657 @ignore
25658 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
25659 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
25660
25661 @subsubheading Synopsis
25662
25663 @smallexample
25664 -file-list-exec-sections
25665 @end smallexample
25666
25667 List the sections of the current executable file.
25668
25669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25670
25671 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
25672 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
25673 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
25674
25675 @subsubheading Example
25676 N.A.
25677 @end ignore
25678
25679
25680 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
25681 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
25682
25683 @subsubheading Synopsis
25684
25685 @smallexample
25686 -file-list-exec-source-file
25687 @end smallexample
25688
25689 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
25690 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
25691 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
25692 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
25693
25694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25695
25696 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
25697
25698 @subsubheading Example
25699
25700 @smallexample
25701 (gdb)
25702 123-file-list-exec-source-file
25703 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
25704 (gdb)
25705 @end smallexample
25706
25707
25708 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
25709 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
25710
25711 @subsubheading Synopsis
25712
25713 @smallexample
25714 -file-list-exec-source-files
25715 @end smallexample
25716
25717 List the source files for the current executable.
25718
25719 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
25720 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
25721
25722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25723
25724 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
25725 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
25726
25727 @subsubheading Example
25728 @smallexample
25729 (gdb)
25730 -file-list-exec-source-files
25731 ^done,files=[
25732 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
25733 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
25734 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
25735 (gdb)
25736 @end smallexample
25737
25738 @ignore
25739 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
25740 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
25741
25742 @subsubheading Synopsis
25743
25744 @smallexample
25745 -file-list-shared-libraries
25746 @end smallexample
25747
25748 List the shared libraries in the program.
25749
25750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25751
25752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
25753
25754 @subsubheading Example
25755 N.A.
25756
25757
25758 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
25759 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
25760
25761 @subsubheading Synopsis
25762
25763 @smallexample
25764 -file-list-symbol-files
25765 @end smallexample
25766
25767 List symbol files.
25768
25769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25770
25771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
25772
25773 @subsubheading Example
25774 N.A.
25775 @end ignore
25776
25777
25778 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
25779 @findex -file-symbol-file
25780
25781 @subsubheading Synopsis
25782
25783 @smallexample
25784 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
25785 @end smallexample
25786
25787 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
25788 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
25789 produced, except for a completion notification.
25790
25791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25792
25793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
25794
25795 @subsubheading Example
25796
25797 @smallexample
25798 (gdb)
25799 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25800 ^done
25801 (gdb)
25802 @end smallexample
25803
25804 @ignore
25805 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25806 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
25807 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
25808
25809 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
25810
25811 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
25812
25813 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
25814
25815 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
25816
25817 @c @subheading -overlay-map
25818
25819 @c @subheading -overlay-off
25820
25821 @c @subheading -overlay-on
25822
25823 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
25824
25825 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25826 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
25827 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
25828
25829 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
25830
25831 @c @subheading -signal-handle
25832
25833 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
25834
25835 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
25836 @end ignore
25837
25838
25839 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25840 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
25841 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
25842
25843
25844 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
25845 @findex -target-attach
25846
25847 @subsubheading Synopsis
25848
25849 @smallexample
25850 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
25851 @end smallexample
25852
25853 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
25854 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
25855 group, the id previously returned by
25856 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
25857
25858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25859
25860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
25861
25862 @subsubheading Example
25863 @smallexample
25864 (gdb)
25865 -target-attach 34
25866 =thread-created,id="1"
25867 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
25868 ^done
25869 (gdb)
25870 @end smallexample
25871
25872 @ignore
25873 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
25874 @findex -target-compare-sections
25875
25876 @subsubheading Synopsis
25877
25878 @smallexample
25879 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
25880 @end smallexample
25881
25882 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
25883 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
25884
25885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25886
25887 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
25888
25889 @subsubheading Example
25890 N.A.
25891 @end ignore
25892
25893
25894 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
25895 @findex -target-detach
25896
25897 @subsubheading Synopsis
25898
25899 @smallexample
25900 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
25901 @end smallexample
25902
25903 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
25904 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
25905 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
25906
25907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25908
25909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
25910
25911 @subsubheading Example
25912
25913 @smallexample
25914 (gdb)
25915 -target-detach
25916 ^done
25917 (gdb)
25918 @end smallexample
25919
25920
25921 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
25922 @findex -target-disconnect
25923
25924 @subsubheading Synopsis
25925
25926 @smallexample
25927 -target-disconnect
25928 @end smallexample
25929
25930 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
25931 generally not resumed.
25932
25933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25934
25935 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
25936
25937 @subsubheading Example
25938
25939 @smallexample
25940 (gdb)
25941 -target-disconnect
25942 ^done
25943 (gdb)
25944 @end smallexample
25945
25946
25947 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
25948 @findex -target-download
25949
25950 @subsubheading Synopsis
25951
25952 @smallexample
25953 -target-download
25954 @end smallexample
25955
25956 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
25957 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
25958
25959 @table @samp
25960 @item section
25961 The name of the section.
25962 @item section-sent
25963 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
25964 @item section-size
25965 The size of the section.
25966 @item total-sent
25967 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
25968 @item total-size
25969 The size of the overall executable to download.
25970 @end table
25971
25972 @noindent
25973 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
25974 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
25975
25976 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
25977 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
25978
25979 @table @samp
25980 @item section
25981 The name of the section.
25982 @item section-size
25983 The size of the section.
25984 @item total-size
25985 The size of the overall executable to download.
25986 @end table
25987
25988 @noindent
25989 At the end, a summary is printed.
25990
25991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25992
25993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
25994
25995 @subsubheading Example
25996
25997 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
25998 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
25999
26000 @smallexample
26001 (gdb)
26002 -target-download
26003 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
26004 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
26005 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
26006 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
26007 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
26008 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
26009 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
26010 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
26011 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
26012 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
26013 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
26014 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
26015 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
26016 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
26017 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
26018 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
26019 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
26020 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
26021 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
26022 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
26023 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
26024 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
26025 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
26026 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
26027 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
26028 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
26029 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
26030 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
26031 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
26032 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
26033 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
26034 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
26035 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
26036 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
26037 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
26038 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
26039 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
26040 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
26041 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
26042 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
26043 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
26044 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
26045 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
26046 write-rate="429"
26047 (gdb)
26048 @end smallexample
26049
26050
26051 @ignore
26052 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
26053 @findex -target-exec-status
26054
26055 @subsubheading Synopsis
26056
26057 @smallexample
26058 -target-exec-status
26059 @end smallexample
26060
26061 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
26062 not, for instance).
26063
26064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26065
26066 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26067
26068 @subsubheading Example
26069 N.A.
26070
26071
26072 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
26073 @findex -target-list-available-targets
26074
26075 @subsubheading Synopsis
26076
26077 @smallexample
26078 -target-list-available-targets
26079 @end smallexample
26080
26081 List the possible targets to connect to.
26082
26083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26084
26085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
26086
26087 @subsubheading Example
26088 N.A.
26089
26090
26091 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
26092 @findex -target-list-current-targets
26093
26094 @subsubheading Synopsis
26095
26096 @smallexample
26097 -target-list-current-targets
26098 @end smallexample
26099
26100 Describe the current target.
26101
26102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26103
26104 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
26105 other things).
26106
26107 @subsubheading Example
26108 N.A.
26109
26110
26111 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
26112 @findex -target-list-parameters
26113
26114 @subsubheading Synopsis
26115
26116 @smallexample
26117 -target-list-parameters
26118 @end smallexample
26119
26120 @c ????
26121 @end ignore
26122
26123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26124
26125 No equivalent.
26126
26127 @subsubheading Example
26128 N.A.
26129
26130
26131 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
26132 @findex -target-select
26133
26134 @subsubheading Synopsis
26135
26136 @smallexample
26137 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
26138 @end smallexample
26139
26140 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
26141
26142 @table @samp
26143 @item @var{type}
26144 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
26145 @item @var{parameters}
26146 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
26147 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
26148 @end table
26149
26150 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
26151 which the target program is, in the following form:
26152
26153 @smallexample
26154 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
26155 args=[@var{arg list}]
26156 @end smallexample
26157
26158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26159
26160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
26161
26162 @subsubheading Example
26163
26164 @smallexample
26165 (gdb)
26166 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
26167 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
26168 (gdb)
26169 @end smallexample
26170
26171 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26172 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
26173 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
26174
26175
26176 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
26177 @findex -target-file-put
26178
26179 @subsubheading Synopsis
26180
26181 @smallexample
26182 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
26183 @end smallexample
26184
26185 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
26186 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
26187
26188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26189
26190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
26191
26192 @subsubheading Example
26193
26194 @smallexample
26195 (gdb)
26196 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
26197 ^done
26198 (gdb)
26199 @end smallexample
26200
26201
26202 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
26203 @findex -target-file-get
26204
26205 @subsubheading Synopsis
26206
26207 @smallexample
26208 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
26209 @end smallexample
26210
26211 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
26212 on the host system.
26213
26214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26215
26216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
26217
26218 @subsubheading Example
26219
26220 @smallexample
26221 (gdb)
26222 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
26223 ^done
26224 (gdb)
26225 @end smallexample
26226
26227
26228 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
26229 @findex -target-file-delete
26230
26231 @subsubheading Synopsis
26232
26233 @smallexample
26234 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
26235 @end smallexample
26236
26237 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
26238
26239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26240
26241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
26242
26243 @subsubheading Example
26244
26245 @smallexample
26246 (gdb)
26247 -target-file-delete remotefile
26248 ^done
26249 (gdb)
26250 @end smallexample
26251
26252
26253 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26254 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
26255 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
26256
26257 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
26258
26259 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
26260 @findex -gdb-exit
26261
26262 @subsubheading Synopsis
26263
26264 @smallexample
26265 -gdb-exit
26266 @end smallexample
26267
26268 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
26269
26270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26271
26272 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
26273
26274 @subsubheading Example
26275
26276 @smallexample
26277 (gdb)
26278 -gdb-exit
26279 ^exit
26280 @end smallexample
26281
26282
26283 @ignore
26284 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
26285 @findex -exec-abort
26286
26287 @subsubheading Synopsis
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 -exec-abort
26291 @end smallexample
26292
26293 Kill the inferior running program.
26294
26295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26296
26297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
26298
26299 @subsubheading Example
26300 N.A.
26301 @end ignore
26302
26303
26304 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
26305 @findex -gdb-set
26306
26307 @subsubheading Synopsis
26308
26309 @smallexample
26310 -gdb-set
26311 @end smallexample
26312
26313 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
26314 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
26315
26316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26317
26318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
26319
26320 @subsubheading Example
26321
26322 @smallexample
26323 (gdb)
26324 -gdb-set $foo=3
26325 ^done
26326 (gdb)
26327 @end smallexample
26328
26329
26330 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
26331 @findex -gdb-show
26332
26333 @subsubheading Synopsis
26334
26335 @smallexample
26336 -gdb-show
26337 @end smallexample
26338
26339 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
26340
26341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26342
26343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
26344
26345 @subsubheading Example
26346
26347 @smallexample
26348 (gdb)
26349 -gdb-show annotate
26350 ^done,value="0"
26351 (gdb)
26352 @end smallexample
26353
26354 @c @subheading -gdb-source
26355
26356
26357 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
26358 @findex -gdb-version
26359
26360 @subsubheading Synopsis
26361
26362 @smallexample
26363 -gdb-version
26364 @end smallexample
26365
26366 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
26367
26368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26369
26370 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
26371 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
26372
26373 @subsubheading Example
26374
26375 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
26376 @c box in TeX.
26377 @smallexample
26378 (gdb)
26379 -gdb-version
26380 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
26381 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
26382 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
26383 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
26384 ~ certain conditions.
26385 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
26386 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
26387 ~ details.
26388 ~This GDB was configured as
26389 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
26390 ^done
26391 (gdb)
26392 @end smallexample
26393
26394 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
26395 @findex -list-features
26396
26397 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
26398 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
26399 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
26400 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
26401 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
26402 startup.
26403
26404 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
26405 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
26406 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
26407 is given below.
26408
26409 Example output:
26410
26411 @smallexample
26412 (gdb) -list-features
26413 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
26414 @end smallexample
26415
26416 The current list of features is:
26417
26418 @table @samp
26419 @item frozen-varobjs
26420 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
26421 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
26422 of @code{-varobj-create}.
26423 @item pending-breakpoints
26424 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
26425 @item python
26426 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
26427 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
26428 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
26429 @item thread-info
26430 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
26431
26432 @end table
26433
26434 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
26435 @findex -list-target-features
26436
26437 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
26438 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
26439 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
26440 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
26441 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
26442 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
26443 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
26444 Example output:
26445
26446 @smallexample
26447 (gdb) -list-features
26448 ^done,result=["async"]
26449 @end smallexample
26450
26451 The current list of features is:
26452
26453 @table @samp
26454 @item async
26455 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
26456 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
26457 while the target is running.
26458
26459 @end table
26460
26461 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
26462 @findex -list-thread-groups
26463
26464 @subheading Synopsis
26465
26466 @smallexample
26467 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
26468 @end smallexample
26469
26470 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
26471 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
26472 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
26473 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
26474 top-level thread groups.
26475
26476 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
26477 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
26478 available on the target.
26479
26480 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
26481 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
26482 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
26483 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
26484 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
26485 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
26486 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
26487 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
26488
26489 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
26490 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
26491 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
26492 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
26493 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
26494 @samp{threads} field.
26495
26496 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
26497 the following caveats:
26498
26499 @itemize @bullet
26500 @item
26501 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
26502 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
26503 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
26504
26505 @item
26506 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
26507 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
26508 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
26509 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
26510 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
26511 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
26512
26513 @end itemize
26514
26515 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
26516 have the following fields:
26517
26518 @table @code
26519 @item id
26520 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
26521
26522 @item type
26523 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
26524 valid type.
26525
26526 @item pid
26527 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
26528 for thread groups of type @samp{process}.
26529
26530 @item num_children
26531 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
26532 absent for an available thread group.
26533
26534 @item threads
26535 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
26536 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
26537 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
26538
26539 @item cores
26540 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
26541 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
26542 such information is not available.
26543
26544 @end table
26545
26546 @subheading Example
26547
26548 @smallexample
26549 @value{GDBP}
26550 -list-thread-groups
26551 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
26552 -list-thread-groups 17
26553 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26554 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
26555 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26556 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26557 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
26558 -list-thread-groups --available
26559 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
26560 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
26561 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
26562 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
26563 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
26564 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
26565 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
26566 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
26567 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
26568 @end smallexample
26569
26570 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
26571 @findex -interpreter-exec
26572
26573 @subheading Synopsis
26574
26575 @smallexample
26576 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
26577 @end smallexample
26578 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
26579
26580 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
26581
26582 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26583
26584 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
26585
26586 @subheading Example
26587
26588 @smallexample
26589 (gdb)
26590 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
26591 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
26592 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
26593 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
26594 ^done
26595 (gdb)
26596 @end smallexample
26597
26598 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
26599 @findex -inferior-tty-set
26600
26601 @subheading Synopsis
26602
26603 @smallexample
26604 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26605 @end smallexample
26606
26607 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
26608
26609 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26610
26611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
26612
26613 @subheading Example
26614
26615 @smallexample
26616 (gdb)
26617 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26618 ^done
26619 (gdb)
26620 @end smallexample
26621
26622 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
26623 @findex -inferior-tty-show
26624
26625 @subheading Synopsis
26626
26627 @smallexample
26628 -inferior-tty-show
26629 @end smallexample
26630
26631 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
26632
26633 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26634
26635 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
26636
26637 @subheading Example
26638
26639 @smallexample
26640 (gdb)
26641 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26642 ^done
26643 (gdb)
26644 -inferior-tty-show
26645 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
26646 (gdb)
26647 @end smallexample
26648
26649 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
26650 @findex -enable-timings
26651
26652 @subheading Synopsis
26653
26654 @smallexample
26655 -enable-timings [yes | no]
26656 @end smallexample
26657
26658 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
26659 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
26660 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
26661 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
26662
26663 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26664
26665 No equivalent.
26666
26667 @subheading Example
26668
26669 @smallexample
26670 (gdb)
26671 -enable-timings
26672 ^done
26673 (gdb)
26674 -break-insert main
26675 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26676 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26677 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
26678 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
26679 (gdb)
26680 -enable-timings no
26681 ^done
26682 (gdb)
26683 -exec-run
26684 ^running
26685 (gdb)
26686 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26687 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
26688 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
26689 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
26690 (gdb)
26691 @end smallexample
26692
26693 @node Annotations
26694 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
26695
26696 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
26697 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
26698 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
26699 relatively high level.
26700
26701 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
26702 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
26703
26704 @ignore
26705 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
26706 @end ignore
26707
26708 @menu
26709 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
26710 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
26711 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
26712 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
26713 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
26714 * Annotations for Running::
26715 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
26716 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
26717 @end menu
26718
26719 @node Annotations Overview
26720 @section What is an Annotation?
26721 @cindex annotations
26722
26723 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
26724 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
26725 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
26726 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
26727 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
26728 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
26729 cannot contain newline characters.
26730
26731 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
26732 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
26733 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
26734 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
26735 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
26736 means those three characters as output.
26737
26738 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
26739 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
26740 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
26741 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
26742 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
26743 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
26744 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
26745 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
26746 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
26747
26748 @table @code
26749 @kindex set annotate
26750 @item set annotate @var{level}
26751 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
26752 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
26753
26754 @item show annotate
26755 @kindex show annotate
26756 Show the current annotation level.
26757 @end table
26758
26759 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
26760
26761 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
26762
26763 @smallexample
26764 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
26765 GNU gdb 6.0
26766 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
26767 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
26768 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
26769 under certain conditions.
26770 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
26771 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
26772 for details.
26773 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
26774
26775 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
26776 (@value{GDBP})
26777 ^Z^Zprompt
26778 @kbd{quit}
26779
26780 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
26781 $
26782 @end smallexample
26783
26784 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
26785 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
26786 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
26787 output from @value{GDBN}.
26788
26789 @node Server Prefix
26790 @section The Server Prefix
26791 @cindex server prefix
26792
26793 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
26794 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
26795 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
26796 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
26797 a transparent manner.
26798
26799 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
26800 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
26801 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
26802 @code{print} command.
26803
26804 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
26805 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
26806
26807 @node Prompting
26808 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
26809
26810 @cindex annotations for prompts
26811 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
26812 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
26813 over, etc.
26814
26815 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
26816 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
26817 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
26818 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
26819 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
26820 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
26821 features the following annotations:
26822
26823 @smallexample
26824 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
26825 ^Z^Zprompt
26826 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
26827 @end smallexample
26828
26829 The input types are
26830
26831 @table @code
26832 @findex pre-prompt annotation
26833 @findex prompt annotation
26834 @findex post-prompt annotation
26835 @item prompt
26836 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
26837
26838 @findex pre-commands annotation
26839 @findex commands annotation
26840 @findex post-commands annotation
26841 @item commands
26842 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
26843 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
26844
26845 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
26846 @findex overload-choice annotation
26847 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
26848 @item overload-choice
26849 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
26850
26851 @findex pre-query annotation
26852 @findex query annotation
26853 @findex post-query annotation
26854 @item query
26855 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
26856
26857 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
26858 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
26859 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
26860 @item prompt-for-continue
26861 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
26862 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
26863 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
26864 presence of annotations.
26865 @end table
26866
26867 @node Errors
26868 @section Errors
26869 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
26870
26871 @findex quit annotation
26872 @smallexample
26873 ^Z^Zquit
26874 @end smallexample
26875
26876 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
26877
26878 @findex error annotation
26879 @smallexample
26880 ^Z^Zerror
26881 @end smallexample
26882
26883 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
26884
26885 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
26886 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
26887 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
26888 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
26889 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
26890 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
26891 to the top level.
26892
26893 @findex error-begin annotation
26894 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
26895
26896 @smallexample
26897 ^Z^Zerror-begin
26898 @end smallexample
26899
26900 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
26901 message.
26902
26903 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
26904 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
26905 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
26906
26907 @node Invalidation
26908 @section Invalidation Notices
26909
26910 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
26911 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
26912 changed.
26913
26914 @table @code
26915 @findex frames-invalid annotation
26916 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
26917
26918 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
26919 have changed.
26920
26921 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
26922 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
26923
26924 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
26925 deleted a breakpoint.
26926 @end table
26927
26928 @node Annotations for Running
26929 @section Running the Program
26930 @cindex annotations for running programs
26931
26932 @findex starting annotation
26933 @findex stopping annotation
26934 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
26935 @code{step} or @code{continue},
26936
26937 @smallexample
26938 ^Z^Zstarting
26939 @end smallexample
26940
26941 is output. When the program stops,
26942
26943 @smallexample
26944 ^Z^Zstopped
26945 @end smallexample
26946
26947 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
26948 annotations describe how the program stopped.
26949
26950 @table @code
26951 @findex exited annotation
26952 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
26953 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
26954 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
26955
26956 @findex signalled annotation
26957 @findex signal-name annotation
26958 @findex signal-name-end annotation
26959 @findex signal-string annotation
26960 @findex signal-string-end annotation
26961 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
26962 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
26963 annotation continues:
26964
26965 @smallexample
26966 @var{intro-text}
26967 ^Z^Zsignal-name
26968 @var{name}
26969 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
26970 @var{middle-text}
26971 ^Z^Zsignal-string
26972 @var{string}
26973 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
26974 @var{end-text}
26975 @end smallexample
26976
26977 @noindent
26978 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
26979 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
26980 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
26981 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
26982 user's benefit and have no particular format.
26983
26984 @findex signal annotation
26985 @item ^Z^Zsignal
26986 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
26987 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
26988 terminated with it.
26989
26990 @findex breakpoint annotation
26991 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
26992 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
26993
26994 @findex watchpoint annotation
26995 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
26996 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
26997 @end table
26998
26999 @node Source Annotations
27000 @section Displaying Source
27001 @cindex annotations for source display
27002
27003 @findex source annotation
27004 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
27005
27006 @smallexample
27007 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
27008 @end smallexample
27009
27010 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
27011 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
27012 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
27013 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
27014 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
27015 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
27016 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
27017 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
27018 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
27019 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
27020 depend on the language).
27021
27022 @node JIT Interface
27023 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
27024 @cindex just-in-time compilation
27025 @cindex JIT compilation interface
27026
27027 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
27028 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
27029 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
27030 performance while maintaining platform independence.
27031
27032 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
27033 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
27034 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
27035 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
27036 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
27037 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
27038
27039 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
27040 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
27041 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
27042 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
27043 LLVM JIT.
27044
27045 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
27046 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
27047 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
27048 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
27049 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
27050 out about additional code.
27051
27052 @menu
27053 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
27054 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
27055 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
27056 @end menu
27057
27058 @node Declarations
27059 @section JIT Declarations
27060
27061 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
27062 implement the interface:
27063
27064 @smallexample
27065 typedef enum
27066 @{
27067 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
27068 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
27069 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
27070 @} jit_actions_t;
27071
27072 struct jit_code_entry
27073 @{
27074 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
27075 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
27076 const char *symfile_addr;
27077 uint64_t symfile_size;
27078 @};
27079
27080 struct jit_descriptor
27081 @{
27082 uint32_t version;
27083 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
27084 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
27085 uint32_t action_flag;
27086 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
27087 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
27088 @};
27089
27090 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
27091 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
27092
27093 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
27094 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
27095 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
27096 @end smallexample
27097
27098 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
27099 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
27100 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
27101
27102 @node Registering Code
27103 @section Registering Code
27104
27105 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
27106
27107 @itemize @bullet
27108 @item
27109 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
27110 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
27111
27112 @item
27113 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
27114 file.
27115
27116 @item
27117 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
27118
27119 @item
27120 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
27121
27122 @item
27123 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
27124 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
27125 @end itemize
27126
27127 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
27128 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
27129 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
27130 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
27131
27132 @node Unregistering Code
27133 @section Unregistering Code
27134
27135 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
27136
27137 @itemize @bullet
27138 @item
27139 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
27140
27141 @item
27142 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
27143
27144 @item
27145 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
27146 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
27147 @end itemize
27148
27149 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
27150 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
27151
27152 @node GDB Bugs
27153 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
27154 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
27155 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
27156
27157 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
27158
27159 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
27160 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
27161 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
27162 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
27163
27164 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
27165 information that enables us to fix the bug.
27166
27167 @menu
27168 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
27169 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
27170 @end menu
27171
27172 @node Bug Criteria
27173 @section Have You Found a Bug?
27174 @cindex bug criteria
27175
27176 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
27177
27178 @itemize @bullet
27179 @cindex fatal signal
27180 @cindex debugger crash
27181 @cindex crash of debugger
27182 @item
27183 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
27184 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
27185
27186 @cindex error on valid input
27187 @item
27188 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
27189 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
27190 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
27191
27192 @cindex invalid input
27193 @item
27194 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
27195 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
27196 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
27197 for traditional practice''.
27198
27199 @item
27200 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
27201 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
27202 @end itemize
27203
27204 @node Bug Reporting
27205 @section How to Report Bugs
27206 @cindex bug reports
27207 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
27208
27209 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
27210 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
27211 contact that organization first.
27212
27213 You can find contact information for many support companies and
27214 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
27215 distribution.
27216 @c should add a web page ref...
27217
27218 @ifset BUGURL
27219 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
27220 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
27221 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
27222 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
27223 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
27224 be used.
27225
27226 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
27227 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
27228 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
27229 @samp{bug-gdb}.
27230
27231 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
27232 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
27233 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
27234 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
27235 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
27236 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
27237 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
27238 bug reports to the mailing list.
27239 @end ifset
27240 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
27241 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
27242 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
27243 @end ifclear
27244 @end ifset
27245
27246 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
27247 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
27248 fact or leave it out, state it!
27249
27250 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
27251 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
27252 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
27253 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
27254 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
27255 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
27256 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
27257 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
27258 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
27259
27260 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
27261 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
27262 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
27263 self-contained.
27264
27265 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
27266 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
27267 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
27268 bugs properly.
27269
27270 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
27271
27272 @itemize @bullet
27273 @item
27274 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
27275 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
27276 version}.
27277
27278 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
27279 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
27280
27281 @item
27282 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
27283 version number.
27284
27285 @item
27286 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
27287 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
27288
27289 @item
27290 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
27291 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
27292 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
27293 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
27294 those compilers.
27295
27296 @item
27297 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
27298 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
27299 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
27300 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
27301
27302 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
27303 and then we might not encounter the bug.
27304
27305 @item
27306 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
27307 reproduce the bug.
27308
27309 @item
27310 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
27311 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
27312
27313 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
27314 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
27315 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
27316 a chance to make a mistake.
27317
27318 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
27319 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
27320 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
27321 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
27322 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
27323 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
27324 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
27325 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
27326
27327 @pindex script
27328 @cindex recording a session script
27329 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
27330 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
27331 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
27332 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
27333
27334 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
27335 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
27336
27337 @item
27338 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
27339 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
27340 it by context, not by line number.
27341
27342 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
27343 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
27344
27345 @end itemize
27346
27347 Here are some things that are not necessary:
27348
27349 @itemize @bullet
27350 @item
27351 A description of the envelope of the bug.
27352
27353 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
27354 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
27355 changes will not affect it.
27356
27357 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
27358 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
27359 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
27360 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
27361
27362 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
27363 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
27364 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
27365 less time, and so on.
27366
27367 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
27368 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
27369
27370 @item
27371 A patch for the bug.
27372
27373 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
27374 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
27375 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
27376 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
27377
27378 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
27379 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
27380 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
27381 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
27382
27383 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
27384 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
27385 help us to understand.
27386
27387 @item
27388 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
27389
27390 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
27391 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
27392 @end itemize
27393
27394 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
27395 @c and consists of the two following files:
27396 @c rluser.texinfo
27397 @c inc-hist.texinfo
27398 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
27399 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
27400 @include rluser.texi
27401 @include inc-hist.texinfo
27402
27403
27404 @node Formatting Documentation
27405 @appendix Formatting Documentation
27406
27407 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
27408 @cindex reference card
27409 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
27410 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
27411 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
27412 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
27413 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
27414 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
27415
27416 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
27417 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
27418
27419 @smallexample
27420 make refcard.dvi
27421 @end smallexample
27422
27423 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
27424 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
27425 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
27426 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
27427 your @sc{dvi} output program.
27428
27429 @cindex documentation
27430
27431 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
27432 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
27433 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
27434 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
27435 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
27436 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
27437
27438 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
27439 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
27440 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
27441 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
27442 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
27443 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
27444 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
27445 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
27446
27447 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
27448 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
27449 @code{makeinfo}.
27450
27451 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
27452 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
27453 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
27454
27455 @smallexample
27456 cd gdb
27457 make gdb.info
27458 @end smallexample
27459
27460 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
27461 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
27462 Texinfo definitions file.
27463
27464 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
27465 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
27466 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
27467 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
27468 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
27469 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
27470 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
27471
27472 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
27473 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
27474 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
27475 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
27476 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
27477 directory.
27478
27479 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
27480 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
27481 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
27482 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
27483
27484 @smallexample
27485 make gdb.dvi
27486 @end smallexample
27487
27488 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
27489
27490 @node Installing GDB
27491 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
27492 @cindex installation
27493
27494 @menu
27495 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
27496 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
27497 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
27498 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
27499 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
27500 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
27501 @end menu
27502
27503 @node Requirements
27504 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
27505 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
27506
27507 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
27508 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
27509
27510 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
27511 @table @asis
27512 @item ISO C90 compiler
27513 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
27514 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
27515
27516 @end table
27517
27518 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
27519 @table @asis
27520 @item Expat
27521 @anchor{Expat}
27522 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
27523 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
27524 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
27525 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
27526 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
27527 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
27528
27529 Expat is used for:
27530
27531 @itemize @bullet
27532 @item
27533 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
27534 @item
27535 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
27536 @item
27537 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
27538 @item
27539 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
27540 @end itemize
27541
27542 @item zlib
27543 @cindex compressed debug sections
27544 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
27545 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
27546 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
27547 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
27548 information in such binaries.
27549
27550 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
27551 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
27552 @url{http://zlib.net}.
27553
27554 @item iconv
27555 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
27556 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
27557 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
27558 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
27559
27560 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
27561 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
27562 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
27563
27564 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
27565 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
27566 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
27567 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
27568 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
27569 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
27570 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
27571 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
27572 @end table
27573
27574 @node Running Configure
27575 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
27576 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
27577 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
27578 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
27579 build the @code{gdb} program.
27580 @iftex
27581 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
27582 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
27583 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
27584 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
27585 @end iftex
27586
27587 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
27588 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
27589 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
27590
27591 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
27592 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
27593
27594 @table @code
27595 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
27596 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
27597
27598 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
27599 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
27600
27601 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
27602 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
27603
27604 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
27605 @sc{gnu} include files
27606
27607 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
27608 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
27609
27610 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
27611 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
27612
27613 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
27614 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
27615
27616 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
27617 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
27618
27619 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
27620 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
27621 @end table
27622
27623 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
27624 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
27625 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
27626
27627 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
27628 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
27629 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
27630 argument.
27631
27632 For example:
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
27636 ./configure @var{host}
27637 make
27638 @end smallexample
27639
27640 @noindent
27641 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
27642 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
27643 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
27644 correct value by examining your system.)
27645
27646 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
27647 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
27648 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
27649 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
27650
27651 @need 750
27652 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
27653 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
27654 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
27655
27656 @smallexample
27657 sh configure @var{host}
27658 @end smallexample
27659
27660 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
27661 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
27662 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
27663 @file{configure}
27664 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
27665 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
27666
27667 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
27668 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
27669 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
27670 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
27671 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
27672 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
27673 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
27674 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
27675 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
27676
27677 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
27678 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
27679 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
27680 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
27681 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
27682
27683 @node Separate Objdir
27684 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
27685
27686 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
27687 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
27688 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
27689 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
27690 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
27691 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
27692 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
27693 program specified there.
27694
27695 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
27696 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
27697 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
27698 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
27699 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
27700 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
27701
27702 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
27703 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
27704
27705 @smallexample
27706 @group
27707 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
27708 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
27709 cd ../gdb-sun4
27710 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
27711 make
27712 @end group
27713 @end smallexample
27714
27715 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
27716 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
27717 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
27718 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
27719 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
27720 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
27721
27722 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
27723 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
27724 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
27725 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
27726 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
27727
27728 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
27729 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
27730 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
27731 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
27732 You specify a cross-debugging target by
27733 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
27734
27735 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
27736 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
27737 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
27738
27739 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
27740 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
27741 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
27742 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
27743 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
27744
27745 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
27746 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
27747 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
27748 with each other.
27749
27750 @node Config Names
27751 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
27752
27753 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
27754 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
27755 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
27756 of information in the following pattern:
27757
27758 @smallexample
27759 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
27760 @end smallexample
27761
27762 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
27763 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
27764 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
27765
27766 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
27767 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
27768 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
27769 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
27770 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
27771 abbreviations---for example:
27772
27773 @smallexample
27774 % sh config.sub i386-linux
27775 i386-pc-linux-gnu
27776 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
27777 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
27778 % sh config.sub hp9k700
27779 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
27780 % sh config.sub sun4
27781 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
27782 % sh config.sub sun3
27783 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
27784 % sh config.sub i986v
27785 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
27786 @end smallexample
27787
27788 @noindent
27789 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
27790 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
27791
27792 @node Configure Options
27793 @section @file{configure} Options
27794
27795 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
27796 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
27797 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
27798 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
27799
27800 @smallexample
27801 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
27802 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
27803 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
27804 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
27805 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
27806 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
27807 @var{host}
27808 @end smallexample
27809
27810 @noindent
27811 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
27812 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
27813 @samp{--}.
27814
27815 @table @code
27816 @item --help
27817 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
27818
27819 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
27820 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
27821 @file{@var{dir}}.
27822
27823 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
27824 Configure the source to install programs under directory
27825 @file{@var{dir}}.
27826
27827 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
27828 @need 2000
27829 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
27830 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
27831 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
27832 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
27833 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
27834 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
27835 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
27836 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
27837 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
27838 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
27839 @var{dirname}.
27840
27841 @item --norecursion
27842 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
27843 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
27844
27845 @item --target=@var{target}
27846 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
27847 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
27848 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
27849
27850 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
27851
27852 @item @var{host} @dots{}
27853 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
27854
27855 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
27856 @end table
27857
27858 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
27859 needed for special purposes only.
27860
27861 @node System-wide configuration
27862 @section System-wide configuration and settings
27863 @cindex system-wide init file
27864
27865 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
27866 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
27867 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
27868
27869 Here is the corresponding configure option:
27870
27871 @table @code
27872 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
27873 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
27874 @var{file}.
27875 @end table
27876
27877 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
27878 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
27879
27880 @itemize @bullet
27881 @item
27882 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
27883 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
27884 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
27885 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
27886 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
27887 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
27888
27889 @item
27890 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
27891 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
27892 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
27893 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
27894 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
27895 @end itemize
27896
27897 @node Maintenance Commands
27898 @appendix Maintenance Commands
27899 @cindex maintenance commands
27900 @cindex internal commands
27901
27902 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
27903 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
27904 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
27905 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
27906 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
27907
27908 @table @code
27909 @kindex maint agent
27910 @kindex maint agent-eval
27911 @item maint agent @var{expression}
27912 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
27913 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
27914 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
27915 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
27916 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
27917 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
27918 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
27919 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
27920 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
27921 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
27922 addition and return the sum.
27923
27924 @kindex maint info breakpoints
27925 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
27926 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
27927 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
27928 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
27929 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
27930 is shown:
27931
27932 @table @code
27933 @item breakpoint
27934 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
27935
27936 @item watchpoint
27937 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
27938
27939 @item longjmp
27940 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
27941 @code{longjmp} calls.
27942
27943 @item longjmp resume
27944 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
27945
27946 @item until
27947 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
27948
27949 @item finish
27950 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
27951
27952 @item shlib events
27953 Shared library events.
27954
27955 @end table
27956
27957 @kindex set displaced-stepping
27958 @kindex show displaced-stepping
27959 @cindex displaced stepping support
27960 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
27961 @item set displaced-stepping
27962 @itemx show displaced-stepping
27963 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
27964 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
27965 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
27966 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
27967 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
27968
27969 @table @code
27970 @item set displaced-stepping on
27971 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
27972 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
27973
27974 @item set displaced-stepping off
27975 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
27976 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
27977
27978 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
27979 @item set displaced-stepping auto
27980 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
27981 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
27982 architecture supports displaced stepping.
27983 @end table
27984
27985 @kindex maint check-symtabs
27986 @item maint check-symtabs
27987 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
27988
27989 @kindex maint cplus first_component
27990 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
27991 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
27992
27993 @kindex maint cplus namespace
27994 @item maint cplus namespace
27995 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
27996
27997 @kindex maint demangle
27998 @item maint demangle @var{name}
27999 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
28000
28001 @kindex maint deprecate
28002 @kindex maint undeprecate
28003 @cindex deprecated commands
28004 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
28005 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
28006 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
28007 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
28008 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
28009 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
28010 the replacement as part of the warning.
28011
28012 @kindex maint dump-me
28013 @item maint dump-me
28014 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
28015 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
28016 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
28017 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
28018
28019 @kindex maint internal-error
28020 @kindex maint internal-warning
28021 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
28022 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
28023 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
28024 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
28025 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
28026 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
28027 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
28028 @value{GDBN} session.
28029
28030 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
28031 used as the text of the error or warning message.
28032
28033 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
28034
28035 @smallexample
28036 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
28037 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
28038 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
28039 debugging may prove unreliable.
28040 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
28041 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
28042 (@value{GDBP})
28043 @end smallexample
28044
28045 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
28046 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
28047
28048 @kindex maint set internal-error
28049 @kindex maint show internal-error
28050 @kindex maint set internal-warning
28051 @kindex maint show internal-warning
28052 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
28053 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
28054 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
28055 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
28056 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
28057 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
28058 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
28059 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
28060 described in the table below.
28061
28062 @table @samp
28063 @item quit
28064 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
28065 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
28066
28067 @item corefile
28068 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
28069 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
28070 @end table
28071
28072 @kindex maint packet
28073 @item maint packet @var{text}
28074 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
28075 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
28076 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
28077 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
28078 checksum.
28079
28080 @kindex maint print architecture
28081 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28082 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
28083 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
28084
28085 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
28086 @item maint print c-tdesc
28087 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
28088 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
28089 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
28090
28091 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
28092 @item maint print dummy-frames
28093 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
28094
28095 @smallexample
28096 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
28097 @dots{}
28098 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
28099 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
28100 58 return (a + b);
28101 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
28102 @dots{}
28103 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
28104 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
28105 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
28106 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
28107 (@value{GDBP})
28108 @end smallexample
28109
28110 Takes an optional file parameter.
28111
28112 @kindex maint print registers
28113 @kindex maint print raw-registers
28114 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
28115 @kindex maint print register-groups
28116 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28117 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28118 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28119 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28120 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
28121
28122 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
28123 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
28124 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
28125 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
28126 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
28127 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
28128
28129 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
28130 write the information.
28131
28132 @kindex maint print reggroups
28133 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
28134 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
28135 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
28136 information.
28137
28138 The register groups info looks like this:
28139
28140 @smallexample
28141 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
28142 Group Type
28143 general user
28144 float user
28145 all user
28146 vector user
28147 system user
28148 save internal
28149 restore internal
28150 @end smallexample
28151
28152 @kindex flushregs
28153 @item flushregs
28154 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
28155
28156 @kindex maint print objfiles
28157 @cindex info for known object files
28158 @item maint print objfiles
28159 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
28160 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
28161 and symtabs.
28162
28163 @kindex maint print statistics
28164 @cindex bcache statistics
28165 @item maint print statistics
28166 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
28167 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
28168 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
28169 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
28170 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
28171 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
28172 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
28173 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
28174 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
28175 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
28176 lengths.
28177
28178 @kindex maint print target-stack
28179 @cindex target stack description
28180 @item maint print target-stack
28181 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
28182 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
28183 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
28184 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
28185 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
28186 address.
28187
28188 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
28189 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
28190
28191 @kindex maint print type
28192 @cindex type chain of a data type
28193 @item maint print type @var{expr}
28194 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
28195 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
28196 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
28197 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
28198 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
28199
28200 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
28201 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
28202 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
28203 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
28204 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
28205
28206 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
28207 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
28208 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
28209 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
28210 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
28211 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
28212 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
28213 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
28214 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
28215
28216 @kindex maint set profile
28217 @kindex maint show profile
28218 @cindex profiling GDB
28219 @item maint set profile
28220 @itemx maint show profile
28221 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
28222
28223 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
28224 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
28225 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
28226 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
28227 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
28228 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
28229 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
28230
28231 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
28232 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
28233
28234 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
28235 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
28236 @cindex hardware debug registers
28237 @item maint set show-debug-regs
28238 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
28239 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
28240 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
28241 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
28242 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
28243 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
28244
28245 @kindex maint space
28246 @cindex memory used by commands
28247 @item maint space
28248 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
28249 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
28250 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
28251 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
28252 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
28253
28254 @kindex maint time
28255 @cindex time of command execution
28256 @item maint time
28257 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
28258 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
28259 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
28260 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
28261 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
28262 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
28263 it's not possibly currently
28264 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
28265 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
28266
28267 @kindex maint translate-address
28268 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
28269 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
28270 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
28271 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
28272 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
28273 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
28274 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
28275
28276 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
28277 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
28278 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
28279
28280 @end table
28281
28282 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
28283 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
28284
28285 @table @code
28286 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
28287 @kindex set watchdog
28288 @cindex watchdog timer
28289 @cindex timeout for commands
28290 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
28291 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
28292 reports and error and the command is aborted.
28293
28294 @item show watchdog
28295 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
28296 @end table
28297
28298 @node Remote Protocol
28299 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
28300
28301 @menu
28302 * Overview::
28303 * Packets::
28304 * Stop Reply Packets::
28305 * General Query Packets::
28306 * Register Packet Format::
28307 * Tracepoint Packets::
28308 * Host I/O Packets::
28309 * Interrupts::
28310 * Notification Packets::
28311 * Remote Non-Stop::
28312 * Packet Acknowledgment::
28313 * Examples::
28314 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
28315 * Library List Format::
28316 * Memory Map Format::
28317 * Thread List Format::
28318 @end menu
28319
28320 @node Overview
28321 @section Overview
28322
28323 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
28324 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
28325 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
28326 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
28327
28328 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
28329 transmitted and received data, respectively.
28330
28331 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
28332 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
28333 @cindex remote serial protocol
28334 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
28335 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
28336 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
28337 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
28338 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
28339
28340 @smallexample
28341 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
28342 @end smallexample
28343 @noindent
28344
28345 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
28346 @noindent
28347 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
28348 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
28349 eight bit unsigned checksum).
28350
28351 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
28352 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
28353
28354 @smallexample
28355 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
28356 @end smallexample
28357
28358 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
28359 @noindent
28360 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
28361 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
28362 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
28363
28364 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
28365 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
28366 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
28367 retransmission):
28368
28369 @smallexample
28370 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
28371 <- @code{+}
28372 @end smallexample
28373 @noindent
28374
28375 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
28376 once a connection is established.
28377 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
28378
28379 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
28380 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
28381 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
28382 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
28383 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
28384 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
28385 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
28386
28387 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
28388 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
28389 exceptions).
28390
28391 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
28392 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
28393 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
28394 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
28395
28396 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
28397 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
28398 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
28399
28400 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
28401 @anchor{Binary Data}
28402 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
28403 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
28404 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
28405 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
28406 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
28407 binary data.
28408
28409 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
28410 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
28411 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
28412 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
28413 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
28414 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
28415 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
28416 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
28417 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
28418 (described next).
28419
28420 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
28421 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
28422 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
28423 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
28424 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
28425 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
28426 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
28427 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
28428 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
28429 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
28430 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
28431 3}} more times.
28432
28433 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
28434 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
28435 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
28436 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
28437 @samp{0*"00}.
28438
28439 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
28440 error number. That number is not well defined.
28441
28442 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
28443 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
28444 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
28445 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
28446 on that response.
28447
28448 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
28449 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
28450 optional.
28451
28452 @node Packets
28453 @section Packets
28454
28455 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
28456 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
28457 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
28458 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
28459
28460 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
28461 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
28462 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
28463 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
28464 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
28465 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
28466 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
28467 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
28468 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
28469 @var{baz}.
28470
28471 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
28472 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
28473 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
28474 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
28475 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
28476 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
28477 pick any thread.
28478
28479 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
28480 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
28481 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
28482 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
28483 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
28484 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
28485 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
28486 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
28487 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
28488 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
28489 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
28490 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
28491 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
28492
28493 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
28494 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
28495 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
28496 more information.
28497
28498 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
28499 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
28500
28501 Here are the packet descriptions.
28502
28503 @table @samp
28504
28505 @item !
28506 @cindex @samp{!} packet
28507 @anchor{extended mode}
28508 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
28509 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
28510 debugged.
28511
28512 Reply:
28513 @table @samp
28514 @item OK
28515 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
28516 @end table
28517
28518 @item ?
28519 @cindex @samp{?} packet
28520 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
28521 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
28522 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
28523
28524 Reply:
28525 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28526
28527 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
28528 @cindex @samp{A} packet
28529 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
28530 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
28531 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
28532
28533 Reply:
28534 @table @samp
28535 @item OK
28536 The arguments were set.
28537 @item E @var{NN}
28538 An error occurred.
28539 @end table
28540
28541 @item b @var{baud}
28542 @cindex @samp{b} packet
28543 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
28544 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
28545
28546 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
28547 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
28548 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
28549
28550 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
28551 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
28552 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
28553 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
28554 of view, nothing actually happened.}
28555
28556 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
28557 @cindex @samp{B} packet
28558 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
28559 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
28560
28561 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
28562 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
28563
28564 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
28565 @anchor{bc}
28566 @item bc
28567 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
28568 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
28569
28570 Reply:
28571 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28572
28573 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
28574 @anchor{bs}
28575 @item bs
28576 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
28577 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
28578
28579 Reply:
28580 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28581
28582 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
28583 @cindex @samp{c} packet
28584 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
28585 resume at current address.
28586
28587 Reply:
28588 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28589
28590 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
28591 @cindex @samp{C} packet
28592 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
28593 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
28594
28595 Reply:
28596 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28597
28598 @item d
28599 @cindex @samp{d} packet
28600 Toggle debug flag.
28601
28602 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
28603 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
28604
28605 @item D
28606 @itemx D;@var{pid}
28607 @cindex @samp{D} packet
28608 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
28609 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
28610 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
28611
28612 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
28613 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
28614 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
28615 big-endian hex string.
28616
28617 Reply:
28618 @table @samp
28619 @item OK
28620 for success
28621 @item E @var{NN}
28622 for an error
28623 @end table
28624
28625 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
28626 @cindex @samp{F} packet
28627 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
28628 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
28629 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
28630
28631 @item g
28632 @anchor{read registers packet}
28633 @cindex @samp{g} packet
28634 Read general registers.
28635
28636 Reply:
28637 @table @samp
28638 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28639 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
28640 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
28641 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
28642 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
28643 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
28644 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
28645 @item E @var{NN}
28646 for an error.
28647 @end table
28648
28649 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
28650 @cindex @samp{G} packet
28651 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
28652 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
28653
28654 Reply:
28655 @table @samp
28656 @item OK
28657 for success
28658 @item E @var{NN}
28659 for an error
28660 @end table
28661
28662 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
28663 @cindex @samp{H} packet
28664 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
28665 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
28666 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
28667 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
28668 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28669
28670 Reply:
28671 @table @samp
28672 @item OK
28673 for success
28674 @item E @var{NN}
28675 for an error
28676 @end table
28677
28678 @c FIXME: JTC:
28679 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
28680 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
28681 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
28682 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
28683 @c described. For example:
28684 @c
28685 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
28686 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
28687 @c otherwise returns current registers.
28688 @c
28689 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
28690 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
28691 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
28692
28693 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
28694 @anchor{cycle step packet}
28695 @cindex @samp{i} packet
28696 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
28697 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
28698 step starting at that address.
28699
28700 @item I
28701 @cindex @samp{I} packet
28702 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
28703 step packet}.
28704
28705 @item k
28706 @cindex @samp{k} packet
28707 Kill request.
28708
28709 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
28710 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
28711 thread?)}.
28712
28713 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
28714 @cindex @samp{m} packet
28715 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
28716 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
28717
28718 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
28719 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
28720 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
28721 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
28722 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
28723 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
28724 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
28725 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
28726
28727 Reply:
28728 @table @samp
28729 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28730 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
28731 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
28732 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
28733 @item E @var{NN}
28734 @var{NN} is errno
28735 @end table
28736
28737 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
28738 @cindex @samp{M} packet
28739 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
28740 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
28741 hexadecimal number.
28742
28743 Reply:
28744 @table @samp
28745 @item OK
28746 for success
28747 @item E @var{NN}
28748 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
28749 written).
28750 @end table
28751
28752 @item p @var{n}
28753 @cindex @samp{p} packet
28754 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
28755 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
28756 register value is encoded.
28757
28758 Reply:
28759 @table @samp
28760 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28761 the register's value
28762 @item E @var{NN}
28763 for an error
28764 @item
28765 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
28766 @end table
28767
28768 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
28769 @anchor{write register packet}
28770 @cindex @samp{P} packet
28771 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
28772 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
28773 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
28774
28775 Reply:
28776 @table @samp
28777 @item OK
28778 for success
28779 @item E @var{NN}
28780 for an error
28781 @end table
28782
28783 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
28784 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
28785 @cindex @samp{q} packet
28786 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
28787 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
28788 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
28789
28790 @item r
28791 @cindex @samp{r} packet
28792 Reset the entire system.
28793
28794 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
28795
28796 @item R @var{XX}
28797 @cindex @samp{R} packet
28798 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
28799 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
28800
28801 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
28802
28803 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
28804 @cindex @samp{s} packet
28805 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
28806 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
28807
28808 Reply:
28809 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28810
28811 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
28812 @anchor{step with signal packet}
28813 @cindex @samp{S} packet
28814 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
28815 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
28816
28817 Reply:
28818 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28819
28820 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
28821 @cindex @samp{t} packet
28822 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
28823 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
28824 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
28825
28826 @item T @var{thread-id}
28827 @cindex @samp{T} packet
28828 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
28829
28830 Reply:
28831 @table @samp
28832 @item OK
28833 thread is still alive
28834 @item E @var{NN}
28835 thread is dead
28836 @end table
28837
28838 @item v
28839 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
28840 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
28841
28842 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
28843 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
28844 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
28845 The process ID is a
28846 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
28847 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
28848 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
28849
28850 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
28851 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
28852 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
28853 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
28854 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
28855 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
28856 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
28857 @c stopping or restarting threads.
28858
28859 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
28860
28861 Reply:
28862 @table @samp
28863 @item E @var{nn}
28864 for an error
28865 @item @r{Any stop packet}
28866 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
28867 @item OK
28868 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
28869 @end table
28870
28871 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
28872 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
28873 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
28874 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
28875 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
28876 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
28877 in their current state in non-stop mode.
28878 Specifying multiple
28879 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
28880 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28881
28882 Currently supported actions are:
28883
28884 @table @samp
28885 @item c
28886 Continue.
28887 @item C @var{sig}
28888 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
28889 @item s
28890 Step.
28891 @item S @var{sig}
28892 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
28893 @item t
28894 Stop.
28895 @end table
28896
28897 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
28898 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
28899 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
28900
28901 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
28902 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
28903 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
28904 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
28905 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
28906 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
28907 as an implementation detail.
28908
28909 Reply:
28910 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28911
28912 @item vCont?
28913 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
28914 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
28915
28916 Reply:
28917 @table @samp
28918 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
28919 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
28920 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
28921 @item
28922 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
28923 @end table
28924
28925 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
28926 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
28927 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
28928 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
28929
28930 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
28931 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
28932 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
28933 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
28934 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
28935 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
28936 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
28937 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
28938 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
28939 packet is received.
28940
28941 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
28942 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
28943 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
28944 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
28945 @var{thread-id}.
28946
28947 Reply:
28948 @table @samp
28949 @item OK
28950 for success
28951 @item E @var{NN}
28952 for an error
28953 @end table
28954
28955 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
28956 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
28957 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
28958 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
28959 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
28960 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
28961 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
28962 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
28963 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
28964 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
28965 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
28966 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
28967
28968
28969 Reply:
28970 @table @samp
28971 @item OK
28972 for success
28973 @item E.memtype
28974 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
28975 @item E @var{NN}
28976 for an error
28977 @end table
28978
28979 @item vFlashDone
28980 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
28981 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
28982 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
28983 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
28984 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
28985 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
28986 request is completed.
28987
28988 @item vKill;@var{pid}
28989 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
28990 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
28991 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
28992 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
28993 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
28994
28995 Reply:
28996 @table @samp
28997 @item E @var{nn}
28998 for an error
28999 @item OK
29000 for success
29001 @end table
29002
29003 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
29004 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
29005 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
29006 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
29007 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
29008 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
29009 state.
29010
29011 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
29012
29013 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
29014
29015 Reply:
29016 @table @samp
29017 @item E @var{nn}
29018 for an error
29019 @item @r{Any stop packet}
29020 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
29021 @end table
29022
29023 @item vStopped
29024 @anchor{vStopped packet}
29025 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
29026
29027 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
29028 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
29029
29030 Reply:
29031 @table @samp
29032 @item @r{Any stop packet}
29033 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
29034 @item OK
29035 if there are no unreported stop events
29036 @end table
29037
29038 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
29039 @anchor{X packet}
29040 @cindex @samp{X} packet
29041 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
29042 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
29043 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
29044
29045 Reply:
29046 @table @samp
29047 @item OK
29048 for success
29049 @item E @var{NN}
29050 for an error
29051 @end table
29052
29053 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
29054 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
29055 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
29056 @cindex @samp{z} packet
29057 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
29058 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
29059 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
29060 @var{length} bytes.
29061
29062 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
29063 separately.
29064
29065 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
29066 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
29067 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
29068 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
29069 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
29070 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
29071
29072 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
29073 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
29074 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
29075 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
29076 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
29077 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
29078
29079 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
29080 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
29081 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
29082 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
29083 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
29084
29085 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
29086 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
29087 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
29088 target, is not defined.}
29089
29090 Reply:
29091 @table @samp
29092 @item OK
29093 success
29094 @item
29095 not supported
29096 @item E @var{NN}
29097 for an error
29098 @end table
29099
29100 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
29101 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
29102 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
29103 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
29104 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
29105 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
29106
29107 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
29108 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
29109
29110 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
29111 movement.}
29112
29113 Reply:
29114 @table @samp
29115 @item OK
29116 success
29117 @item
29118 not supported
29119 @item E @var{NN}
29120 for an error
29121 @end table
29122
29123 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
29124 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
29125 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
29126 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
29127 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
29128
29129 Reply:
29130 @table @samp
29131 @item OK
29132 success
29133 @item
29134 not supported
29135 @item E @var{NN}
29136 for an error
29137 @end table
29138
29139 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
29140 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
29141 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
29142 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
29143 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
29144
29145 Reply:
29146 @table @samp
29147 @item OK
29148 success
29149 @item
29150 not supported
29151 @item E @var{NN}
29152 for an error
29153 @end table
29154
29155 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
29156 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
29157 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
29158 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
29159 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
29160
29161 Reply:
29162 @table @samp
29163 @item OK
29164 success
29165 @item
29166 not supported
29167 @item E @var{NN}
29168 for an error
29169 @end table
29170
29171 @end table
29172
29173 @node Stop Reply Packets
29174 @section Stop Reply Packets
29175 @cindex stop reply packets
29176
29177 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
29178 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
29179 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
29180 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
29181 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
29182 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
29183 @value{GDBN} source code.
29184
29185 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
29186 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
29187 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
29188 components.
29189
29190 @table @samp
29191
29192 @item S @var{AA}
29193 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
29194 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
29195 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
29196
29197 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
29198 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
29199 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
29200 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
29201 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
29202 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
29203 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
29204 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
29205
29206 @itemize @bullet
29207 @item
29208 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
29209 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
29210 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
29211 two-digit hex number.
29212
29213 @item
29214 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
29215 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
29216
29217 @item
29218 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
29219 the core on which the stop event was detected.
29220
29221 @item
29222 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
29223 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
29224 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
29225 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
29226
29227 @item
29228 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
29229 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
29230 future.
29231 @end itemize
29232
29233 The currently defined stop reasons are:
29234
29235 @table @samp
29236 @item watch
29237 @itemx rwatch
29238 @itemx awatch
29239 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
29240 hex.
29241
29242 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
29243 @item library
29244 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
29245 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
29246 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
29247
29248 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
29249 @item replaylog
29250 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
29251 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
29252 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
29253 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
29254 for more information.
29255 @end table
29256
29257 @item W @var{AA}
29258 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
29259 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
29260 applicable to certain targets.
29261
29262 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
29263 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
29264 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
29265 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
29266
29267 @item X @var{AA}
29268 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
29269 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
29270
29271 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
29272 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
29273 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
29274 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
29275
29276 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
29277 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
29278 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
29279 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
29280 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
29281
29282 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
29283 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
29284 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
29285 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
29286 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
29287 system calls.
29288
29289 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
29290 this very system call.
29291
29292 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
29293 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
29294 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
29295 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
29296 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
29297 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
29298
29299 @end table
29300
29301 @node General Query Packets
29302 @section General Query Packets
29303 @cindex remote query requests
29304
29305 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
29306 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
29307 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
29308 sending information to and from the stub.
29309
29310 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
29311 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
29312 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
29313 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
29314 conventions:
29315
29316 @itemize @bullet
29317 @item
29318 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
29319 @item
29320 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
29321 letter.
29322 @item
29323 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
29324 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
29325 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
29326 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
29327 @end itemize
29328
29329 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
29330 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
29331 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
29332 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
29333 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
29334 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
29335 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
29336 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
29337 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
29338 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
29339 packet.}.
29340
29341 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
29342 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
29343 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
29344 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
29345 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
29346
29347 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
29348
29349 @table @samp
29350
29351 @item qC
29352 @cindex current thread, remote request
29353 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
29354 Return the current thread ID.
29355
29356 Reply:
29357 @table @samp
29358 @item QC @var{thread-id}
29359 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
29360 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
29361 @item @r{(anything else)}
29362 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
29363 @end table
29364
29365 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
29366 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
29367 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
29368 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
29369 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
29370 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
29371 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
29372
29373 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
29374 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
29375 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
29376 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
29377 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
29378 detect trailing zeros.
29379
29380 Reply:
29381 @table @samp
29382 @item E @var{NN}
29383 An error (such as memory fault)
29384 @item C @var{crc32}
29385 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
29386 @end table
29387
29388 @item qfThreadInfo
29389 @itemx qsThreadInfo
29390 @cindex list active threads, remote request
29391 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
29392 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
29393 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
29394 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
29395 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
29396 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
29397 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
29398 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
29399
29400 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
29401
29402 Reply:
29403 @table @samp
29404 @item m @var{thread-id}
29405 A single thread ID
29406 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
29407 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
29408 @item l
29409 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
29410 @end table
29411
29412 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
29413 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
29414 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
29415 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
29416 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
29417 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
29418 fields.
29419
29420 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
29421 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
29422 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
29423 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
29424 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
29425
29426 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
29427 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
29428
29429 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
29430 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
29431 information associated with the variable.)
29432
29433 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
29434 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
29435 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
29436 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
29437 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
29438 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
29439
29440 Reply:
29441 @table @samp
29442 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
29443 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
29444 local storage requested.
29445
29446 @item E @var{nn}
29447 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29448
29449 @item
29450 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
29451 @end table
29452
29453 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
29454 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
29455 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
29456 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
29457 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
29458 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
29459 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
29460
29461 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
29462
29463 Reply:
29464 @table @samp
29465 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
29466 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
29467 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
29468 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
29469 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
29470 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
29471 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
29472 @end table
29473
29474 @item qOffsets
29475 @cindex section offsets, remote request
29476 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
29477 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
29478 image.
29479
29480 Reply:
29481 @table @samp
29482 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
29483 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
29484 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
29485 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
29486 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
29487 segments by the supplied offsets.
29488
29489 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
29490 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
29491 to the @code{Bss} section.}
29492
29493 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
29494 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
29495 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
29496 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
29497 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
29498 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
29499 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
29500 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
29501 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
29502 @end table
29503
29504 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
29505 @cindex thread information, remote request
29506 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
29507 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
29508 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
29509 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
29510
29511 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
29512 (see below).
29513
29514 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
29515
29516 @item QNonStop:1
29517 @item QNonStop:0
29518 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
29519 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
29520 @anchor{QNonStop}
29521 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
29522 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
29523
29524 Reply:
29525 @table @samp
29526 @item OK
29527 The request succeeded.
29528
29529 @item E @var{nn}
29530 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29531
29532 @item
29533 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
29534 the stub.
29535 @end table
29536
29537 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29538 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29539 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
29540 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
29541
29542 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
29543 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
29544 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
29545 @anchor{QPassSignals}
29546 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
29547 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
29548 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
29549 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
29550 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
29551 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
29552 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
29553 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
29554 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
29555
29556 Reply:
29557 @table @samp
29558 @item OK
29559 The request succeeded.
29560
29561 @item E @var{nn}
29562 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29563
29564 @item
29565 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
29566 the stub.
29567 @end table
29568
29569 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
29570 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
29571 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29572 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29573
29574 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
29575 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
29576 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
29577 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
29578 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
29579 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
29580 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
29581 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
29582 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
29583
29584 Reply:
29585 @table @samp
29586 @item OK
29587 A command response with no output.
29588 @item @var{OUTPUT}
29589 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
29590 @item E @var{NN}
29591 Indicate a badly formed request.
29592 @item
29593 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
29594 @end table
29595
29596 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
29597 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
29598 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
29599 packets.)
29600
29601 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
29602 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
29603 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
29604 @anchor{qSearch memory}
29605 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
29606 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
29607 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
29608
29609 Reply:
29610 @table @samp
29611 @item 0
29612 The pattern was not found.
29613 @item 1,address
29614 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
29615 @item E @var{NN}
29616 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
29617 @item
29618 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
29619 @end table
29620
29621 @item QStartNoAckMode
29622 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
29623 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
29624 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
29625 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
29626
29627 Reply:
29628 @table @samp
29629 @item OK
29630 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
29631 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
29632 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
29633 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
29634 @item
29635 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
29636 @end table
29637
29638 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
29639 @cindex supported packets, remote query
29640 @cindex features of the remote protocol
29641 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
29642 @anchor{qSupported}
29643 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
29644 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
29645 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
29646 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
29647 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
29648 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
29649 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
29650 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
29651 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
29652 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
29653 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
29654 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
29655 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
29656 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
29657
29658 Reply:
29659 @table @samp
29660 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
29661 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
29662 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
29663 possible forms).
29664 @item
29665 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
29666 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
29667 @end table
29668
29669 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
29670 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
29671 are:
29672
29673 @table @samp
29674 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
29675 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
29676 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
29677 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
29678 @item @var{name}+
29679 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
29680 need an associated value.
29681 @item @var{name}-
29682 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
29683 @item @var{name}?
29684 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
29685 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
29686 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
29687 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
29688 @end table
29689
29690 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
29691 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
29692 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
29693 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
29694 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
29695
29696 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
29697 are defined:
29698
29699 @table @samp
29700 @item multiprocess
29701 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
29702 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
29703 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
29704 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
29705 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
29706 @end table
29707
29708 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
29709 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
29710 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
29711 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
29712 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
29713 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
29714 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
29715 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
29716 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
29717 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
29718 all the features it supports.
29719
29720 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
29721 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
29722
29723 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
29724 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
29725 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
29726 form response.
29727
29728 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
29729 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
29730 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
29731 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
29732
29733 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
29734 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
29735 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
29736 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
29737 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
29738
29739 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
29740
29741 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
29742 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
29743 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
29744 @item Feature Name
29745 @tab Value Required
29746 @tab Default
29747 @tab Probe Allowed
29748
29749 @item @samp{PacketSize}
29750 @tab Yes
29751 @tab @samp{-}
29752 @tab No
29753
29754 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
29755 @tab No
29756 @tab @samp{-}
29757 @tab Yes
29758
29759 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
29760 @tab No
29761 @tab @samp{-}
29762 @tab Yes
29763
29764 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29765 @tab No
29766 @tab @samp{-}
29767 @tab Yes
29768
29769 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29770 @tab No
29771 @tab @samp{-}
29772 @tab Yes
29773
29774 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
29775 @tab No
29776 @tab @samp{-}
29777 @tab Yes
29778
29779 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
29780 @tab No
29781 @tab @samp{-}
29782 @tab Yes
29783
29784 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
29785 @tab No
29786 @tab @samp{-}
29787 @tab Yes
29788
29789 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
29790 @tab No
29791 @tab @samp{-}
29792 @tab Yes
29793
29794 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
29795 @tab No
29796 @tab @samp{-}
29797 @tab Yes
29798
29799
29800 @item @samp{QNonStop}
29801 @tab No
29802 @tab @samp{-}
29803 @tab Yes
29804
29805 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
29806 @tab No
29807 @tab @samp{-}
29808 @tab Yes
29809
29810 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
29811 @tab No
29812 @tab @samp{-}
29813 @tab Yes
29814
29815 @item @samp{multiprocess}
29816 @tab No
29817 @tab @samp{-}
29818 @tab No
29819
29820 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
29821 @tab No
29822 @tab @samp{-}
29823 @tab No
29824
29825 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
29826 @tab No
29827 @tab @samp{-}
29828 @tab No
29829
29830 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
29831 @tab No
29832 @tab @samp{-}
29833 @tab No
29834
29835 @end multitable
29836
29837 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
29838
29839 @table @samp
29840 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
29841 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
29842 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
29843 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
29844 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
29845 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
29846 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
29847 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
29848 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
29849 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
29850
29851 @item qXfer:auxv:read
29852 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
29853 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
29854
29855 @item qXfer:features:read
29856 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
29857 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
29858
29859 @item qXfer:libraries:read
29860 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
29861 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
29862
29863 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
29864 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
29865 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
29866
29867 @item qXfer:spu:read
29868 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
29869 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
29870
29871 @item qXfer:spu:write
29872 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
29873 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
29874
29875 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
29876 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
29877 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
29878
29879 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
29880 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
29881 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
29882
29883 @item qXfer:threads:read
29884 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
29885 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
29886
29887 @item QNonStop
29888 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
29889 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
29890
29891 @item QPassSignals
29892 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
29893 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
29894
29895 @item QStartNoAckMode
29896 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
29897 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
29898
29899 @item multiprocess
29900 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
29901 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
29902 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
29903 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
29904 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
29905 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
29906 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
29907 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
29908 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
29909 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
29910 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
29911
29912 @item qXfer:osdata:read
29913 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
29914 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
29915
29916 @item ConditionalTracepoints
29917 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
29918 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
29919
29920 @item ReverseContinue
29921 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
29922 (@pxref{bc}).
29923
29924 @item ReverseStep
29925 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
29926 (@pxref{bs}).
29927
29928 @end table
29929
29930 @item qSymbol::
29931 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
29932 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
29933 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
29934 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
29935
29936 Reply:
29937 @table @samp
29938 @item OK
29939 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
29940 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
29941 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
29942 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
29943 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
29944 below.
29945 @end table
29946
29947 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
29948 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
29949
29950 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
29951 target has previously requested.
29952
29953 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
29954 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
29955 will be empty.
29956
29957 Reply:
29958 @table @samp
29959 @item OK
29960 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
29961 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
29962 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
29963 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
29964 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
29965 @end table
29966
29967 @item QTDisconnected
29968 @itemx QTDP
29969 @itemx QTDV
29970 @itemx QTfP
29971 @itemx QTFrame
29972 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
29973
29974 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
29975 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
29976 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
29977 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
29978 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
29979 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
29980 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
29981 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
29982 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
29983 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
29984 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
29985
29986 Reply:
29987 @table @samp
29988 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
29989 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
29990 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
29991 the thread's attributes.
29992 @end table
29993
29994 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
29995 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
29996 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
29997 packets.)
29998
29999 @item QTsP
30000 @itemx QTStart
30001 @itemx QTStop
30002 @itemx QTinit
30003 @itemx QTro
30004 @itemx qTStatus
30005 @itemx qTV
30006 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
30007
30008 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
30009 @cindex read special object, remote request
30010 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
30011 @anchor{qXfer read}
30012 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
30013 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
30014 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
30015 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
30016 additional details about what data to access.
30017
30018 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
30019 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
30020 formats, listed below.
30021
30022 @table @samp
30023 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
30024 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
30025 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
30026 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
30027
30028 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30029 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30030
30031 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
30032 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
30033 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
30034 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
30035 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
30036
30037 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30038 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30039
30040 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
30041 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
30042 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
30043 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
30044 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
30045
30046 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
30047 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
30048 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
30049
30050 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30051 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30052
30053 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
30054 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
30055 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
30056 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
30057 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
30058
30059 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30060 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30061
30062 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
30063 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
30064 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
30065 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
30066 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
30067
30068 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30069 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
30070 (@pxref{qSupported}).
30071
30072 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
30073 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
30074 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
30075 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
30076 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
30077 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
30078 in that context to be accessed.
30079
30080 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30081 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
30082 (@pxref{qSupported}).
30083
30084 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
30085 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
30086 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
30087 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
30088 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
30089
30090 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30091 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30092
30093 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
30094 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
30095 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
30096 @xref{Operating System Information}.
30097
30098 @end table
30099
30100 Reply:
30101 @table @samp
30102 @item m @var{data}
30103 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
30104 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
30105 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
30106 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
30107 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
30108 request.
30109
30110 @item l @var{data}
30111 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
30112 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
30113 than the @var{length} in the request.
30114
30115 @item l
30116 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
30117 There is no more data to be read.
30118
30119 @item E00
30120 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
30121
30122 @item E @var{nn}
30123 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
30124 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
30125
30126 @item
30127 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
30128 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
30129 @end table
30130
30131 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
30132 @cindex write data into object, remote request
30133 @anchor{qXfer write}
30134 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
30135 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
30136 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
30137 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
30138 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
30139 to access.
30140
30141 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
30142 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
30143 formats, listed below.
30144
30145 @table @samp
30146 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
30147 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
30148 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
30149 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
30150 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
30151
30152 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30153 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
30154 (@pxref{qSupported}).
30155
30156 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
30157 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
30158 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
30159 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
30160 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
30161 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
30162 in that context to be accessed.
30163
30164 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
30165 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30166 @end table
30167
30168 Reply:
30169 @table @samp
30170 @item @var{nn}
30171 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
30172 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
30173
30174 @item E00
30175 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
30176
30177 @item E @var{nn}
30178 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
30179 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
30180
30181 @item
30182 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
30183 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
30184 @end table
30185
30186 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
30187 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
30188 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
30189 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
30190 must respond with an empty packet.
30191
30192 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
30193 @cindex query attached, remote request
30194 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
30195 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
30196 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
30197 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
30198 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
30199 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
30200 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
30201
30202 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
30203 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
30204 the @code{quit} command.
30205
30206 Reply:
30207 @table @samp
30208 @item 1
30209 The remote server attached to an existing process.
30210 @item 0
30211 The remote server created a new process.
30212 @item E @var{NN}
30213 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
30214 @end table
30215
30216 @end table
30217
30218 @node Register Packet Format
30219 @section Register Packet Format
30220
30221 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
30222 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
30223 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
30224 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
30225 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
30226 most-significant - least-significant.
30227
30228 @table @r
30229
30230 @item MIPS32
30231
30232 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
30233 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
30234 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
30235
30236 @item MIPS64
30237
30238 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
30239 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
30240 as @code{MIPS32}.
30241
30242 @end table
30243
30244 @node Tracepoint Packets
30245 @section Tracepoint Packets
30246 @cindex tracepoint packets
30247 @cindex packets, tracepoint
30248
30249 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
30250 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
30251
30252 @table @samp
30253
30254 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
30255 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
30256 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
30257 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
30258 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
30259 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
30260 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
30261 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
30262 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
30263 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
30264 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
30265 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
30266 actions.
30267
30268 Replies:
30269 @table @samp
30270 @item OK
30271 The packet was understood and carried out.
30272 @item
30273 The packet was not recognized.
30274 @end table
30275
30276 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
30277 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
30278 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
30279 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
30280 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
30281 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
30282 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
30283
30284 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
30285 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
30286 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
30287 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
30288 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
30289 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
30290 tracepoint actions.
30291
30292 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
30293 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
30294 following forms:
30295
30296 @table @samp
30297
30298 @item R @var{mask}
30299 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
30300 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
30301 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
30302 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
30303 not fit in a 32-bit word.
30304
30305 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
30306 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
30307 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
30308 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
30309 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
30310 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
30311 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
30312
30313 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
30314 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
30315 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
30316 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
30317 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
30318 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
30319 packet).
30320
30321 @end table
30322
30323 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
30324 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
30325 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
30326 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
30327 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
30328 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
30329 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
30330 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
30331
30332 Replies:
30333 @table @samp
30334 @item OK
30335 The packet was understood and carried out.
30336 @item
30337 The packet was not recognized.
30338 @end table
30339
30340 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
30341 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
30342 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
30343 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
30344 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
30345 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
30346 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
30347 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
30348 mentioned in expressions.
30349
30350 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
30351 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
30352 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
30353 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
30354
30355 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
30356 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
30357 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
30358 one of the following forms:
30359
30360 @table @samp
30361 @item F @var{f}
30362 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
30363 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
30364 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
30365
30366 @item T @var{t}
30367 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
30368 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
30369
30370 @end table
30371
30372 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
30373 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
30374 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
30375 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
30376
30377 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
30378 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
30379 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
30380 is a hexadecimal number.
30381
30382 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
30383 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
30384 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
30385 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
30386 numbers.
30387
30388 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
30389 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
30390 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
30391
30392 @item QTStart
30393 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
30394 hits in the trace frame buffer.
30395
30396 @item QTStop
30397 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
30398
30399 @item QTinit
30400 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
30401
30402 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
30403 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
30404 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
30405 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
30406
30407 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
30408 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
30409 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
30410 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
30411
30412 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
30413 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
30414 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
30415 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
30416 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
30417
30418 @item qTStatus
30419 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
30420
30421 Replies:
30422 @table @samp
30423 @item T0
30424 There is no trace experiment running.
30425 @item T1
30426 There is a trace experiment running.
30427 @end table
30428
30429 @item qTV:@var{var}
30430 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
30431 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
30432 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
30433
30434 Replies:
30435 @table @samp
30436 @item V@var{value}
30437 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
30438 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
30439 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
30440 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
30441 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
30442 program is running.
30443
30444 @item U
30445 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
30446 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
30447 was not collected.
30448 @end table
30449
30450 @item qTfP
30451 @itemx qTsP
30452 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
30453 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
30454 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
30455 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
30456 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
30457
30458 @end table
30459
30460 @node Host I/O Packets
30461 @section Host I/O Packets
30462 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
30463 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
30464
30465 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
30466 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
30467 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
30468 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
30469 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
30470 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
30471 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
30472 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
30473 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
30474 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
30475
30476 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
30477 its arguments. They have this format:
30478
30479 @table @samp
30480
30481 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
30482 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
30483 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
30484 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
30485 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
30486 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
30487 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
30488 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
30489 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
30490
30491 @end table
30492
30493 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
30494
30495 @table @samp
30496
30497 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
30498 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
30499 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
30500 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
30501 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
30502 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
30503 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
30504 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
30505 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
30506 @var{attachment}.
30507
30508 @item
30509 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
30510
30511 @end table
30512
30513 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
30514
30515 @table @samp
30516 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
30517 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
30518 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
30519 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
30520 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
30521 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
30522 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
30523
30524 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
30525 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
30526 -1 if an error occurs.
30527
30528 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
30529 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
30530 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
30531 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
30532 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
30533 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
30534 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
30535 @var{count} was zero.
30536
30537 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
30538 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
30539 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
30540 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
30541 some characters were escaped.
30542
30543 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
30544 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
30545 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
30546 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
30547 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
30548 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
30549 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
30550 error occurred.
30551
30552 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
30553 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
30554 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
30555
30556 @end table
30557
30558 @node Interrupts
30559 @section Interrupts
30560 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
30561
30562 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
30563 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
30564 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
30565 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
30566
30567 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
30568 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
30569 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
30570 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
30571 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
30572
30573 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
30574 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
30575 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
30576 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
30577 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
30578 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
30579 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
30580 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
30581
30582 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
30583 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
30584 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
30585
30586 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
30587 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
30588 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
30589 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
30590 currently-executing threads and processes.
30591 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
30592 running program, it should send one of the stop
30593 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
30594 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
30595 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
30596 Interrupts received while the
30597 program is stopped are discarded.
30598
30599 @node Notification Packets
30600 @section Notification Packets
30601 @cindex notification packets
30602 @cindex packets, notification
30603
30604 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
30605 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
30606 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
30607 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
30608 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
30609 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
30610 is not a problem.
30611
30612 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
30613 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
30614 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
30615 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
30616 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
30617 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
30618 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
30619
30620 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
30621 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
30622
30623 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
30624 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
30625 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
30626 not they understand it.
30627
30628 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
30629 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
30630 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
30631 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
30632 recipients.
30633
30634 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
30635 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
30636 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
30637 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
30638 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
30639
30640 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
30641 defined:
30642
30643 @table @samp
30644 @item Stop: @var{reply}
30645 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
30646 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
30647 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
30648 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
30649 @value{GDBN}.
30650 @end table
30651
30652 @node Remote Non-Stop
30653 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
30654
30655 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
30656 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
30657 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
30658 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30659
30660 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
30661 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
30662 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
30663 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
30664 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
30665 probe the target state after a mode change.
30666
30667 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
30668 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
30669 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
30670 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
30671 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
30672 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
30673 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
30674 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
30675 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
30676 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
30677 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
30678
30679 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
30680 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
30681 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
30682 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
30683 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
30684 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
30685 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
30686 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
30687 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
30688 sending any queued stop events.
30689
30690 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
30691 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
30692 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
30693 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
30694 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
30695 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
30696 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
30697
30698 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
30699 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
30700 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
30701 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
30702 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
30703 process normally.
30704
30705 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
30706 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
30707 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
30708 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
30709 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
30710 should process normally.
30711
30712 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
30713 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
30714 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
30715 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
30716 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
30717
30718 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
30719 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
30720 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
30721 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
30722 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
30723 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
30724 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
30725 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
30726 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
30727 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
30728 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
30729 @samp{OK}.
30730
30731 @node Packet Acknowledgment
30732 @section Packet Acknowledgment
30733
30734 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
30735 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
30736 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
30737 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
30738 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
30739 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
30740 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
30741
30742 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
30743 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
30744 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
30745 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
30746 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
30747
30748 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
30749 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
30750 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
30751 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
30752
30753 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
30754 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
30755 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
30756 @pxref{qSupported}.
30757 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
30758 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
30759 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
30760 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
30761 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
30762 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
30763 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
30764
30765 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
30766 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
30767 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
30768 connection.
30769 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
30770 new connection is established,
30771 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
30772 for the current connection, once disabled.
30773
30774 @node Examples
30775 @section Examples
30776
30777 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
30778 does not get any direct output:
30779
30780 @smallexample
30781 -> @code{R00}
30782 <- @code{+}
30783 @emph{target restarts}
30784 -> @code{?}
30785 <- @code{+}
30786 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
30787 -> @code{+}
30788 @end smallexample
30789
30790 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
30791
30792 @smallexample
30793 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
30794 <- @code{+}
30795 -> @code{s}
30796 <- @code{+}
30797 @emph{time passes}
30798 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
30799 -> @code{+}
30800 -> @code{g}
30801 <- @code{+}
30802 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
30803 -> @code{+}
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
30807 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
30808 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
30809
30810 @menu
30811 * File-I/O Overview::
30812 * Protocol Basics::
30813 * The F Request Packet::
30814 * The F Reply Packet::
30815 * The Ctrl-C Message::
30816 * Console I/O::
30817 * List of Supported Calls::
30818 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
30819 * Constants::
30820 * File-I/O Examples::
30821 @end menu
30822
30823 @node File-I/O Overview
30824 @subsection File-I/O Overview
30825 @cindex file-i/o overview
30826
30827 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
30828 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
30829 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
30830 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
30831 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
30832 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
30833
30834 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
30835 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
30836 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
30837 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
30838 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
30839
30840 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
30841 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
30842 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
30843 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
30844 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
30845 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
30846 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
30847
30848 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
30849 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
30850 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
30851 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
30852 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
30853
30854 @smallexample
30855 (@value{GDBP}) continue
30856 <- target requests 'system call X'
30857 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
30858 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
30859 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
30860 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
30861 @end smallexample
30862
30863 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
30864 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
30865 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
30866 system are not supported by this protocol.
30867
30868 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
30869
30870 @node Protocol Basics
30871 @subsection Protocol Basics
30872 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
30873
30874 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
30875 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
30876 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
30877 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
30878 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
30879 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
30880 to call the appropriate host system call:
30881
30882 @itemize @bullet
30883 @item
30884 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
30885
30886 @item
30887 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
30888 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
30889 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
30890 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
30891
30892 @end itemize
30893
30894 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
30895
30896 @itemize @bullet
30897 @item
30898 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
30899 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
30900 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
30901 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
30902 packet.
30903
30904 @item
30905 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
30906 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
30907
30908 @item
30909 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
30910
30911 @item
30912 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
30913
30914 @item
30915 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
30916 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
30917 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
30918 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
30919 packet.
30920
30921 @end itemize
30922
30923 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
30924 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
30925
30926 @itemize @bullet
30927 @item
30928 Return value.
30929
30930 @item
30931 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
30932
30933 @item
30934 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
30935
30936 @end itemize
30937
30938 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
30939 the latest continue or step action.
30940
30941 @node The F Request Packet
30942 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
30943 @cindex file-i/o request packet
30944 @cindex @code{F} request packet
30945
30946 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
30947
30948 @table @samp
30949 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
30950
30951 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
30952 This is just the name of the function.
30953
30954 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
30955 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
30956 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
30957 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
30958 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
30959 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
30960 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
30961
30962 @end table
30963
30964
30965
30966 @node The F Reply Packet
30967 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
30968 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
30969 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
30970
30971 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
30972
30973 @table @samp
30974
30975 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
30976
30977 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
30978
30979 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
30980 representation.
30981 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
30982
30983 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
30984 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
30985 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
30986
30987 @smallexample
30988 F0,0,C
30989 @end smallexample
30990
30991 @noindent
30992 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
30993
30994 @smallexample
30995 F-1,4,C
30996 @end smallexample
30997
30998 @noindent
30999 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
31000
31001 @end table
31002
31003
31004 @node The Ctrl-C Message
31005 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
31006 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
31007
31008 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
31009 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
31010 the target should behave as if it had
31011 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
31012 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
31013 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
31014 packet.
31015
31016 It's important for the target to know in which
31017 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
31018
31019 @itemize @bullet
31020 @item
31021 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
31022
31023 @item
31024 The system call on the host has been finished.
31025
31026 @end itemize
31027
31028 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
31029 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
31030 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
31031 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
31032 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
31033 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
31034
31035 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
31036 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
31037 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
31038 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
31039 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
31040 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
31041 or the full action has been completed.
31042
31043 @node Console I/O
31044 @subsection Console I/O
31045 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
31046
31047 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
31048 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
31049 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
31050 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
31051 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
31052 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
31053 conditions is met:
31054
31055 @itemize @bullet
31056 @item
31057 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
31058 @code{read}
31059 system call is treated as finished.
31060
31061 @item
31062 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
31063 newline.
31064
31065 @item
31066 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
31067 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
31068
31069 @end itemize
31070
31071 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
31072 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
31073 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
31074 is stopped at the user's request.
31075
31076
31077 @node List of Supported Calls
31078 @subsection List of Supported Calls
31079 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
31080
31081 @menu
31082 * open::
31083 * close::
31084 * read::
31085 * write::
31086 * lseek::
31087 * rename::
31088 * unlink::
31089 * stat/fstat::
31090 * gettimeofday::
31091 * isatty::
31092 * system::
31093 @end menu
31094
31095 @node open
31096 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
31097 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
31098
31099 @table @asis
31100 @item Synopsis:
31101 @smallexample
31102 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
31103 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
31104 @end smallexample
31105
31106 @item Request:
31107 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
31108
31109 @noindent
31110 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
31111
31112 @table @code
31113 @item O_CREAT
31114 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
31115 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
31116 are concerned.
31117
31118 @item O_EXCL
31119 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
31120 an error and open() fails.
31121
31122 @item O_TRUNC
31123 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
31124 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
31125 truncated to zero length.
31126
31127 @item O_APPEND
31128 The file is opened in append mode.
31129
31130 @item O_RDONLY
31131 The file is opened for reading only.
31132
31133 @item O_WRONLY
31134 The file is opened for writing only.
31135
31136 @item O_RDWR
31137 The file is opened for reading and writing.
31138 @end table
31139
31140 @noindent
31141 Other bits are silently ignored.
31142
31143
31144 @noindent
31145 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
31146
31147 @table @code
31148 @item S_IRUSR
31149 User has read permission.
31150
31151 @item S_IWUSR
31152 User has write permission.
31153
31154 @item S_IRGRP
31155 Group has read permission.
31156
31157 @item S_IWGRP
31158 Group has write permission.
31159
31160 @item S_IROTH
31161 Others have read permission.
31162
31163 @item S_IWOTH
31164 Others have write permission.
31165 @end table
31166
31167 @noindent
31168 Other bits are silently ignored.
31169
31170
31171 @item Return value:
31172 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
31173 occurred.
31174
31175 @item Errors:
31176
31177 @table @code
31178 @item EEXIST
31179 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
31180
31181 @item EISDIR
31182 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
31183
31184 @item EACCES
31185 The requested access is not allowed.
31186
31187 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31188 @var{pathname} was too long.
31189
31190 @item ENOENT
31191 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
31192
31193 @item ENODEV
31194 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
31195
31196 @item EROFS
31197 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
31198 write access was requested.
31199
31200 @item EFAULT
31201 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
31202
31203 @item ENOSPC
31204 No space on device to create the file.
31205
31206 @item EMFILE
31207 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
31208
31209 @item ENFILE
31210 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
31211 has been reached.
31212
31213 @item EINTR
31214 The call was interrupted by the user.
31215 @end table
31216
31217 @end table
31218
31219 @node close
31220 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
31221 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
31222
31223 @table @asis
31224 @item Synopsis:
31225 @smallexample
31226 int close(int fd);
31227 @end smallexample
31228
31229 @item Request:
31230 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
31231
31232 @item Return value:
31233 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
31234
31235 @item Errors:
31236
31237 @table @code
31238 @item EBADF
31239 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
31240
31241 @item EINTR
31242 The call was interrupted by the user.
31243 @end table
31244
31245 @end table
31246
31247 @node read
31248 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
31249 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
31250
31251 @table @asis
31252 @item Synopsis:
31253 @smallexample
31254 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
31255 @end smallexample
31256
31257 @item Request:
31258 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
31259
31260 @item Return value:
31261 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
31262 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
31263 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
31264
31265 @item Errors:
31266
31267 @table @code
31268 @item EBADF
31269 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
31270 reading.
31271
31272 @item EFAULT
31273 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31274
31275 @item EINTR
31276 The call was interrupted by the user.
31277 @end table
31278
31279 @end table
31280
31281 @node write
31282 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
31283 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
31284
31285 @table @asis
31286 @item Synopsis:
31287 @smallexample
31288 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
31289 @end smallexample
31290
31291 @item Request:
31292 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
31293
31294 @item Return value:
31295 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
31296 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
31297 is returned.
31298
31299 @item Errors:
31300
31301 @table @code
31302 @item EBADF
31303 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
31304 writing.
31305
31306 @item EFAULT
31307 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31308
31309 @item EFBIG
31310 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
31311 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
31312
31313 @item ENOSPC
31314 No space on device to write the data.
31315
31316 @item EINTR
31317 The call was interrupted by the user.
31318 @end table
31319
31320 @end table
31321
31322 @node lseek
31323 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
31324 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
31325
31326 @table @asis
31327 @item Synopsis:
31328 @smallexample
31329 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
31330 @end smallexample
31331
31332 @item Request:
31333 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
31334
31335 @var{flag} is one of:
31336
31337 @table @code
31338 @item SEEK_SET
31339 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
31340
31341 @item SEEK_CUR
31342 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
31343 bytes.
31344
31345 @item SEEK_END
31346 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
31347 bytes.
31348 @end table
31349
31350 @item Return value:
31351 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
31352 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
31353 value of -1 is returned.
31354
31355 @item Errors:
31356
31357 @table @code
31358 @item EBADF
31359 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
31360
31361 @item ESPIPE
31362 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
31363
31364 @item EINVAL
31365 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
31366
31367 @item EINTR
31368 The call was interrupted by the user.
31369 @end table
31370
31371 @end table
31372
31373 @node rename
31374 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
31375 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
31376
31377 @table @asis
31378 @item Synopsis:
31379 @smallexample
31380 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
31381 @end smallexample
31382
31383 @item Request:
31384 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
31385
31386 @item Return value:
31387 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
31388
31389 @item Errors:
31390
31391 @table @code
31392 @item EISDIR
31393 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
31394 directory.
31395
31396 @item EEXIST
31397 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
31398
31399 @item EBUSY
31400 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
31401 process.
31402
31403 @item EINVAL
31404 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
31405 of itself.
31406
31407 @item ENOTDIR
31408 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
31409 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
31410 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
31411
31412 @item EFAULT
31413 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
31414
31415 @item EACCES
31416 No access to the file or the path of the file.
31417
31418 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31419
31420 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
31421
31422 @item ENOENT
31423 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
31424
31425 @item EROFS
31426 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
31427
31428 @item ENOSPC
31429 The device containing the file has no room for the new
31430 directory entry.
31431
31432 @item EINTR
31433 The call was interrupted by the user.
31434 @end table
31435
31436 @end table
31437
31438 @node unlink
31439 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
31440 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
31441
31442 @table @asis
31443 @item Synopsis:
31444 @smallexample
31445 int unlink(const char *pathname);
31446 @end smallexample
31447
31448 @item Request:
31449 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
31450
31451 @item Return value:
31452 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
31453
31454 @item Errors:
31455
31456 @table @code
31457 @item EACCES
31458 No access to the file or the path of the file.
31459
31460 @item EPERM
31461 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
31462
31463 @item EBUSY
31464 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
31465 being used by another process.
31466
31467 @item EFAULT
31468 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31469
31470 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31471 @var{pathname} was too long.
31472
31473 @item ENOENT
31474 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
31475
31476 @item ENOTDIR
31477 A component of the path is not a directory.
31478
31479 @item EROFS
31480 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
31481
31482 @item EINTR
31483 The call was interrupted by the user.
31484 @end table
31485
31486 @end table
31487
31488 @node stat/fstat
31489 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
31490 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
31491 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
31492
31493 @table @asis
31494 @item Synopsis:
31495 @smallexample
31496 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
31497 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
31498 @end smallexample
31499
31500 @item Request:
31501 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
31502 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
31503
31504 @item Return value:
31505 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
31506
31507 @item Errors:
31508
31509 @table @code
31510 @item EBADF
31511 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
31512
31513 @item ENOENT
31514 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
31515 path is an empty string.
31516
31517 @item ENOTDIR
31518 A component of the path is not a directory.
31519
31520 @item EFAULT
31521 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31522
31523 @item EACCES
31524 No access to the file or the path of the file.
31525
31526 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31527 @var{pathname} was too long.
31528
31529 @item EINTR
31530 The call was interrupted by the user.
31531 @end table
31532
31533 @end table
31534
31535 @node gettimeofday
31536 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
31537 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
31538
31539 @table @asis
31540 @item Synopsis:
31541 @smallexample
31542 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
31543 @end smallexample
31544
31545 @item Request:
31546 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
31547
31548 @item Return value:
31549 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
31550
31551 @item Errors:
31552
31553 @table @code
31554 @item EINVAL
31555 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
31556
31557 @item EFAULT
31558 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31559 @end table
31560
31561 @end table
31562
31563 @node isatty
31564 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
31565 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
31566
31567 @table @asis
31568 @item Synopsis:
31569 @smallexample
31570 int isatty(int fd);
31571 @end smallexample
31572
31573 @item Request:
31574 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
31575
31576 @item Return value:
31577 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
31578
31579 @item Errors:
31580
31581 @table @code
31582 @item EINTR
31583 The call was interrupted by the user.
31584 @end table
31585
31586 @end table
31587
31588 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
31589 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
31590 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
31591 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
31592 needed.
31593
31594
31595 @node system
31596 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
31597 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
31598
31599 @table @asis
31600 @item Synopsis:
31601 @smallexample
31602 int system(const char *command);
31603 @end smallexample
31604
31605 @item Request:
31606 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
31607
31608 @item Return value:
31609 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
31610 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
31611 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
31612 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
31613 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
31614 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
31615 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
31616
31617 @item Errors:
31618
31619 @table @code
31620 @item EINTR
31621 The call was interrupted by the user.
31622 @end table
31623
31624 @end table
31625
31626 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
31627 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
31628 the host is simplified before it's returned
31629 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
31630 is discarded, and the return value consists
31631 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
31632
31633 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
31634 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
31635 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
31636
31637 @table @code
31638 @item set remote system-call-allowed
31639 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
31640 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
31641 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
31642
31643 @item show remote system-call-allowed
31644 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
31645 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
31646 protocol.
31647 @end table
31648
31649 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
31650 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
31651 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
31652
31653 @menu
31654 * Integral Datatypes::
31655 * Pointer Values::
31656 * Memory Transfer::
31657 * struct stat::
31658 * struct timeval::
31659 @end menu
31660
31661 @node Integral Datatypes
31662 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
31663 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
31664
31665 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
31666 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
31667 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
31668
31669 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
31670 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
31671
31672 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
31673
31674 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
31675 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
31676
31677 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
31678
31679 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
31680 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
31681 byte order.
31682
31683 @node Pointer Values
31684 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
31685 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
31686
31687 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
31688 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
31689 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
31690 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
31691
31692 @smallexample
31693 @code{1aaf/12}
31694 @end smallexample
31695
31696 @noindent
31697 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
31698 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
31699 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
31700 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
31701
31702 @smallexample
31703 @code{123456/d}
31704 @end smallexample
31705
31706 @node Memory Transfer
31707 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
31708 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
31709
31710 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
31711 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
31712 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
31713 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
31714 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
31715 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
31716 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
31717
31718
31719 @node struct stat
31720 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
31721 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
31722
31723 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
31724 is defined as follows:
31725
31726 @smallexample
31727 struct stat @{
31728 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
31729 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
31730 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
31731 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
31732 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
31733 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
31734 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
31735 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
31736 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
31737 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
31738 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
31739 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
31740 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
31741 @};
31742 @end smallexample
31743
31744 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
31745 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
31746 structure is of size 64 bytes.
31747
31748 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
31749 range of values.
31750
31751 @table @code
31752
31753 @item st_dev
31754 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
31755
31756 @item st_ino
31757 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
31758
31759 @item st_mode
31760 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
31761 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
31762
31763 @item st_uid
31764 @itemx st_gid
31765 @itemx st_rdev
31766 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
31767
31768 @item st_atime
31769 @itemx st_mtime
31770 @itemx st_ctime
31771 These values have a host and file system dependent
31772 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
31773 support exact timing values.
31774 @end table
31775
31776 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
31777 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
31778 continuing.
31779
31780 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
31781 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
31782 get truncated on the target.
31783
31784 @node struct timeval
31785 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
31786 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
31787
31788 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
31789 is defined as follows:
31790
31791 @smallexample
31792 struct timeval @{
31793 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
31794 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
31795 @};
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
31799 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
31800 structure is of size 8 bytes.
31801
31802 @node Constants
31803 @subsection Constants
31804 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
31805
31806 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
31807 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
31808 values before and after the call as needed.
31809
31810 @menu
31811 * Open Flags::
31812 * mode_t Values::
31813 * Errno Values::
31814 * Lseek Flags::
31815 * Limits::
31816 @end menu
31817
31818 @node Open Flags
31819 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
31820 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
31821
31822 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
31823
31824 @smallexample
31825 O_RDONLY 0x0
31826 O_WRONLY 0x1
31827 O_RDWR 0x2
31828 O_APPEND 0x8
31829 O_CREAT 0x200
31830 O_TRUNC 0x400
31831 O_EXCL 0x800
31832 @end smallexample
31833
31834 @node mode_t Values
31835 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
31836 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
31837
31838 All values are given in octal representation.
31839
31840 @smallexample
31841 S_IFREG 0100000
31842 S_IFDIR 040000
31843 S_IRUSR 0400
31844 S_IWUSR 0200
31845 S_IXUSR 0100
31846 S_IRGRP 040
31847 S_IWGRP 020
31848 S_IXGRP 010
31849 S_IROTH 04
31850 S_IWOTH 02
31851 S_IXOTH 01
31852 @end smallexample
31853
31854 @node Errno Values
31855 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
31856 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
31857
31858 All values are given in decimal representation.
31859
31860 @smallexample
31861 EPERM 1
31862 ENOENT 2
31863 EINTR 4
31864 EBADF 9
31865 EACCES 13
31866 EFAULT 14
31867 EBUSY 16
31868 EEXIST 17
31869 ENODEV 19
31870 ENOTDIR 20
31871 EISDIR 21
31872 EINVAL 22
31873 ENFILE 23
31874 EMFILE 24
31875 EFBIG 27
31876 ENOSPC 28
31877 ESPIPE 29
31878 EROFS 30
31879 ENAMETOOLONG 91
31880 EUNKNOWN 9999
31881 @end smallexample
31882
31883 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
31884 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
31885
31886 @node Lseek Flags
31887 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
31888 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
31889
31890 @smallexample
31891 SEEK_SET 0
31892 SEEK_CUR 1
31893 SEEK_END 2
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 @node Limits
31897 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
31898 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
31899
31900 All values are given in decimal representation.
31901
31902 @smallexample
31903 INT_MIN -2147483648
31904 INT_MAX 2147483647
31905 UINT_MAX 4294967295
31906 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
31907 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
31908 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
31909 @end smallexample
31910
31911 @node File-I/O Examples
31912 @subsection File-I/O Examples
31913 @cindex file-i/o examples
31914
31915 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
31916 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
31917
31918 @smallexample
31919 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
31920 @emph{request memory read from target}
31921 -> @code{m1234,6}
31922 <- XXXXXX
31923 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
31924 -> @code{F6}
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
31928 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
31929
31930 @smallexample
31931 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31932 @emph{request memory write to target}
31933 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
31934 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
31935 -> @code{F6}
31936 @end smallexample
31937
31938 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
31939 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31943 -> @code{F-1,9}
31944 @end smallexample
31945
31946 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
31947 host is called:
31948
31949 @smallexample
31950 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31951 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
31952 <- @code{T02}
31953 @end smallexample
31954
31955 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
31956 host is called:
31957
31958 @smallexample
31959 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31960 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
31961 <- @code{T02}
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 @node Library List Format
31965 @section Library List Format
31966 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
31967
31968 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
31969 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
31970 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
31971 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
31972 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
31973 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
31974 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
31975 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
31976 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
31977 are loaded.
31978
31979 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
31980 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
31981 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
31982 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
31983
31984 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
31985 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
31986 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
31987 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
31988 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
31989 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
31990
31991 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
31992 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
31993
31994 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
31995 offset, looks like this:
31996
31997 @smallexample
31998 <library-list>
31999 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
32000 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
32001 </library>
32002 </library-list>
32003 @end smallexample
32004
32005 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
32006 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 <library-list>
32010 <library name="sharedlib.o">
32011 <section address="0x10000000"/>
32012 <section address="0x20000000"/>
32013 <section address="0x30000000"/>
32014 </library>
32015 </library-list>
32016 @end smallexample
32017
32018 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
32019
32020 @smallexample
32021 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
32022 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
32023 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
32024 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
32025 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
32026 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
32027 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
32028 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
32029 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
32033 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
32034 section for each library.
32035
32036 @node Memory Map Format
32037 @section Memory Map Format
32038 @cindex memory map format
32039
32040 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
32041 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
32042 memory map.
32043
32044 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
32045 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
32046 lists memory regions.
32047
32048 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
32049 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
32050
32051 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
32052
32053 @smallexample
32054 <?xml version="1.0"?>
32055 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
32056 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
32057 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
32058 <memory-map>
32059 region...
32060 </memory-map>
32061 @end smallexample
32062
32063 Each region can be either:
32064
32065 @itemize
32066
32067 @item
32068 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
32069 bytes from there:
32070
32071 @smallexample
32072 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
32073 @end smallexample
32074
32075
32076 @item
32077 A region of read-only memory:
32078
32079 @smallexample
32080 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
32081 @end smallexample
32082
32083
32084 @item
32085 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
32086 bytes in length:
32087
32088 @smallexample
32089 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
32090 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
32091 </memory>
32092 @end smallexample
32093
32094 @end itemize
32095
32096 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
32097 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
32098 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
32099
32100 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
32101
32102 @smallexample
32103 <!-- ................................................... -->
32104 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
32105 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
32106 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
32107 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
32108 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
32109 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
32110 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
32111 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
32112 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
32113 and its type, or device. -->
32114 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
32115 start CDATA #REQUIRED
32116 length CDATA #REQUIRED
32117 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
32118 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
32119 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
32120 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
32121 @end smallexample
32122
32123 @node Thread List Format
32124 @section Thread List Format
32125 @cindex thread list format
32126
32127 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
32128 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
32129 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
32130 the following structure:
32131
32132 @smallexample
32133 <?xml version="1.0"?>
32134 <threads>
32135 <thread id="id" core="0">
32136 ... description ...
32137 </thread>
32138 </threads>
32139 @end smallexample
32140
32141 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
32142 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
32143 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
32144 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
32145 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
32146
32147 @include agentexpr.texi
32148
32149 @node Target Descriptions
32150 @appendix Target Descriptions
32151 @cindex target descriptions
32152
32153 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
32154 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
32155 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
32156
32157 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
32158 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
32159 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
32160 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
32161 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
32162 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
32163 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
32164
32165 @itemize @bullet
32166 @item
32167 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
32168 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
32169 @item
32170 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
32171 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
32172 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
32173 @item
32174 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
32175 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
32176 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
32177 @end itemize
32178
32179 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
32180 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
32181 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
32182 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
32183 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
32184
32185 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
32186 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
32187
32188 @menu
32189 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
32190 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
32191 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
32192 descriptions.
32193 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
32194 @end menu
32195
32196 @node Retrieving Descriptions
32197 @section Retrieving Descriptions
32198
32199 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
32200 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
32201 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
32202 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
32203 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
32204 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
32205 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
32206 Format}.
32207
32208 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
32209 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
32210 specify a file are:
32211
32212 @table @code
32213 @cindex set tdesc filename
32214 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
32215 Read the target description from @var{path}.
32216
32217 @cindex unset tdesc filename
32218 @item unset tdesc filename
32219 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
32220 will use the description supplied by the current target.
32221
32222 @cindex show tdesc filename
32223 @item show tdesc filename
32224 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
32225 @end table
32226
32227
32228 @node Target Description Format
32229 @section Target Description Format
32230 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
32231
32232 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
32233 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
32234 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
32235 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
32236 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
32237 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
32238 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
32239
32240 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
32241 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
32242 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
32243 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
32244 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
32245
32246 Here is a simple target description:
32247
32248 @smallexample
32249 <target version="1.0">
32250 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
32251 </target>
32252 @end smallexample
32253
32254 @noindent
32255 This minimal description only says that the target uses
32256 the x86-64 architecture.
32257
32258 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
32259 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
32260 are explained further below.
32261
32262 @smallexample
32263 <?xml version="1.0"?>
32264 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
32265 <target version="1.0">
32266 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
32267 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
32268 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
32269 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
32270 </target>
32271 @end smallexample
32272
32273 @noindent
32274 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
32275 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
32276 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
32277 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
32278 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
32279 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
32280 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
32281 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
32282 the version mismatch.
32283
32284 @subsection Inclusion
32285 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
32286 @cindex XInclude
32287 @ifnotinfo
32288 @cindex <xi:include>
32289 @end ifnotinfo
32290
32291 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
32292 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
32293 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
32294 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
32295 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301 @noindent
32302 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
32303 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
32304 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
32305 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
32306 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
32307 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
32308 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
32309 original description.
32310
32311 @subsection Architecture
32312 @cindex <architecture>
32313
32314 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
32315
32316 @smallexample
32317 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
32318 @end smallexample
32319
32320 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
32321 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
32322
32323 @subsection OS ABI
32324 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
32325
32326 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
32327 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
32328
32329 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
32330
32331 @smallexample
32332 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
32333 @end smallexample
32334
32335 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
32336 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
32337
32338 @subsection Compatible Architecture
32339 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
32340
32341 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
32342 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
32343
32344 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
32345
32346 @smallexample
32347 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
32348 @end smallexample
32349
32350 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
32351 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
32352
32353 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
32354 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
32355 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
32356 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
32357 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
32358 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
32359 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
32360
32361 @smallexample
32362 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
32363 <compatible>spu</compatible>
32364 @end smallexample
32365
32366 @subsection Features
32367 @cindex <feature>
32368
32369 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
32370 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
32371 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
32372 has this form:
32373
32374 @smallexample
32375 <feature name="@var{name}">
32376 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
32377 @var{reg}@dots{}
32378 </feature>
32379 @end smallexample
32380
32381 @noindent
32382 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
32383 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
32384 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
32385 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
32386
32387 @subsection Types
32388
32389 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
32390 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
32391 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
32392 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
32393 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
32394
32395 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
32396 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
32397 Types must be defined before they are used.
32398
32399 @cindex <vector>
32400 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
32401 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
32402 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
32403 @var{count}:
32404
32405 @smallexample
32406 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
32407 @end smallexample
32408
32409 @cindex <union>
32410 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
32411 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
32412 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
32413 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
32414
32415 @smallexample
32416 <union id="@var{id}">
32417 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
32418 @dots{}
32419 </union>
32420 @end smallexample
32421
32422 @subsection Registers
32423 @cindex <reg>
32424
32425 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
32426
32427 @smallexample
32428 <reg name="@var{name}"
32429 bitsize="@var{size}"
32430 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
32431 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
32432 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
32433 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
32434 @end smallexample
32435
32436 @noindent
32437 The components are as follows:
32438
32439 @table @var
32440
32441 @item name
32442 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
32443
32444 @item bitsize
32445 The register's size, in bits.
32446
32447 @item regnum
32448 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
32449 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
32450 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
32451 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
32452 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
32453 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
32454 in order of increasing register number.
32455
32456 @item save-restore
32457 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
32458 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
32459 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
32460 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
32461 ABI.
32462
32463 @item type
32464 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
32465 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
32466 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
32467 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
32468 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
32469 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
32470
32471 @item group
32472 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
32473 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
32474 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
32475 in @code{info registers}.
32476
32477 @end table
32478
32479 @node Predefined Target Types
32480 @section Predefined Target Types
32481 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
32482
32483 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
32484 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
32485 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
32486 types. The currently supported types are:
32487
32488 @table @code
32489
32490 @item int8
32491 @itemx int16
32492 @itemx int32
32493 @itemx int64
32494 @itemx int128
32495 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
32496
32497 @item uint8
32498 @itemx uint16
32499 @itemx uint32
32500 @itemx uint64
32501 @itemx uint128
32502 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
32503
32504 @item code_ptr
32505 @itemx data_ptr
32506 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
32507 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
32508 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
32509 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
32510 may be marked as data pointers.
32511
32512 @item ieee_single
32513 Single precision IEEE floating point.
32514
32515 @item ieee_double
32516 Double precision IEEE floating point.
32517
32518 @item arm_fpa_ext
32519 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
32520
32521 @end table
32522
32523 @node Standard Target Features
32524 @section Standard Target Features
32525 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
32526
32527 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
32528 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
32529 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
32530 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
32531 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
32532 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
32533 can recognize them.
32534
32535 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
32536 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
32537 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
32538 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
32539 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
32540 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
32541 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
32542 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
32543
32544 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
32545 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
32546 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
32547
32548 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
32549 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
32550 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
32551 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
32552
32553 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
32554 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
32555 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
32556
32557 @menu
32558 * ARM Features::
32559 * MIPS Features::
32560 * M68K Features::
32561 * PowerPC Features::
32562 @end menu
32563
32564
32565 @node ARM Features
32566 @subsection ARM Features
32567 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
32568
32569 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
32570 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
32571 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
32572
32573 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
32574 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
32575
32576 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
32577 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
32578 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
32579 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
32580
32581 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
32582 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
32583 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
32584 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
32585 halves of the double-precision registers.
32586
32587 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
32588 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
32589 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
32590 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
32591 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
32592 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
32593
32594 @node MIPS Features
32595 @subsection MIPS Features
32596 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
32597
32598 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
32599 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
32600 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
32601 on the target.
32602
32603 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
32604 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
32605 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32606
32607 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
32608 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
32609 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
32610 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32611
32612 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
32613 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
32614 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
32615
32616 @node M68K Features
32617 @subsection M68K Features
32618 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
32619
32620 @table @code
32621 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
32622 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
32623 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
32624 One of those features must be always present.
32625 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
32626 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
32627 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
32628 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
32629
32630 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
32631 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
32632 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
32633 @samp{fpiaddr}.
32634 @end table
32635
32636 @node PowerPC Features
32637 @subsection PowerPC Features
32638 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
32639
32640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
32641 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
32642 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
32643 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32644
32645 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
32646 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
32647
32648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
32649 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
32650 and @samp{vrsave}.
32651
32652 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
32653 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
32654 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
32655 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
32656 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
32657 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
32658
32659 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
32660 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
32661 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
32662 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
32663 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
32664 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
32665 user.
32666
32667 @node Operating System Information
32668 @appendix Operating System Information
32669 @cindex operating system information
32670
32671 @menu
32672 * Process list::
32673 @end menu
32674
32675 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
32676 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
32677 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
32678 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
32679 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
32680 on a different aspect of target.
32681
32682 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
32683 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
32684 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
32685 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
32686
32687 @node Process list
32688 @appendixsection Process list
32689 @cindex operating system information, process list
32690
32691 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
32692 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
32693 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
32694 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
32695
32696 An example document is:
32697
32698 @smallexample
32699 <?xml version="1.0"?>
32700 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
32701 <osdata type="processes">
32702 <item>
32703 <column name="pid">1</column>
32704 <column name="user">root</column>
32705 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
32706 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
32707 </item>
32708 </osdata>
32709 @end smallexample
32710
32711 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
32712 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
32713 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
32714 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
32715 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
32716 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
32717 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
32718
32719 @include gpl.texi
32720
32721 @raisesections
32722 @include fdl.texi
32723 @lowersections
32724
32725 @node Index
32726 @unnumbered Index
32727
32728 @printindex cp
32729
32730 @tex
32731 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
32732 % meantime:
32733 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
32734 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
32735 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
32736 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
32737 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
32738 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
32739 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
32740 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
32741 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
32742 \page\colophon
32743 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
32744 @end tex
32745
32746 @bye
This page took 0.83043 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.